Nikon D600 Camera Manual

Nikon

Camera Manual

Nikon Cameras: Nikon D600 Camera

PDF preview unavailable. Download the PDF instead.

Nikon-D600-camera-manual
DIGITAL CAMERA
User's Manual
En

Thank you for your purchase of a Nikon single-lens reflex (SLR) digital camera. To get the most from your camera, please be sure to read all instructions thoroughly and keep them where they will be read by all who use the product. Symbols and Conventions To make it easier to find the information you need, the following symbols and conventions are used:
D This icon marks cautions; information that should be read before use to prevent damage to the camera.
A This icon marks notes; information that should be read before using the camera.
0 This icon marks references to other pages in this manual.
Menu items, options, and messages displayed in the camera monitor are shown in bold.
Camera Settings The explanations in this manual assume that default settings are used.
Help Use the camera's on-board help feature for help on menu items and other topics. See page 18 for details.
Digitutor "Digitutor", a series of "watch and learn" manuals in movie form, is available from the following website: http://www.nikondigitutor.com/index_eng.html A For Your Safety Before using the camera for the first time, read the safety instructions in "For Your Safety" (0 xviii­xix).

Where to Find It

Find what you're looking for from:
i The Table of Contents ............ 0 x i The Q&A Index........................ 0 ii i Menu Options......................... 0 iv

i The Index................................. 0 338 i Error Messages........................ 0 322 i Troubleshooting ..................... 0 316

X Introduction s Basic Photography and Playback x Live View Photography y Movie Live View # P, S, A, and M Modes $ User Settings: U1 and U2 Modes k Release Mode d Image Recording Options N Focus S ISO Sensitivity Z Exposure r White Balance J Image Enhancement l Flash Photography t Other Shooting Options I More on Playback Q Connections U Menu Guide n Technical Notes

01 0 35 0 49 0 57 0 73 0 81 0 83 0 89 0 97 0 105 0 109 0 115 0 129 0 143 0 151 0 177 0 193 0 207 0 285

i

Q&A Index

Find what you're looking for using this "question and answer" index.

Taking Photographs

0

i Shooting Modes and Framing Options

Is there a quick and easy way to take snapshots (i mode)?

35­39

How do I quickly adjust settings for different scenes?

40­45

Can I adjust shutter speed to freeze or blur motion (mode S)?

76

Can I adjust aperture to blur backgrounds or bring them into focus (mode A)?

77

How do I make long ("time") exposures (mode M)?

79

Can I frame photos in the monitor (C live view photography)?

49

Can I shoot movies (1 movie live view)?

57

Can I join photographs taken at regular intervals to create a timelapse movie?

168

i Release Modes

Can I take photos one at a time or in quick succession?

6, 83

How do I take pictures with the self-timer or a remote control?

85

Can I reduce shutter noise in quiet surroundings (quiet shutter-release)? 6, 83

i Focus

Can I choose how the camera focuses?

97­100

Can I choose the focus point?

101

i Exposure

Can I make photos brighter or darker?

112

How do I preserve details in shadows and highlights?

137

i Using the Flash

Can I set the flash to fire automatically when needed?

How do I keep the flash from firing?

35, 143­147

How do I avoid "red-eye"?

i Image Quality and Size

How do I take pictures for printing at large sizes? How can I get more pictures on the memory card?

93­95

Viewing Photographs
i Playback
How do I view photographs on the camera? How do I view more information about a photo? Can I view photos in an automatic slide show? Can I view photos on a TV? Can I protect photos from accidental deletion?
i Deletion
How do I delete unwanted photos?

0
46, 177 179­184
213 204­205
188
47, 189­191

ii

Retouching Photographs
How do I create retouched copies of photos? How do I remove "red-eye"? How do I make JPEG copies of RAW (NEF) photos? Can I overlay two NEF (RAW) photos to make a single image? Can I create a copy of a photo that looks like a painting? Can I trim movie footage on the camera or save movie stills?
Menus and Settings
How do I use the menus? How do I display menus in another language? How do I use the command dials? How do I keep the displays from turning off? How do I focus the viewfinder? Can I display a framing grid in the viewfinder or the monitor? How do I tell if the camera is level? How do I set the camera clock? How do I format memory cards? How do I restore default settings? How do I get help for a menu or message?
Connections
How do I copy photos to a computer? How do I print photos? Can I print the date of recording on my photos?
Maintenance and Optional Accessories
What memory cards can I use? What lenses can I use? What optional flash units (Speedlights) can I use? What other accessories are available for my camera? What software is available for my camera? What do I do with the supplied eyepiece cap? How do I clean the camera? Where should I take my camera for servicing and repairs?

0
261­279 264 271
269­270 275 69
0
18­20 27, 253 12­16
228 33 55, 62, 229 258 27, 253 31, 250 151, 214, 221 18, 322
0
193­195 196­203 198, 203
0
334 285 292
297­298
86
300

iii

Menu Options

D PLAYBACK MENU (0 207)

Delete

Selected

Select date

All

Playback folder ND600

(default)

All

Current

Hide image

Select/set

Select date

Deselect all?

Playback display Done

options

Basic photo info

Focus point

Additional photo info

None (image only)

Highlights

RGB histogram

Shooting data

Overview

Copy image(s) Select source

Select image(s)

Select destination folder

Copy image(s)?

Image review On

Off

(default)

After delete

Show next

(default)

Show previous

Continue as before

Rotate tall

On

(default)

Off

Slide show

Start

Image type

Frame interval

DPOF print order Select/set

Deselect all?

C SHOOTING MENU (0 214)

Reset shooting menu Storage folder File naming Role played by card in Slot 2 Image quality
(0 93)
Image size

Yes

No

Select folder by number

Select folder from list

File naming

Overflow

(default)

Backup

RAW Slot 1 - JPEG Slot 2

NEF (RAW) + JPEG fine

NEF (RAW) + JPEG normal

NEF (RAW) + JPEG basic

NEF (RAW)

JPEG fine

JPEG normal

(default)

JPEG basic

Large

(default)

Medium

(0 95) Image area
JPEG compression NEF (RAW) recording White balance
(0 115)

Small

Auto DX crop

Choose image area

Size priority

(default)

Optimal quality

Type

NEF (RAW) bit depth

Auto

(default)

Incandescent

Fluorescent

Direct sunlight

Flash

Cloudy

Shade

Choose color temp.

Preset manual

Items marked with a icon can be saved to the memory card using the Save/load settings > Save settings option in the camera setup menu (0 249). The saved settings can be copied to other D600 cameras by inserting the memory card into the camera and selecting Save/load settings > Load settings.
iv

Set Picture Control
Manage Picture Control
Auto distortion control Color space Active D-Lighting 2
HDR (high dynamic range) Vignette control
Long exposure NR High ISO NR
ISO sensitivity settings

Standard

(default)

Neutral

Vivid

Monochrome

Portrait

Landscape

Save/edit

Rename 1

Delete 1

Load/save

On

Off

(default)

sRGB

(default)

Adobe RGB

Auto

Extra high

High

Normal

Low

Off

HDR mode

Exposure differential

Smoothing

High

Normal

(default)

Low

Off

On

Off

(default)

High

Normal

(default)

Low

Off

ISO sensitivity

Auto ISO sensitivity control

(0 105) Remote control mode
Multiple exposure

Delayed remote (default) Quick-response remote Remote mirror-up Multiple exposure mode Number of shots Auto gain

Interval timer shooting
Time-lapse photography

Choose start time Now Start time
Interval Select no. of times×no. of shots Start Start Interval

Movie settings

Shooting time Frame size/frame rate Movie quality Microphone Destination

1 Not available if no custom Picture Controls are present.
2 Defaults to Off (modes P, S, A, M, 1, 2, and 3) or Auto (other modes).

A CUSTOM SETTING MENU (0 219)

Reset custom Yes

settings

No

a Autofocus

a1 AF-C priority Release

selection

Focus

a2 AF-S priority Release

selection

Focus

a3 Focus

5 (Long)

tracking with 4

lock-on

3 (Normal)

2

1 (Short)

Off

a4 AF point

Auto

illumination On

Off

a5 Focus point Wrap

wrap-around No wrap

a6 Number of 39 points

focus points 11 points

a7 Built-in AF- On

assist

Off

illuminator

(default) (default) (default)
(default)
(default) (default) (default)

v

b Metering/exposure

b1 ISOsensitivity 1/3 step

step value 1/2 step

b2 EV steps for 1/3 step

exposure cntrl

1/2 step

b3 Easy exposure On (Auto reset)

compensation On

Off

b4 Center-

 8 mm

weighted area

 12 mm  15 mm

 20 mm

Average

b5 Fine-tune Yes

optimal

No

exposure

(default) (default)
(default) (default)
(default)

c Timers/AE lock c1 Shutter-
release button AE-L c2 Standby timer
c3 Self-timer
c4 Monitor off delay
c5 Remote on duration

On

Off

(default)

4 s

6 s

(default)

10 s

30 s

1 min

5 min

10 min

30 min

No limit

Self-timer delay

Number of shots

Interval between shots

Playback

Menus

Information display

Image review

Live view

1 min

(default)

5 min

10 min

15 min

d Shooting/display

d1 Beep

Volume

Pitch

d2 Viewfinder On grid display Off

(default)

d3 ISO display and adjustment

Show ISO sensitivity Show ISO/Easy ISO Show frame count (default)

d4 Screen tips On

(default)

Off

d5 CL mode 5 fps

shooting

4 fps

speed

3 fps

(default)

2 fps

1 fps

d6 Max. continuous release

1­100

d7 File number On sequence Off

(default)

Reset

d8 Information Auto

display

Manual

(default)

d9 LCD

On

illumination Off

(default)

d10 Exposure 3 s delay mode 2 s

1 s

Off

(default)

d11 Flash warning On

(default)

Off

d12 MB-D14

LR6 (AA alkaline)

battery type HR6 (AA Ni-MH)

(default)

FR6 (AA lithium)

d13 Battery order Use MB-D14 batteries first (default)

Use camera battery first

vi

e Bracketing/flash

e1 Flash sync 1/250 s (Auto FP)

speed

1/200 s (Auto FP)

1/200 s

(default)

1/160 s

1/125 s

1/100 s

1/80 s

1/60 s

e2 Flash shutter 1/60 s

(default)

speed

1/30 s

1/15 s

1/8 s

1/4 s

1/2 s

1 s

2 s

4 s

8 s

15 s

30 s

e3 Flash cntrl for TTL

(default)

built-in flash Manual

Repeating flash

Commander mode

e3 Optional flash *

TTL Manual

(default)

e4 Exposure Entire frame

(default)

comp. for flash

Background only

e5 Modeling On

(default)

flash

Off

e6 Auto

AE & flash

(default)

bracketing AE only

set

Flash only

WB bracketing

ADL bracketing

e7 Bracketing MTR > under > over (default)

order

Under > MTR > over

* Displayed only when optional SB-400 flash unit is attached.

f Controls
f1 OK button (shooting mode)

Select center focus point (default)
Highlight active focus point Not used

f Controls f2 Assign Fn
button
f3 Assign preview button

Preview

FV lock

AE/AF lock

AE lock only

AE lock (Hold)

AF lock only

AF-ON

Flash off

Bracketing burst

Active D-Lighting

+ NEF (RAW)

Matrix metering

Center-weighted metering

Spot metering

Framing grid

Choose image area (default)

Viewfinder virtual horizon

MY MENU

Access top item in MY MENU

1 step spd/aperture

Choose non-CPU lens number

Playback

None

Preview

(default)

FV lock

AE/AF lock

AE lock only

AE lock (Hold)

AF lock only

AF-ON

Flash off

Bracketing burst

Active D-Lighting

+ NEF (RAW)

Matrix metering

Center-weighted metering

Spot metering

Framing grid

Choose image area

Viewfinder virtual horizon

MY MENU

Access top item in MY MENU

1 step spd/aperture

Choose non-CPU lens number

Playback

None

vii

f Controls

f4 Assign AE-L/ AE/AF lock

(default)

AF-L button AE lock only

AE lock (Hold)

AF lock only

AF-ON

FV lock

None

f5 Customize Reverse rotation

command dials

Change main/sub Aperture setting

Menus and playback

f6 Release

Yes

button to use No dial

(default)

f7 Slot empty Release locked

release lock Enable release

(default)

f8 Reverse

indicators

(default)

f9 Assign

AE/AF lock

(default)

MB-D14 4 button

AE lock only AE lock (Hold)

AF lock only

AF-ON

FV lock

Same as Fn button

g Movie g1 Assign Fn
button
g2 Assign preview button

Index marking

View photo shooting info

AE/AF lock

AE lock only

AE lock (Hold)

AF lock only

AF-ON

None

(default)

Index marking

(default)

View photo shooting info

AE/AF lock

AE lock only

AE lock (Hold)

AF lock only

AF-ON

None

g Movie g3 Assign AE-L/
AF-L button
g4 Assign shutter button

Index marking

View photo shooting info

AE/AF lock

(default)

AE lock only

AE lock (Hold)

AF lock only

AF-ON

None

Take photos

(default)

Record movies

B SETUP MENU (0 249)

Format memory Slot 1

card

Slot 2

Save user settings

Save to U1 Save to U2

Reset user settings

Reset U1 Reset U2

Monitor brightness

Auto Manual

(default)

Clean image sensor

Clean now Clean at startup/shutdown

Lock mirror up Start for cleaning 1

Image Dust Off Start

ref photo

Clean sensor and then start

HDMI

Output resolution

Device control

Flicker reduction Auto

(default)

50 Hz

60 Hz

Time zone and Time zone

date

Date and time

Date format

Daylight saving time

Language

,

,

,

,

,

,

,

,

,

,

,

,

,

,

,

,

,

,

,

,

, ,

,

,

, ,

,

viii

Image comment Done

Input comment

Attach comment

Auto image

On

rotation

Off

(default)

Battery info

­

Copyright information

Done Artist

Copyright

Save/load settings
GPS

Attach copyright information Save settings Load settings Standby timer

Position

Use GPS to set camera clock

Virtual horizon ­

Non-CPU lens data

Done Lens number

Focal length (mm)

Maximum aperture

AF fine-tune AF fine-tune (On/Off)

Saved value

Default

List saved values Eye-Fi upload 2 Slot 1

Slot 2

Firmware version ­

1 Not available at battery levels of J or below. 2 Available only with compatible Eye-Fi memory
cards.

N RETOUCH MENU (0 261)

D-Lighting Red-eye correction Trim Monochrome
Filter effects

­ ­
­ Black-and-white Sepia Cyanotype Skylight Warm filter Red intensifier Green intensifier Blue intensifier Cross screen Soft

Color balance Image overlay 1 NEF (RAW) processing Resize
Quick retouch Straighten Distortion control Fisheye Color outline Color sketch Perspective control Miniature effect Selective color Edit movie
Side-by-side comparison 2

­ ­ ­
Select image Choose destination Choose size ­ ­ Auto Manual ­ ­ ­ ­
­ ­ Choose start/end point Save selected frame ­

1 Available only when G button is pressed and N tab selected in menus.
2 Only available when J or c (b) button is pressed to display retouch menu during fullframe playback.

O MY MENU (0 280)

Add items
Remove items * Rank items Choose tab

Playback menu Shooting menu Custom setting menu Setup menu Retouch menu ­ ­ My Menu Recent settings

* Items can also be deleted by highlighting them in MY MENU and pressing the O (Q) button twice.

ix

Table of Contents

Q&A Index .................................................................................................................................... ii Menu Options ............................................................................................................................ iv For Your Safety ......................................................................................................................xviii Notices......................................................................................................................................... xx Package Contents.................................................................................................................xxiv

Introduction

1

Getting to Know the Camera................................................................................................. 1 The Camera Body ......................................................................................................................1 The Mode Dial.............................................................................................................................5 The Release-Mode Dial ............................................................................................................6 The Control Panel......................................................................................................................7 The Viewfinder............................................................................................................................8 The Information Display..........................................................................................................9 The Command Dials .............................................................................................................. 12 The BM-14 Monitor Cover ................................................................................................... 17
Camera Menus..........................................................................................................................18 Using Camera Menus ............................................................................................................ 19
First Steps ...................................................................................................................................21 Charge the Battery ................................................................................................................. 21 Insert the Battery .................................................................................................................... 23 Attach a Lens............................................................................................................................ 25 Basic Setup................................................................................................................................ 27 Insert a Memory Card............................................................................................................ 29 Format the Memory Card .................................................................................................... 31 Adjust Viewfinder Focus ...................................................................................................... 33

Basic Photography and Playback

35

"Point-and-Shoot" Photography (i and j Modes)...................................................35 Step 1: Turn the Camera On................................................................................................ 35 Step 2: Select i or j Mode ............................................................................................... 36 Step 3: Frame the Photograph .......................................................................................... 37 Step 4: Focus ............................................................................................................................ 38 Step 5: Shoot ............................................................................................................................ 38

x

Creative Photography (Scene Modes) .............................................................................40 k Portrait...............................................................................................................................41 l Landscape........................................................................................................................41 p Child...................................................................................................................................41 m Sports.................................................................................................................................41 n Close Up............................................................................................................................42 o Night Portrait ..................................................................................................................42 r Night Landscape............................................................................................................42 s Party/Indoor ....................................................................................................................42 t Beach/Snow ....................................................................................................................43 u Sunset................................................................................................................................43 v Dusk/Dawn ......................................................................................................................43 w Pet Portrait.......................................................................................................................43 x Candlelight........................................................................................................................44 y Blossom.............................................................................................................................44 z Autumn Colors ...............................................................................................................44 0 Food....................................................................................................................................44 1 Silhouette.........................................................................................................................45 2 High Key............................................................................................................................45 3 Low Key.............................................................................................................................45
Basic Playback ...........................................................................................................................46 Deleting Unwanted Photographs.....................................................................................47

Live View Photography

49

Focusing in Live View ............................................................................................................51 The Live View Display: Live View Photography ...........................................................53 The Information Display: Live View Photography ......................................................55 Manual Focus ...........................................................................................................................55

Movie Live View

57

Indices ......................................................................................................................................... 60 The Live View Display: Movie Live View .........................................................................61 The Information Display: Movie Live View.....................................................................62 Image Area ................................................................................................................................63 Movie Settings .........................................................................................................................65 Viewing Movies ........................................................................................................................67 Editing Movies ..........................................................................................................................69 Trimming Movies ....................................................................................................................69 Saving Selected Frames........................................................................................................72

xi

P, S, A, and M Modes

73

P: Programmed Auto ............................................................................................................. 75 S: Shutter-Priority Auto ......................................................................................................... 76 A: Aperture-Priority Auto...................................................................................................... 77 M: Manual................................................................................................................................... 78
Long Time-Exposures (M Mode Only)........................................................................ 79

User Settings: U1 and U2 Modes

81

Saving User Settings.............................................................................................................. 81 Recalling User Settings ......................................................................................................... 82 Resetting User Settings ........................................................................................................ 82

Release Mode

83

Choosing a Release Mode ....................................................................................................83 Self-Timer and Remote Control Modes ...........................................................................85 Mirror up Mode ........................................................................................................................88

Image Recording Options

89

Image Area.................................................................................................................................89 Image Quality and Size..........................................................................................................93
Image Quality........................................................................................................................... 93 Image Size ................................................................................................................................. 95 Using Two Memory Cards ....................................................................................................96

Focus

97

Autofocus ...................................................................................................................................97 Autofocus Mode ..................................................................................................................... 97 AF-Area Mode.......................................................................................................................... 99 Focus Point Selection..........................................................................................................101 Focus Lock...............................................................................................................................102
Manual Focus ......................................................................................................................... 103

ISO Sensitivity

105

Auto ISO Sensitivity Control ............................................................................................. 107

xii

Exposure

109

Metering................................................................................................................................... 109 Autoexposure Lock .............................................................................................................. 110 Exposure Compensation.................................................................................................... 112

White Balance

115

Fine-Tuning White Balance ............................................................................................... 117 Choosing a Color Temperature ....................................................................................... 120 Preset Manual ........................................................................................................................ 121

Image Enhancement

129

Picture Controls..................................................................................................................... 129 Selecting a Picture Control............................................................................................... 129 Modifying Picture Controls .............................................................................................. 131 Creating Custom Picture Controls ................................................................................. 134 Sharing Custom Picture Controls................................................................................... 136
Preserving Detail in Highlights and Shadows ............................................................ 137 Active D-Lighting................................................................................................................. 137 High Dynamic Range (HDR) ............................................................................................. 139

Flash Photography

143

Using the Built-in Flash....................................................................................................... 143 Flash Mode ............................................................................................................................. 144
Flash Compensation............................................................................................................ 148 FV Lock...................................................................................................................................... 149

Other Shooting Options

151

Two-Button Reset: Restoring Default Settings........................................................... 151 Bracketing ............................................................................................................................... 153 Multiple Exposure................................................................................................................. 160 Interval Timer Photography.............................................................................................. 164 Time-Lapse Photography .................................................................................................. 168 Non-CPU Lenses.................................................................................................................... 172 The GP-1 GPS Unit ................................................................................................................ 175

xiii

More on Playback

177

Full-Frame Playback............................................................................................................. 177 Photo Information................................................................................................................179
Thumbnail Playback ............................................................................................................ 185 Calendar Playback ................................................................................................................ 186 Taking a Closer Look: Playback Zoom........................................................................... 187 Protecting Photographs from Deletion........................................................................ 188 Deleting Photographs ........................................................................................................ 189
Full-Frame, Thumbnail, and Calendar Playback........................................................189 The Playback Menu..............................................................................................................190

Connections

193

Connecting to a Computer ............................................................................................... 193 Before Connecting the Camera.......................................................................................193 Connecting the Camera .....................................................................................................194
Printing Photographs.......................................................................................................... 196 Connecting the Printer.......................................................................................................196 Printing Pictures One at a Time.......................................................................................197 Printing Multiple Pictures..................................................................................................199 Creating a DPOF Print Order: Print Set .........................................................................202
Viewing Photographs on TV............................................................................................. 204

Menu Guide

207

D The Playback Menu: Managing Images ........................................................................... 207 Playback Folder.................................................................................................................207 Hide Image .........................................................................................................................208 Playback Display Options..............................................................................................209 Copy Image(s) ...................................................................................................................209 Image Review ....................................................................................................................212 After Delete ........................................................................................................................212 Rotate Tall...........................................................................................................................212 Slide Show ..........................................................................................................................213
C The Shooting Menu: Shooting Options ............................................................................ 214 Reset Shooting Menu .....................................................................................................214 Storage Folder...................................................................................................................215 File Naming ........................................................................................................................216 Auto Distortion Control .................................................................................................217 Color Space ........................................................................................................................217 Vignette Control...............................................................................................................218 Long Exposure NR (Long Exposure Noise Reduction)........................................218 High ISO NR........................................................................................................................218

xiv

A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings................................................................... 219 Reset Custom Settings................................................................................................... 221
a: Autofocus ........................................................................................................................... 221 a1: AF-C Priority Selection ............................................................................................ 221 a2: AF-S Priority Selection ............................................................................................ 221 a3: Focus Tracking with Lock-On............................................................................... 222 a4: AF Point Illumination .............................................................................................. 222 a5: Focus Point Wrap-Around..................................................................................... 222 a6: Number of Focus Points......................................................................................... 223 a7: Built-in AF-assist Illuminator................................................................................. 223
b: Metering/Exposure......................................................................................................... 224 b1: ISO Sensitivity Step Value ..................................................................................... 224 b2: EV Steps for Exposure Cntrl .................................................................................. 224 b3: Easy Exposure Compensation ............................................................................. 225 b4: Center-Weighted Area ........................................................................................... 226 b5: Fine-tune Optimal Exposure................................................................................ 226
c: Timers/AE Lock ................................................................................................................. 226 c1: Shutter-Release Button AE-L ................................................................................ 226 c2: Standby timer ............................................................................................................ 227 c3: Self-Timer..................................................................................................................... 227 c4: Monitor off Delay...................................................................................................... 228 c5: Remote on Duration................................................................................................ 228
d: Shooting/Display............................................................................................................. 228 d1: Beep .............................................................................................................................. 228 d2: Viewfinder Grid Display ......................................................................................... 229 d3: ISO Display and Adjustment ................................................................................ 229 d4: Screen Tips.................................................................................................................. 229 d5: CL Mode Shooting Speed ..................................................................................... 229 d6: Max. Continuous Release ...................................................................................... 230 d7: File Number Sequence........................................................................................... 230 d8: Information Display................................................................................................. 231 d9: LCD Illumination....................................................................................................... 231 d10: Exposure Delay Mode .......................................................................................... 231 d11: Flash Warning ......................................................................................................... 231 d12: MB-D14 Battery Type ........................................................................................... 232 d13: Battery Order........................................................................................................... 233
e: Bracketing/Flash .............................................................................................................. 234 e1: Flash Sync Speed ...................................................................................................... 234 e2: Flash Shutter Speed................................................................................................. 235 e3: Flash Cntrl for Built-in Flash.................................................................................. 236 e4: Exposure Comp. for Flash...................................................................................... 240 e5: Modeling Flash.......................................................................................................... 241 e6: Auto Bracketing Set................................................................................................. 241 e7: Bracketing Order....................................................................................................... 241
xv

f: Controls ................................................................................................................................241 f1: OK Button (Shooting Mode)...................................................................................241 f2: Assign Fn Button ........................................................................................................242 f3: Assign Preview Button .............................................................................................244 f4: Assign AE-L/AF-L Button .........................................................................................244 f5: Customize Command Dials ....................................................................................245 f6: Release Button to Use Dial......................................................................................246 f7: Slot Empty Release Lock..........................................................................................246 f8: Reverse Indicators......................................................................................................246 f9: Assign MB-D14 4 Button........................................................................................247
g: Movie....................................................................................................................................247 g1: Assign Fn Button.......................................................................................................247 g2: Assign Preview Button............................................................................................248 g3: Assign AE-L/AF-L Button ........................................................................................248 g4: Assign Shutter Button.............................................................................................248
B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup .......................................................................................... 249 Format Memory Card .....................................................................................................250 Monitor Brightness..........................................................................................................250 Image Dust Off Ref Photo .............................................................................................251 Flicker Reduction..............................................................................................................252 Time Zone and Date .......................................................................................................253 Language ............................................................................................................................253 Image Comment ..............................................................................................................253 Auto Image Rotation ......................................................................................................254 Battery Info.........................................................................................................................255 Copyright Information ...................................................................................................256 Save/Load Settings..........................................................................................................257 Virtual Horizon ..................................................................................................................258 AF Fine-tune ......................................................................................................................259 Eye-Fi Upload ....................................................................................................................260 Firmware Version .............................................................................................................260
N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies ................................................................. 261 Creating Retouched Copies..............................................................................................262 D-Lighting...........................................................................................................................264 Red-Eye Correction..........................................................................................................264 Trim .......................................................................................................................................265 Monochrome.....................................................................................................................266 Filter Effects........................................................................................................................267 Color Balance.....................................................................................................................268 Image Overlay ...................................................................................................................269 NEF (RAW) Processing ....................................................................................................271 Resize....................................................................................................................................272 Quick Retouch...................................................................................................................273 Straighten ...........................................................................................................................274 Distortion Control............................................................................................................274 Fisheye .................................................................................................................................274 Color Outline .....................................................................................................................275
xvi

Color Sketch ...................................................................................................................... 275 Perspective Control ........................................................................................................ 275 Miniature Effect................................................................................................................ 276 Selective Color.................................................................................................................. 277 Side-by-side Comparison ............................................................................................. 279 O My Menu/m Recent Settings...................................................................................... 280 Recent Settings..................................................................................................................... 283

Technical Notes

285

Compatible Lenses............................................................................................................... 285 Optional Flash Units (Speedlights)................................................................................. 292
The Nikon Creative Lighting System (CLS) ................................................................. 293
Other Accessories ................................................................................................................. 297 Attaching a Power Connector and AC Adapter ........................................................ 299
Caring for the Camera......................................................................................................... 300 Storage..................................................................................................................................... 300 Cleaning .................................................................................................................................. 300 The Low-Pass Filter.............................................................................................................. 301 "Clean Now" ...................................................................................................................... 301 "Clean at Startup/Shutdown" ..................................................................................... 302 Manual Cleaning.............................................................................................................. 303
Caring for the Camera and Battery: Cautions............................................................. 306 Available Settings ................................................................................................................. 309 Defaults .................................................................................................................................... 312 Exposure Program (Mode P)............................................................................................. 315 Troubleshooting ................................................................................................................... 316
Display ..................................................................................................................................... 316 Shooting (All Modes) .......................................................................................................... 317 Shooting (P, S, A, M)........................................................................................................... 319 Playback .................................................................................................................................. 320 Miscellaneous........................................................................................................................ 321
Error Messages....................................................................................................................... 322 Specifications ......................................................................................................................... 326 Approved Memory Cards................................................................................................... 334 Memory Card Capacity ....................................................................................................... 335 Battery Life .............................................................................................................................. 337 Index.......................................................................................................................................... 338

xvii

For Your Safety

To prevent damage to your Nikon product or injury to yourself or to others, read the following safety precautions in their entirety before using this equipment. Keep these safety instructions where all those who use the product will read them.
The consequences that could result from failure to observe the precautions listed in this section are indicated by the following symbol:

A This icon marks warnings. To prevent possible injury, read all warnings before using this Nikon product.

 WARNINGS
A Keep the sun out of the frame
Keep the sun well out of the frame when shooting backlit subjects. Sunlight focused into the camera when the sun is in or close to the frame could cause a fire.
A Do not look at the sun through the viewfinder
Viewing the sun or other strong light source through the viewfinder could cause permanent visual impairment.
A Using the viewfinder diopter adjustment control
When operating the viewfinder diopter adjustment control with your eye to the viewfinder, care should be taken not to put your finger in your eye accidentally.
A Turn off immediately in the event of malfunction
Should you notice smoke or an unusual smell coming from the equipment or AC adapter (available separately), unplug the AC adapter and remove the battery immediately, taking care to avoid burns. Continued operation could result in injury. After removing the battery, take the equipment to a Nikon-authorized service center for inspection.
A Do not use in the presence of flammable gas
Do not use electronic equipment in the presence of flammable gas, as this could result in explosion or fire.
A Do not place the strap around the neck of an
infant or child Placing the camera strap around the neck of an infant or child could result in strangulation.

A Keep out of reach of children
Failure to observe this precaution could result in injury. In addition, note that small parts constitute a chocking hazard. Should a child swallow any part of this equipment, consult a physician immediately.
A Do not disassemble
Touching the product's internal parts could result in injury. In the event of malfunction, the product should be repaired only by a qualified technician. Should the product break open as the result of a fall or other accident, remove the battery and/or AC adapter and then take the product to a Nikon-authorized service center for inspection.
A Do not remain in contact with the camera,
battery, or charger for extended periods while the devices are on or in use Parts of the device become hot. Leaving the device in direct contact with the skin for extended periods may result in lowtemperature burns.
A Do not aim a flash at the operator of a motor
vehicle Failure to observe this precaution could result in accidents.
A Avoid contact with liquid crystal
Should the monitor break, care should be taken to avoid injury due to broken glass and to prevent the liquid crystal from the monitor touching the skin or entering the eyes or mouth.

xviii

A Observe caution when using the flash
· Using the camera with the flash in close contact with the skin or other objects could cause burns.
· Using the flash close to the subject's eyes could cause temporary visual impairment. Particular care should be observed when photographing infants, when the flash should be no less than one meter (39 in.) from the subject.
A Observe proper precautions when handling
batteries Batteries may leak or explode if improperly handled. Observe the following precautions when handling batteries for use in this product: · Use only batteries approved for use in
this equipment. · Do not short or disassemble the battery. · Be sure the product is off before
replacing the battery. If you are using an AC adapter, be sure it is unplugged. · Do not attempt to insert the battery upside down or backwards. · Do not expose the battery to flame or to excessive heat. · Do not immerse in or expose to water. · Replace the terminal cover when transporting the battery. Do not transport or store the battery with metal objects such as necklaces or hairpins. · Batteries are prone to leakage when fully discharged. To avoid damage to the product, be sure to remove the battery when no charge remains. · When the battery is not in use, attach the terminal cover and store in a cool, dry place. · The battery may be hot immediately after use or when the product has been used on battery power for an extended period. Before removing the battery turn the camera off and allow the battery to cool. · Discontinue use immediately should you notice any changes in the battery, such as discoloration or deformation.

A Observe proper precautions when handling the
charger · Keep dry. Failure to observe this
precaution could result in fire or electric shock. · Dust on or near the metal parts of the plug should be removed with a dry cloth. Continued use could result in fire. · Do not handle the power cable or go near the charger during thunderstorms. Failure to observe this precaution could result in electric shock. · Do not damage, modify, or forcibly tug or bend the power cable. Do not place it under heavy objects or expose it to heat or flame. Should the insulation be damaged and the wires become exposed, take the power cable to a Nikon-authorized service representative for inspection. Failure to observe this precaution could result in fire or electric shock. · Do not handle the plug or charger with wet hands. Failure to observe this precaution could result in electric shock. · Do not use with travel converters or adapters designed to convert from one voltage to another or with DC-to-AC inverters. Failure to observe this precaution could damage the product or cause overheating or fire.
A Use appropriate cables
When connecting cables to the input and output jacks, use only the cables provided or sold by Nikon for the purpose to maintain compliance with product regulations.
A CD-ROMs
CD-ROMs containing software or manuals should not be played back on audio CD equipment. Playing CD-ROMs on an audio CD player could cause hearing loss or damage the equipment.

xix

Notices

· No part of the manuals included with this product may be reproduced, transmitted, transcribed, stored in a retrieval system, or translated into any language in any form, by any means, without Nikon's prior written permission.
· Nikon reserves the right to change the specifications of the hardware and software described in these manuals at any time and without prior notice.

· Nikon will not be held liable for any damages resulting from the use of this product.
· While every effort has been made to ensure that the information in these manuals is accurate and complete, we would appreciate it were you to bring any errors or omissions to the attention of the Nikon representative in your area (address provided separately).

Notices for Customers in Canada CAUTION This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003.

ATTENTION Cet appareil numérique de la classe B est conforme à la norme NMB-003 du Canada.

Notices for Customers in Europe

CAUTION RISK OF EXPLOSION IF BATTERY IS REPLACED BY AN INCORRECT TYPE. DISPOSE OF USED BATTERIES ACCORDING TO THE INSTRUCTIONS.

This symbol indicates that this product is to be collected separately.
The following apply only to users in European countries: · This product is designated for separate
collection at an appropriate collection point. Do not dispose of as household waste. · For more information, contact the retailer or the local authorities in charge of waste management.

This symbol on the battery indicates that the battery is to be collected separately.
The following apply only to users in European countries: · All batteries, whether marked with this
symbol or not, are designated for separate collection at an appropriate collection point. Do not dispose of as household waste. · For more information, contact the retailer or the local authorities in charge of waste management.

xx

Notices for Customers in the U.S.A. Power Cable At voltages over AC 125 V (U.S.A. only): The power cable must be rated for the voltage in use, be at least AWG no. 18 gauge, and have SVG insulation or better with a NEMA 6P-15 plug rated for AC 250 V 15 A.

Federal Communications Commission (FCC) Radio Frequency Interference Statement

This equipment has been tested and found

to comply with the limits for a Class B digital

device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC rules.

These limits are designed to provide

reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to

CAUTIONS Modifications The FCC requires the user be notified that any changes or modifications made to this device that are not expressly approved by Nikon Corporation may void the user's authority to operate the equipment.
Interface Cables Use the interface cables sold or provided by Nikon for your equipment. Using other interface cables may exceed the limits of Class B Part 15 of the FCC rules.

correct the interference by one or more of the following measures: · Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna. · Increase the separation between the
equipment and receiver. · Connect the equipment into an outlet on a
circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected. · Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/television technician for help.

Notice for Customers in the State of California WARNING: Handling the cord on this product may expose you to lead, a chemical known to the State of California to cause birth defects or other reproductive harm. Wash hands after handling.
Nikon Inc., 1300 Walt Whitman Road, Melville, New York 11747-3064, U.S.A. Tel.: 631-547-4200

xxi

Notice Concerning Prohibition of Copying or Reproduction Note that simply being in possession of material that has been digitally copied or reproduced by means of a scanner, digital camera, or other device may be punishable by law.

· Items prohibited by law from being copied or reproduced Do not copy or reproduce paper money, coins, securities, government bonds, or local government bonds, even if such copies or reproductions are stamped "Sample."
The copying or reproduction of paper money, coins, or securities which are circulated in a foreign country is prohibited.
Unless the prior permission of the government has been obtained, the copying or reproduction of unused postage stamps or post cards issued by the government is prohibited.
The copying or reproduction of stamps issued by the government and of certified documents stipulated by law is prohibited.

· Cautions on certain copies and reproductions The government has issued cautions on copies or reproductions of securities issued by private companies (shares, bills, checks, gift certificates, etc.), commuter passes, or coupon tickets, except when a minimum of necessary copies are to be provided for business use by a company. Also, do not copy or reproduce passports issued by the government, licenses issued by public agencies and private groups, ID cards, and tickets, such as passes and meal coupons.
· Comply with copyright notices The copying or reproduction of copyrighted creative works such as books, music, paintings, woodcuts, prints, maps, drawings, movies, and photographs is governed by national and international copyright laws. Do not use this product for the purpose of making illegal copies or to infringe copyright laws.

Disposing of Data Storage Devices Please note that deleting images or formatting memory cards or other data storage devices does not completely erase the original image data. Deleted files can sometimes be recovered from discarded storage devices using commercially available software, potentially resulting in the malicious use of personal image data. Ensuring the privacy of such data is the user's responsibility.

Before discarding a data storage device or transferring ownership to another person, erase all data using commercial deletion software, or format the device and then completely refill it with images containing no private information (for example, pictures of empty sky). Be sure to also replace any pictures selected for preset manual (0 121). Care should be taken to avoid injury when physically destroying data storage devices.

AVC Patent Portfolio License THIS PRODUCT IS LICENSED UNDER THE AVC PATENT PORTFOLIO LICENSE FOR THE PERSONAL AND NONCOMMERCIAL USE OF A CONSUMER TO (i) ENCODE VIDEO IN COMPLIANCE WITH THE AVC STANDARD ("AVC VIDEO") AND/OR (ii) DECODE AVC VIDEO THAT WAS ENCODED BY A CONSUMER ENGAGED IN A PERSONAL AND NON-COMMERCIAL ACTIVITY AND/OR WAS OBTAINED FROM A VIDEO PROVIDER LICENSED TO PROVIDE AVC VIDEO. NO LICENSE IS GRANTED OR SHALL BE IMPLIED FOR ANY OTHER USE. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION MAY BE OBTAINED FROM MPEG LA, L.L.C. SEE http://www.mpegla.com

xxii

Use Only Nikon Brand Electronic Accessories Nikon cameras are designed to the highest standards and include complex electronic circuitry. Only Nikon brand electronic accessories (including chargers, batteries, AC adapters, and flash accessories) certified by Nikon specifically for use with this Nikon digital camera are engineered and proven to operate within the operational and safety requirements of this electronic circuitry.
The use of non-Nikon electronic accessories could damage the camera and may void your Nikon warranty. The use of third-party rechargeable Li-ion batteries not bearing the Nikon holographic seal shown at right could interfere with normal operation of the camera or result in the batteries overheating, igniting, rupturing, or leaking.
For more information about Nikon brand accessories, contact a local authorized Nikon dealer.
D Use Only Nikon Brand Accessories
Only Nikon brand accessories certified by Nikon specifically for use with your Nikon digital camera are engineered and proven to operate within its operational and safety requirements. THE USE OF NON-NIKON ACCESSORIES COULD DAMAGE YOUR CAMERA AND MAY VOID YOUR NIKON WARRANTY.
D Servicing the Camera and Accessories
The camera is a precision device and requires regular servicing. Nikon recommends that the camera be inspected by the original retailer or a Nikon-authorized service representative once every one to two years, and that it be serviced once every three to five years (note that fees apply to these services). Frequent inspection and servicing are particularly recommended if the camera is used professionally. Any accessories regularly used with the camera, such as lenses or optional flash units, should be included when the camera is inspected or serviced.
A Before Taking Important Pictures
Before taking pictures on important occasions (such as at weddings or before taking the camera on a trip), take a test shot to ensure that the camera is functioning normally. Nikon will not be held liable for damages or lost profits that may result from product malfunction.
A Life-Long Learning
As part of Nikon's "Life-Long Learning" commitment to ongoing product support and education, continually-updated information is available on-line at the following sites: · For users in the U.S.A.: http://www.nikonusa.com/ · For users in Europe and Africa: http://www.europe-nikon.com/support/ · For users in Asia, Oceania, and the Middle East: http://www.nikon-asia.com/ Visit these sites to keep up-to-date with the latest product information, tips, answers to frequently-asked questions (FAQs), and general advice on digital imaging and photography. Additional information may be available from the Nikon representative in your area. See the following URL for contact information: http://imaging.nikon.com/
xxiii

Package Contents

Be sure all items listed here were included with your camera. Memory cards are sold separately.

· BS-1 accessory shoe cover

· DK-21 rubber eyecup

· D600 camera

· BM-14 monitor cover

· BF-1B body cap

· EN-EL15 rechargeable Li-ion battery (with terminal cover)
· MH-25 battery charger (AC wall adapter supplied only in countries or regions where required. Shape of power cable depends on country of sale.)

· AN-DC8 strap · UC-E15 USB cable · ViewNX 2 CD · User's Manual
(this guide) · Warranty
Memory cards are sold separately.

· DK-5 eyepiece cap

A The Camera Strap
Attach the strap securely to the two eyelets on the camera body as shown below.
xxiv

XIntroduction

Getting to Know the Camera

Take a few moments to familiarize yourself with camera controls and displays. You

may find it helpful to bookmark this section and refer to it as you read through the rest of the manual.

X

The Camera Body

1 Release mode dial .............................................6, 83 2 Mode dial....................................................................5 3 Mode dial lock release.............................................5 4 Eyelet for camera strap 5 Release mode dial lock release ......................6, 83 6 Accessory shoe (for optional flash unit).........292 7 Accessory shoe cover..........................................292 8 Power switch..............................................................1 9 Shutter-release button...................................38, 39

10 E button Exposure compensation................................ 112 Two-button reset............................................. 151
11 Movie-record button .............................................58 12 Z/Q button
Metering............................................................ 109 Formatting memory cards ...............................31 13 Focal plane mark (E)........................................ 103 14 Control panel.............................................................7

A The Power Switch
Rotate the power switch as shown to turn the camera on.

Rotate the power switch as shown to turn the camera off.

1

The Camera Body (Continued)
X

1 Built-in flash ..........................................................143 2 Mirror ............................................................... 88, 303 3 Meter coupling lever...........................................328 4 Lens mounting mark............................................. 26 5 M/Y button
Flash mode ........................................................143 Flash compensation........................................148 6 D button Bracketing........................................153, 156, 158 7 Infrared receiver (front) ........................................ 86 8 Built-in microphone ....................................... 58, 65 9 Audio connector cover ................................ 61, 298

10 HDMI/USB connector cover ............ 194, 196, 204 11 Cover for accessory terminal ............................ 298 12 Lens release button............................................... 26 13 AF-mode button .....................................51, 98, 100 14 Focus-mode selector ................................... 97, 103 15 Headphone connector ......................................... 61 16 Connector for external microphone ................. 61 17 USB connector
Connecting to a computer............................ 194 Connecting to a printer.................................. 196 18 HDMI mini-pin connector.................................. 204 19 Accessory terminal..................................... 175, 298

A LCD Illuminators
Rotating the power switch toward D activates the standby timer and control panel backlight (LCD illuminator), allowing the display to be read in the dark. After the power switch is released and returns to the ON position, the illuminators will remain lit for six seconds while the standby timer is active or until the shutter is released or the power switch is rotated toward D again.

Power switch

2

The Camera Body (Continued)
X

1 AF-assist illuminator ...........................................223 Self-timer lamp ...................................................... 86 Red-eye reduction lamp ....................................145
2 Sub-command dial....................................... 12, 245 3 Depth-of-field preview button...60, 77, 244, 248 4 Fn (function) button................... 92, 149, 174, 242 5 Battery-chamber cover ........................................ 23 6 Battery-chamber cover latch .............................. 23

7 Contact cover for optional MB-D14 battery pack .............................................................................. 297
8 Power connector cover ...................................... 299 9 CPU contacts 10 Lens mount.....................................................26, 103 11 AF coupling 12 Tripod socket 13 Body cap..........................................................25, 298

D The Microphone and Speaker
Do not place the microphone or speaker in close proximity to magnetic devices. Failure to observe this precaution could affect the data recorded on the magnetic devices.
3

The Camera Body (Continued)
X

1 Viewfinder eyepiece.............................................. 33 2 Rubber eyecup ....................................................... 86 3 O/Q button
Delete .......................................................... 47, 189 Formatting memory cards............................... 31 4 K button Playback ...................................................... 46, 177 5 Monitor Viewing settings................................................... 9 Live view ....................................................... 49, 57 Viewing pictures ................................................ 46 Full-frame playback.........................................177 6 G button Menu............................................................ 18, 207 7 c/b button Retouch ....................................................... 69, 261 Picture Control........................................... 50, 129 8 L/U button Help....................................................................... 18 Protect ................................................................188 White balance.................................115, 117, 120 9 X/T button Playback zoom in .............................................187 Image quality/size ...................................... 93, 95

10 W/S button Playback zoom out/thumbnails.......... 185, 186 ISO sensitivity ................................................... 105 Auto ISO sensitivity control........................... 107 Two-button reset............................................. 151
11 Diopter adjustment control ................................ 33 12 A button
Using the AE/AF lock button ...... 102, 110, 244 13 Main command dial..................................... 12, 245 14 Multi selector.......................................................... 19 15 J (OK) button .............................................. 19, 241 16 Focus selector lock .............................................. 101 17 Memory card slot cover ....................................... 29 18 Ambient brightness sensor for automatic
monitor brightness control..................... 53, 250 19 Live view selector
Live view photography .................................... 49 Movie live view .................................................. 57 20 a button...........................................................49, 57 21 Infrared receiver (rear).......................................... 86 22 Memory card access lamp.............................29, 38 23 Speaker .................................................................... 67 24 R (info) button.................................................. 9, 11

4

The Mode Dial
The camera offers the modes Mode dial listed below. To choose a mode, press the mode dial lock release and rotate the mode dial.
X
Mode dial lock release
P, S, A, and M Modes Select these modes for full control over camera settings. · P--Programmed auto (0 75) · S--Shutter-priority auto (0 76) · A--Aperture-priority auto (0 77) · M--Manual (0 78)

Auto Modes

Select these modes for simple, point-and-shoot

photography.

· i Auto (0 35)

· j Auto (flash off) (0 35)

Scene Modes (0 40) The camera automatically optimizes settings to suit the selected scene. Match your selection to the scene being photographed.

U1 and U2 Modes (0 81) Store and recall customized shooting settings.
A Non-CPU Lenses
Non-CPU (0 285) lenses can be used only in modes A and M. Selecting another mode when a non-CPU lens is attached disables the shutter release.
5

The Release-Mode Dial
To choose a release mode, press the release mode dial lock release and turn the release mode dial to the desired setting (0 83).

Release mode dial lock release

X

Release mode dial

Mode

Description

S Single frame

One photograph is taken each time the shutterrelease button is pressed.

CL

Continuous low speed

The camera takes photographs at a slow rate while the shutter-release button is pressed.

CH

Continuous high speed

The camera takes photographs at a fast rate while the shutter-release button is pressed.

J Quiet shutter-release

As for single-frame, except that camera noise is reduced.

E Self-timer

Take pictures with the self-timer.

4 Remote control

Take pictures with an optional ML-L3 remote control.

MUP Mirror up

Raise the mirror before taking photographs.

6

The Control Panel
1 Color temperature indicator .............................120 2 Shutter speed ...................................................76, 78
Exposure compensation value .........................112 Flash compensation value.................................148 White balance fine-tuning ................................118 Color temperature ......................................115, 120 White balance preset number..........................121 Number of shots in exposure and flash
bracketing sequence .......................................153 Number of shots in WB bracketing
sequence ............................................................156 Number of intervals for interval timer
photography...................................................... 165 Focal length (non-CPU lenses) .........................172

3 MB-D14 battery indicator.................................. 233 4 Battery indicator.....................................................35 5 Flash mode............................................................ 144 6 Autofocus mode .....................................................97 7 Image size ................................................................95 8 Image quality ..........................................................93 9 White balance fine-tuning indicator .............. 118 10 White balance ...................................................... 115
X 11 Aperture stop indicator ...............................73, 288
12 Aperture (f-number).......................................77, 78 Aperture (number of stops)........................73, 288 Bracketing increment................................ 154, 156 Number of shots in ADL bracketing sequence............................................................ 158 Number of shots per interval ........................... 165 Maximum aperture (non-CPU lenses)............ 174 PC mode indicator............................................... 195
13 Memory card indicator (Slot 1) ....................30, 96 14 Memory card indicator (Slot 2) ....................30, 96 15 ISO sensitivity indicator ..................................... 105
Auto ISO sensitivity indicator ........................... 108 16 Interval timer indicator ...................................... 166
Time-lapse indicator........................................... 170

17 Metering ................................................................109 18 Flash sync indicator.............................................234 19 Flexible program indicator .................................. 75 20 Auto-area AF indicator ......................................... 99
AF-area mode indicator .....................................100 3D-tracking indicator............................................ 99 21 HDR indicator........................................................140 22 Multiple exposure indicator..............................161

23 Exposure and flash bracketing indicator....... 153 WB bracketing indicator .................................... 156 ADL bracketing indicator................................... 158
24 Bracketing progress indicator ........ 153, 156, 158 25 Exposure compensation indicator .................. 112 26 Flash compensation indicator.......................... 148 27 "K" (appears when memory remains for over
1000 exposures) ..................................................36 28 Number of exposures remaining........................36
Number of shots remaining before memory buffer fills ..............................................38, 84, 335
ISO sensitivity....................................................... 105 Preset white balance recording indicator ..... 122 Active D-Lighting amount ................................ 138 Time-lapse recording indicator........................ 170 Manual lens number .......................................... 174 Capture mode indicator..................................... 195 HDMI-CEC connection indicator...................... 205

7

The Viewfinder

X

1 Framing grid (displayed when On is selected for Custom Setting d2) ..........................................229
2 Focus points .......................................... 38, 101, 222 AF-area mode ......................................................... 99
3 AF area brackets..................................... 33, 37, 179 4 Focus indicator ..................................... 38, 102, 103 5 Metering.................................................................109 6 Autoexposure (AE) lock ......................................110 7 Shutter speed .................................................. 76, 78
Autofocus mode..................................................... 97 8 Aperture (f-number) ...................................... 77, 78
Aperture (number of stops) ....................... 73, 288 9 Flash compensation indicator ..........................148 10 Exposure compensation indicator...................112 11 ISO sensitivity indicator......................................105 12 ISO sensitivity........................................................105
Active D-Lighting amount.................................138 AF-area mode ......................................................... 99 13 Flash-ready indicator ................................... 39, 231

14 FV lock indicator .................................................. 149 15 Flash sync indicator............................................. 234 16 Aperture stop indicator............................... 73, 288 17 Exposure indicator ................................................ 78
Exposure compensation display...................... 112 Roll indicator......................................................... 243 18 Low battery warning ............................................ 35 19 Exposure and flash bracketing indicator ....... 153 WB bracketing indicator .................................... 156 ADL bracketing indicator................................... 158 20 Auto ISO sensitivity indicator ........................... 108 21 Number of exposures remaining....................... 36 Number of shots remaining before memory
buffer fills ..............................................38, 84, 335 Preset white balance recording indicator...... 122 Exposure compensation value .........................112 Flash compensation value................................. 148 22 "K" (appears when memory remains for over
1000 exposures) ................................................. 36

D No Battery
When the battery is totally exhausted or no battery is inserted, the display in the viewfinder will dim. This is normal and does not indicate a malfunction. The viewfinder display will return to normal when a fully-charged battery is inserted.
D The Control Panel and Viewfinder Displays
The brightness of the control panel and viewfinder displays varies with temperature, and the response times of the displays may drop at low temperatures. This is normal and does not indicate a malfunction.
8

The Information Display
Press the R button to display shutter speed, aperture, the number of exposures remaining, AF-area mode, and other shooting information in the monitor.

1 Shooting mode .........................................35, 40, 73 2 Flexible program indicator .................................. 75 3 Flash sync indicator.............................................234 4 Shutter speed ...................................................76, 78
Exposure compensation value .........................112 Flash compensation value.................................148 Number of shots in exposure and flash
bracketing sequence .......................................153 Number of shots in WB bracketing
sequence ............................................................156 Focal length (non-CPU lenses) .........................172 Color temperature ......................................115, 120 5 Color temperature indicator .............................120 6 Aperture stop indicator............................... 73, 288 7 Aperture (f-number) .......................................77, 78 Aperture (number of stops) ....................... 73, 288 Bracketing increment ................................154, 155 Number of shots in ADL bracketing
sequence ............................................................158 Maximum aperture (non-CPU lenses)............174

R button
X 8 Release mode..................................................... 6, 83 Continuous shooting speed ............................. 229 9 Exposure indicator .................................................78
Exposure compensation display...................... 112 Bracketing progress indicator
Exposure and flash bracketing..................... 153 WB bracketing.................................................. 156 10 HDR indicator ....................................................... 140 HDR exposure differential ................................. 140 11 Camera battery indicator .....................................35 12 MB-D14 battery type display............................ 232 MB-D14 battery indicator.................................. 232 13 "K" (appears when memory remains for over 1000 exposures) ..................................................36 14 Number of exposures remaining .......................36 Time-lapse recording indicator........................ 170 Manual lens number .......................................... 174 15 Fn button assignment ........................................ 242 16 AE-L/AF-L button assignment ............................ 244 17 Remote control mode ...........................................85 18 Long exposure noise reduction indicator ..... 218 19 Role played by card in slot 2................................96 20 White balance ...................................................... 115 White balance fine-tuning indicator .............. 118 21 Auto-area AF indicator....................................... 100 Focus points indicator........................................ 101 AF-area mode indicator ..................................... 100 3D-tracking indicator ......................................... 100 22 Image quality ..........................................................93 23 Image size ................................................................95 24 Flash mode............................................................ 144

9

X
25 Image area indicator ............................................. 90 26 Metering.................................................................109 27 Auto distortion control.......................................217 28 "Clock not set" indicator.............................. 28, 253 29 Image comment indicator.................................253 30 Copyright information........................................256 31 Exposure and flash bracketing indicator .......153
WB bracketing indicator.....................................156 ADL bracketing indicator ...................................158

32 ADL bracketing amount..................................... 138 33 Multiple exposure indicator.............................. 162 34 "Beep" indicator ................................................... 228 35 Exposure compensation indicator .................. 112 36 Flash compensation indicator .......................... 148 37 FV lock indicator .................................................. 149 38 Interval timer indicator ...................................... 166
Time-lapse indicator........................................... 170 39 GPS connection indicator.................................. 175 40 Depth-of-field preview button assignment...... 244 41 Vignette control indicator ................................. 218 42 Active D-Lighting indicator............................... 138 43 High ISO noise reduction indicator................. 218 44 Movie settings........................................................ 65 45 Autofocus mode .................................................... 97 46 Eye-Fi connection indicator .............................. 260 47 ISO sensitivity indicator ..................................... 105
ISO sensitivity ....................................................... 105 Auto ISO sensitivity indicator ........................... 108 48 Picture Control indicator.................................... 130

A Turning the Monitor Off
To clear shooting information from the monitor, press the R button twice more or press the shutter-release button halfway. The monitor will turn off automatically if no operations are performed for about 10 seconds.
A See Also
For information on choosing how long the monitor stays on, see Custom Setting c4 (Monitor off delay, 0 228). For information on changing the color of the lettering in the information display, see Custom Setting d8 (Information display, 0 231).
10

 Changing Settings in the Information Display
To change settings for the items listed below, press the R button in the information display. Highlight items using the multi selector and press J to view options for the highlighted item.
R button 1 Movie settings.........................................................65
X 2 High ISO noise reduction .................................. 218
3 Active D-Lighting ................................................ 137 4 Vignette control................................................... 218 5 Depth-of-field preview button assignment ..... 244 6 Fn button assignment ........................................ 242 7 AE-L/AF-L button assignment ............................ 244 8 Remote control mode ...........................................85 9 Long exposure noise reduction ....................... 218 10 Role played by card in Slot 2................................96
A Tool Tips
A tool tip giving the name of the selected item appears in the information display. Tool tips can be turned off using Custom Setting d4 (Screen Tips; 0 229).
11

The Command Dials
The main- and sub-command dials are used alone or in combination with other controls to adjust a variety of settings.

M/Y button Flash mode
Flash compensation

D button

X

Bracketing

AF-mode button
Autofocus mode AF-area mode

Sub-command dial

Mode dial
L/U button White balance
X/T button Image quality/size
W/S button ISO sensitivity
Auto ISO sensitivity control

Main command dial

E button Exposure compensation
Z/Q button Metering

12

 Scene Mode
Choose a scene (h; 0 40).

h mode Main command dial

Monitor

 Image Quality and Size

Set image quality (0 93).

X

+

Choose an image size (0 95).

X (T) button Main command dial
+

Control panel

 Autofocus
Choose an autofocus mode (0 98).

X (T) button Sub-command dial
+

Control panel

Choose an AF-area mode (0 100).

AF-mode button Main command dial Control panel
+

AF-mode button Sub-command dial Control panel

13

 ISO Sensitivity
Set ISO sensitivity (0 105).
+

Set auto ISO sensitivity control
X (0 107).

W (S) button Main command dial
+

Control panel

 Exposure
Choose a combination of aperture and shutter speed (mode P; 0 75).

W (S) button Sub-command dial Control panel

Choose a shutter speed (mode S or M; 0 76, 78).

Mode P Main command dial Control panel

Choose an aperture (mode A or M; 0 77, 78).

Mode S or M Main command dial

Control panel

Choose a metering option (mode P, S, A, or M; 0 109).

Mode A or M Sub-command dial Control panel
+
Z (Q) button Main command dial Control panel

14

Set exposure compensation (mode P, S, A, or M; 0 112).
+

E button Main command dial Control panel

Activate or cancel bracketing/

select number of shots in

bracketing sequence (mode P, S,

+

A, or M; 0 153).

X

Select bracketing increment (mode P, S, A, or M; 0 154).

D button Main command dial Control panel
+

 White Balance
Choose a white balance option (mode P, S, A, or M; 0 115).

D button Sub-command dial
+

Control panel

L (U) button Main command dial

Fine-tune white balance

(0 117), set color temperature

(0 120), or choose a white

+

balance preset (0 121) in mode

P, S, A, or M.

L (U) button Sub-command dial

Control panel Control panel

15

 Flash Settings
Choose a flash mode (0 144).
+

Set flash compensation (mode P,
X S, A, or M; 0 148).

M (Y) button Main command dial
+

Control panel

M (Y) button Sub-command dial Control panel

16

The BM-14 Monitor Cover
A clear plastic cover is provided with the camera to keep the monitor clean and protect it when the camera is not in use. To attach the cover, insert the projection on the top of the cover into the matching indentation above the camera monitor (q) and press the bottom of the cover until it clicks into place (w).
X
To remove the cover, hold the camera firmly and pull the bottom of the cover gently outwards as shown at right.
17

Camera Menus
Most shooting, playback, and setup options can be accessed from the camera menus. To view the menus, press the G button.

X Tabs Choose from the following menus: · D: Playback (0 207) · C: Shooting (0 214)
· A: Custom Settings (0 219)

G button
· B: Setup (0 249) · N: Retouch (0 261)
· O/m: My Menu or Recent settings (defaults to My Menu; 0 280)

Slider shows position in current menu.

Current settings are shown by icons.
Menu options Options in current menu.
d
If a d icon is displayed at the bottom left corner of the monitor, help can be displayed by pressing the L (U) button. A description of the currently selected option or menu will be displayed while the button is pressed. Press 1 or 3 to scroll through the display.
L (U) button

18

Using Camera Menus
The multi selector and J button are used to navigate the camera menus.

Move cursor up J button: select highlighted item

Cancel and return to previous menu

Select highlighted item or display sub-menu

Move cursor down

X

Follow the steps below to navigate the menus.

1 Display the menus.
Press the G button to display the menus.

2 Highlight the icon for the current menu.
Press 4 to highlight the icon for the current menu.
3 Select a menu.
Press 1 or 3 to select the desired menu.

G button

4 Position the cursor in the selected menu.
Press 2 to position the cursor in the selected menu.
19

5 Highlight a menu item.
Press 1 or 3 to highlight a menu item.

6 Display options.

Press 2 to display options for the selected menu

X

item.

7 Highlight an option.
Press 1 or 3 to highlight an option.

8 Select the highlighted item.
Press J to select the highlighted item. To exit without making a selection, press the G button.
Note the following: · Menu items that are displayed in gray are not currently available. · While pressing 2 generally has the same effect as pressing J, there are some
cases in which selection can only be made by pressing J. · To exit the menus and return to shooting mode, press the shutter-release button
halfway (0 39).

20

First Steps

Charge the Battery
The camera is powered by an EN-EL15 rechargeable Li-ion battery (supplied). To maximize shooting time, charge the battery in the supplied MH-25 battery charger before use. About 2 hours and 35 minutes are required to fully recharge the battery when no charge remains.

1 Connect the AC power cable.

X

Connect the power cable. The AC adapter plug should be

in the position shown at right; do not rotate.

2 Remove the terminal cover.
Remove the terminal cover from the battery.
3 Insert the battery.
Place the battery in the battery bay as shown in the illustration on the charger.

4 Plug the charger in.
The CHARGE lamp will flash slowly while the battery charges.
D Charging the Battery
Charge the battery indoors at ambient temperatures between 5­35°C (41­95°F). The battery will not charge if its temperature is below 0°C (32°F) or above 60°C (140°F).

Battery Charging charging complete

5 Remove the battery when charging is complete.
Charging is complete when the CHARGE lamp stops flashing. Unplug the charger and remove the battery.
21

A The AC Wall Adapter
Depending on the country or region of purchase, an AC wall adapter may also be supplied with the charger. To use the adapter, insert it into the charger AC inlet (q). Slide the AC wall adapter latch in the direction shown (w) and rotate the adapter 90 ° to fix it in the position shown (e). Reverse these steps to remove the adapter.
X

AC wall adapter latch

90 °

22

Insert the Battery
Before inserting the battery, rotate the power switch to OFF.
D Inserting and Removing Batteries
Always turn the camera off before inserting or removing batteries.
1 Open the battery-chamber cover.
Unlatch (q) and open (w) the battery-chamber cover.
X
2 Insert the battery.
Insert the battery in the orientation shown (q), using the battery to keep the orange battery latch pressed to one side. The latch locks the battery in place when the battery is fully inserted (w).

3 Close the battery-chamber cover.

Battery latch

A Removing the Battery
Turn the camera off and open the battery-chamber cover. Press the battery latch in the direction shown by the arrow to release the battery and then remove the battery by hand.
23

D The Battery and Charger
Read and follow the warnings and cautions on pages xviii­xix and 306­308 of this manual. Do not use the battery at ambient temperatures below 0°C/32°F or above 40 °C/104 °F; failure to observe this precaution could damage the battery or impair its performance. Capacity may be reduced and charging times may increase at battery temperatures from 0°C/32°F to 15°C/59°F and from 45°C/113°F to 60°C/140°F. If the CHARGE lamp flashes quickly (about eight times a second) during charging, confirm that the temperature is in the correct range and then unplug the charger and remove and reinsert the battery. If the problem persists, cease use immediately and take battery and
X charger to your retailer or a Nikon-authorized service representative.
Do not short the charger terminals; failure to observe this precaution could result in overheating and damage to the charger. Do not move the charger or touch the battery during charging. Failure to observe this precaution could in very rare instances result in the charger showing that charging is complete when the battery is only partially charged. Remove and reinsert the battery to begin charging again. Battery capacity may temporarily drop if the battery is charged at low temperatures or used at a temperature below the temperature at which it was charged. If the battery is charged at a temperature below 5 °C (41 °F), the battery life indicator in the Battery info (0 255) display may show a temporary decrease. The battery may be hot immediately after use. Wait for the battery to cool before recharging. The supplied power cable and AC wall adapter are for use with the MH-25 only. Use the charger with compatible batteries only. Unplug when not in use. A marked drop in the time a fully charged battery retains its charge when used at room temperature indicates that it requires replacement. Purchase a new EN-EL15 battery.
A EN-EL15 Rechargeable Li-ion Batteries
The supplied EN-EL15 shares information with compatible devices, enabling the camera to show battery charge state in six levels (0 35). The Battery info option in the setup menu details battery charge, battery life, and the number of pictures taken since the battery was last charged (0 255).
24

Attach a Lens
Care should be taken to prevent dust from entering the camera when the lens is removed. The lens generally used in this manual for illustrative purposes is an AF-S NIKKOR 24-120mm f/4G ED VR.

Focal length scale index

Focal length scale Lens hood
Lens cap

Mounting index CPU contacts (0 287)
X
Rear lens cap

Focus mode switch (0 26, 103)

Zoom ring
1 Turn the camera off. 2 Remove the rear lens cap and the
camera body cap.

Vibration reduction ON/OFF switch Vibration reduction mode switch Focus ring (0 55, 103)

25

3 Attach the lens.
Keeping the mounting index on the lens aligned with the mounting index on the camera body, position the lens in the camera's bayonet mount (q). Being careful not to press the lens-release button, rotate the lens counter-clockwise until it clicks into place (w).
X
If the lens is equipped with an A-M or M/A-M mode switch, select A (autofocus) or M/A (autofocus with manual override).
A Detaching the Lens
Be sure the camera is off when removing or exchanging lenses. To remove the lens, press and hold the lens release button (q) while turning the lens clockwise (w). After removing the lens, replace the lens caps and camera body cap.
D CPU Lenses with Aperture Rings
In the case of CPU lenses equipped with an aperture ring (0 287), lock aperture at the minimum setting (highest f-number).
A Image Area
The DX format image area is automatically selected when a DX lens is attached (0 89).
Image area
26

Basic Setup
A language-selection dialog will be displayed the first time the camera is turned on. Choose a language and set the time and date. Photographs can not be taken until you have set the time and date.

1 Turn the camera on.
A language-selection dialog will be displayed.

2 Select a language.

X

Press 1 or 3 to highlight the desired language

and press J.

3 Choose a time zone.
A time-zone selection dialog will be displayed. Press 4 or 2 to highlight the local time zone (the UTC field shows the difference between the selected time zone and Coordinated Universal Time, or UTC, in hours) and press J.
4 Choose a date format.
Press 1 or 3 to choose the order in which the year, month, and day will be displayed. Press J to proceed to the next step.
5 Turn daylight saving time on or off.
Daylight saving time options will be displayed. Daylight saving time is off by default; if daylight saving time is in effect in the local time zone, press 1 to highlight On and press J.
6 Set the date and time.
The dialog shown at right will be displayed. Press 4 or 2 to select an item, 1 or 3 to change. Press J to set the clock and exit to shooting mode.

27

A Setting the Clock
Language and date/time settings can be changed at any time using the Language (0 253) and Time zone and date (0 253) options in the setup menu. The camera clock can also be synchronized with GPS devices (0 175).
A The Clock Battery
The camera clock is powered by an independent, rechargeable power source, which is charged as necessary when the main battery is installed or the camera is powered by an optional EP-5B power connector and EH-5b AC adapter (0 297). Two days of charging will power the clock for about three months. If the camera displays a warning at startup stating
X that the clock is not set and a B icon flashes in the information display, the clock battery is exhausted and the clock has been reset. Set the clock to the correct time and date. A The Camera Clock The camera clock is less accurate than most watches and household clocks. Check the clock regularly against more accurate time pieces and reset as necessary.
28

Insert a Memory Card
The camera stores pictures on Secure Digital (SD) memory cards (available separately; 0 334). The camera has two memory card slots (Slot 1 and Slot 2); if you will be using only one memory card, insert it in Slot 1 (0 30).

1 Turn the camera off.

A Inserting and Removing Memory Cards

Always turn the camera off before inserting or removing memory cards.

X

2 Open the card slot cover.
Slide the card slot cover out (q) and open the card slot
(w).

3 Insert the memory card.
Holding the memory card as shown at right, slide it in until it clicks into place. The memory card access lamp will light for a few seconds.

D Inserting Memory Cards
Inserting memory cards upside down or backwards could damage the camera or the card. Check to be sure the card is in the correct orientation. The card slot cover will not close if the card is not correctly inserted.

Front Memory card access lamp

Close the memory card slot cover. If this is the first time the memory card will be used in the camera or the card has been formatted in another device, format the card as described on page 31.

16GB 16GB

A Removing Memory Cards
After confirming that the memory card access lamp is off, turn the camera off, open the memory card slot cover, and press the card in to eject it (q). The card can then be removed by hand (w).
29

A No Memory Card
If the camera is turned off with a charged EN-EL15 battery and no memory card inserted, S will be displayed in the control panel and viewfinder.

A Using Two Memory Cards
Slot 1 is for the main card; the card in slot 2 plays a backup or
X secondary role. If the default setting of Overflow is selected for Role played by card in Slot 2 (0 96) when two memory cards are inserted, the card in slot 2 will only be used when the card in slot 1 is full.

Slot 1

The control panel shows the slot or slots that currently hold a memory card (the example at right shows the icons displayed when a card is inserted in each slot). If the memory card is full or locked or an error has occurred, the icon for the affected card will flash (0 324).

Slot 2 Control panel

Information display
D Memory Cards
· Memory cards may be hot after use. Observe due caution when removing memory cards from the camera.
· Turn the power off before inserting or removing memory cards. Do not remove memory cards from the camera, turn the camera off, or remove or disconnect the power source during formatting or while data are being recorded, deleted, or copied to a computer. Failure to observe these precautions could result in loss of data or in damage to the camera or card.
· Do not touch the card terminals with your fingers or metal objects. · Do not bend, drop, or subject to strong physical shocks. · Do not apply force to the card casing. Failure to observe this precaution could damage
the card. · Do not expose to water, heat, high levels of humidity, or direct sunlight. · Do not format memory cards in a computer.
30

Format the Memory Card
Memory cards must be formatted before first use or after being used or formatted in other devices.
D Formatting Memory Cards
Formatting memory cards permanently deletes any data they may contain. Be sure to copy any photographs and other data you wish to keep to a computer before proceeding (0 193).

1 Turn the camera on.
2 Press the O (Q) and Z (Q) buttons.
Hold the O (Q) and Z (Q) buttons down simultaneously until a flashing C (format) appears in the shutter-speed displays in the control panel and viewfinder. If two memory cards are inserted, the card in Slot 1 (0 30) will be selected; you can choose the card in Slot 2 by rotating the main command dial. To exit without formatting the memory card, wait until C stops flashing (about six seconds) or press any button other than the O (Q) and Z (Q) buttons.

X
O (Q) button Z (Q) button

3 Press the O (Q) and Z (Q) buttons again.
Press the O (Q) and Z (Q) buttons together a second time while C is flashing to format the memory card. Do not remove the memory card or remove or disconnect the power source during formatting.
When formatting is complete, the control panel and viewfinder will show the number of photographs that can be recorded at current settings.

31

A The Write Protect Switch
SD memory cards are equipped with a write protect switch to prevent accidental loss of data. When this switch is in the "lock" position, the memory card can not be formatted and photos can not be deleted or recorded (a warning will be displayed in the monitor if you attempt to release the shutter). To unlock the memory card, slide the switch to the "write" position.

16GB

Write-protect switch

A See Also
X See page 250 for information on formatting memory cards using the Format memory card
option in the setup menu.

32

Adjust Viewfinder Focus
The camera is equipped with diopter adjustment to accommodate individual differences in vision. Check that the display in the viewfinder is in focus before framing pictures in the viewfinder.

1 Turn the camera on.
Remove the lens cap and turn the camera on.

2 Focus the viewfinder.

X

Rotate the diopter adjustment control until

the AF area brackets are in sharp focus. When

operating the diopter adjustment control with

your eye to the viewfinder, be careful not to

put your fingers or fingernails in your eye.

AF area brackets

A Adjusting Viewfinder Focus
If you are unable to focus the viewfinder as described above, select single-servo autofocus (AF-S; 0 97), single-point AF (0 99), and the center focus point (0 101), and then frame a high-contrast subject in the center focus point and press the shutter-release button halfway to focus the camera. With the camera in focus, use the diopter adjustment control to bring the subject into clear focus in the viewfinder. If necessary, viewfinder focus can be further adjusted using optional corrective lenses (0 297).
33

X
34

sBasic Photography and Playback

"Point-and-Shoot" Photography

(i and j Modes)

This section describes how to take photographs in i (auto) mode, an

automatic "point-and-shoot" mode in which the majority of settings are controlled by the camera in response to shooting conditions, and

s

in which the flash will fire automatically if the subject is poorly lit. To

take photographs with the flash off while leaving the camera in

control of other settings, rotate the mode dial to j to select auto (flash off) mode.

Step 1: Turn the Camera On
1 Turn the camera on.
Remove the lens cap and turn the camera on. The control panel will turn on and the display in the viewfinder will light.

2 Check the battery level.
Check the battery level in the control panel or viewfinder.

Control panel * Viewfinder *

Description

L

-- Battery fully charged.

K

--

J

-- Battery partially discharged.

I

--

H

d Low battery. Charge battery or ready spare battery.

H (flashes)

d (flashes)

Shutter release disabled. Charge or exchange battery.

* No icon displayed when camera is powered by optional EP-5B power connector and

EH-5b AC adapter. V appears in information display.

A Image Sensor Cleaning
The camera vibrates the low-pass filter covering the image sensor to remove dust when the camera is turned on or off (0 301).
35

3 Check the number of exposures

remaining.

The control panel and viewfinder show the

number of photographs that can be taken at

current settings (values over 1,000 are rounded

down to the nearest hundred; e.g., values

between 2,000 and 2,099 are shown as 2.0 K). If two memory cards are inserted,

the displays show the space available on the card in Slot 1 (0 30). When the

number of exposures remaining reaches A, the number will flash, n or j

will flash in the shutter-speed displays, and the icon for the affected card will

s

flash. Insert another memory card (0 29) or delete some photos (0 47, 189).

Step 2: Select i or j Mode

To shoot where use of a flash is prohibited, photograph infants, or capture natural lighting under low light conditions, rotate the mode dial to j. Otherwise, rotate the mode dial to i.

Mode dial

j mode

i mode

A Camera Off Display
If the camera is turned off with a battery and memory card inserted, the memory card icon and number of exposures remaining will be displayed (some memory cards may in rare cases only display this information when the camera is on).
36

Control panel

Step 3: Frame the Photograph

1 Ready the camera.

When framing photographs in the viewfinder,

hold the handgrip in your right hand and cradle

the camera body or lens with your left. Keep

your elbows propped lightly against your torso

for support and place one foot half a pace ahead

of the other to keep your upper body stable.

When framing photographs in portrait (tall)

orientation, hold the camera as shown in the

s

bottom of the three illustrations at right.

In j mode, shutter speeds slow when lighting is poor; use of a tripod is recommended.

2 Frame the photograph.
Frame a photograph in the viewfinder with the main subject in the AF area brackets.

AF area brackets

A Using a Zoom Lens
Use the zoom ring to zoom in on the subject so that it fills a larger area of the frame, or zoom out to increase the area visible in the final photograph (select longer focal lengths on the lens focal length scale to zoom in, shorter focal lengths to zoom out).

Zoom in Zoom ring

Zoom out
37

Step 4: Focus
1 Press the shutter-release button halfway.
Press the shutter-release button halfway to focus. The active focus point will be displayed. If the subject is poorly lit, the flash may pop up and the AF-assist illuminator may light.

2 Check the indicators in the viewfinder.

When the focus operation is complete, the in-

s

focus indicator (I) will appear in the viewfinder.

Focus point

In-focus

indicator

Description

I Subject in focus.

2 4 Focus point is between camera and subject.

2 4 Focus point is behind subject.

2 4 Camera unable to focus using autofocus.

(flashes) See page 98.

In-focus indicator

Buffer capacity

While the shutter-release button is pressed halfway, the number of exposures that can be stored in the memory buffer ("t"; 0 84) will be displayed in the viewfinder.

Step 5: Shoot
Smoothly press the shutter-release button the rest of the way down to release the shutter and record the photograph. The memory card access lamp next to the memory card slot cover will light while the photograph is being recorded to the memory card. Do not eject the memory card or remove or disconnect the power source until the lamp has gone out and recording is complete.

Memory card access lamp

38

A The Shutter-Release Button
The camera has a two-stage shutter-release button. The camera focuses when the shutterrelease button is pressed halfway. To take the photograph, press the shutter-release button the rest of the way down.

Focus: press halfway

Shoot: press all the way down

A The Standby Timer
The viewfinder and the control panel shutter speed and aperture displays will turn off if no
s operations are performed for about 6 seconds, reducing the drain on the battery. Press the
shutter-release button halfway to reactivate the display. The length of time before the standby timer expires automatically can be selected using Custom Setting c2 (Standby timer, 0 227).

Exposure meters on

Exposure meters off

Exposure meters on

A The Built-in Flash
If additional lighting is required for correct exposure in i mode, the built-in flash will pop up automatically when the shutter-release button is pressed halfway. If the flash is raised, photographs can only be taken when the flash-ready indicator (M) is displayed. If the flashready indicator is not displayed, the flash is charging; remove your finger briefly from the shutter-release button and try again.

To save power when the flash is not in use, press it gently downward until the latch clicks into place.

39

Creative Photography (Scene Modes)
The camera offers a choice of "scene" modes. Choosing a scene mode automatically optimizes settings to suit the selected scene, making creative photography as simple as selecting a mode, framing a picture, and shooting as described on pages 35­39.
 h Mode
To view the currently selected scene, rotate the mode dial to h and press the R button. To choose another scene, rotate the main command dial.
Mode dial
s

Portrait
k

Landscape
l

Party/indoor Beach/snow
st

Autumn colors
z

Child
p
Sunset
u
Food
0

Main command dial

Monitor

Sports
m

Close up
n

Night portrait
o

Night landscape
r

Dusk/dawn Pet portrait Candlelight

v

w

x

Blossom
y

Silhouette
1

High key
2

Low key
3

40

 Scene Modes
k Portrait

p Child

s

Use for portraits with soft, natural-

Use for snapshots of children. Clothing

looking skin tones. If the subject is far and background details are vividly

from the background or a telephoto lens rendered, while skin tones remain soft

is used, background details will be

and natural.

softened to lend the composition a

sense of depth.

l Landscape

m Sports

Use for vivid landscape shots in daylight. The built-in flash and AF-assist illuminator turn off; use of a tripod is recommended to prevent blur when lighting is poor.

Fast shutter speeds freeze motion for dynamic sports shots in which the main subject stands out clearly. The built-in flash and AF-assist illuminator turn off. To take a sequence of shots, select continuous release mode (0 6, 83).

41

n Close Up

r Night Landscape

s Use for close-up shots of flowers, insects,
and other small objects (a macro lens can be used to focus at very close ranges). Use of a tripod is recommended to prevent blur.

Reduce noise and unnatural colors when photographing night landscapes, including street lighting and neon signs. The built-in flash and AF-assist illuminator turn off; use of a tripod is recommended to prevent blur.

o Night Portrait

s Party/Indoor

Use for a natural balance between the main subject and the background in portraits taken under low light. Use of a tripod is recommended to prevent blur when lighting is poor.

Capture the effects of indoor background lighting. Use for parties and other indoor scenes.

42

t Beach/Snow

v Dusk/Dawn

Capture the brightness of sunlight expanses of water, snow, or sand. The built-in flash and AF-assist illuminator turn off.

Preserves the colors seen in the weak s
natural light before dawn or after sunset. The built-in flash and AF-assist illuminator turn off; use of a tripod is recommended to prevent blur when lighting is poor.

u Sunset

w Pet Portrait

Preserves the deep hues seen in sunsets and sunrises. The built-in flash and AFassist illuminator turn off; use of a tripod is recommended to prevent blur when lighting is poor.

Use for portraits of active pets. The AFassist illuminator turns off.

43

x Candlelight

z Autumn Colors

s For photographs taken by candlelight.
The built-in flash turns off; use of a tripod
is recommended to prevent blur when
lighting is poor.

Captures the brilliant reds and yellows in autumn leaves. The built-in flash turns off; use of a tripod is recommended to prevent blur when lighting is poor.

y Blossom

0 Food

Use for fields of flowers, orchards in bloom, and other landscapes featuring expanses of blossoms. The built-in flash turns off; use of a tripod is recommended to prevent blur when lighting is poor.

Use for vivid photographs of food. Use of a tripod is recommended to prevent blur; the flash can also be used (0 143).

44

1 Silhouette

3 Low Key

Silhouette subjects against bright backgrounds. The built-in flash turns off; use of a tripod is recommended to prevent blur when lighting is poor.

Use when shooting dark scenes to create s
dark, somber images that bring out highlights. The built-in flash turns off; use of a tripod is recommended to prevent blur when lighting is poor.

2 High Key

Use when shooting bright scenes to create bright images that seem filled with light. The built-in flash turns off.
45

Basic Playback

1 Press the K button.
A photograph will be displayed in the monitor. The memory card containing the picture currently displayed is shown by an icon.

K button

2 View additional pictures.

s

Additional pictures can be displayed by

pressing 4 or 2. To view additional

information on the current photograph,

press 1 and 3 (0 179).

1/12

NIKON D600

To end playback and return to shooting mode, press the shutter-release button halfway.

1/ 125 F5. 6 100

85mm

0, 0 100ND600 DSC_0001. JPG 15/04/2012 10: 02: 28

NORMAL 6016x4016

A Image Review
When On is selected for Image review in the playback menu (0 212), photographs are automatically displayed in the monitor for a few seconds after shooting.
A See Also
See page 178 for information on choosing a memory card slot.
46

Deleting Unwanted Photographs
To delete the photograph currently displayed in the monitor, press the O (Q) button. Note that photographs can not be recovered once deleted.

1 Display the photograph.
Display the photograph you wish to delete as described on the preceding page. The location of the current image is shown by an icon at the bottom left corner of the display.

2 Delete the photograph.

s

Press the O (Q) button. A confirmation

dialog will be displayed; press the O (Q)

button again to delete the image and return

to playback. To exit without deleting the

picture, press K.

O (Q) button

A Delete
To delete selected images (0 190), all images taken on a selected date (0 191), or all images in a chosen location on a selected memory card (0 190), use the Delete option in the playback menu.
47

s
48

xLive View Photography
Follow the steps below to take photographs in live view.
1 Rotate the live view selector to C (live view
photography).
D Cover the Viewfinder
To prevent light entering via the viewfinder from interfering with exposure, remove the rubber eyecup and cover the viewfinder with the supplied DK-5 eyepiece cap before shooting (0 86).

x Live view selector

2 Press the a button.
The mirror will be raised and the view through the lens will be displayed in the camera monitor. The subject will no longer be visible in the viewfinder.
a button
3 Position the focus point.
Position the focus point over your subject as described on page 51.
4 Focus.
Press the shutter-release button halfway to focus.
The focus point will flash green while the camera focuses. A AE-L/AF-L button If the camera is able to focus, the focus point will be displayed in green; if the camera is unable to focus, the focus point will flash red (note that pictures can be taken even when the focus point flashes red; check focus in the monitor before shooting). Exposure can be locked by pressing the A AE-L/AF-L button (0 110); focus locks while the shutter-release button is pressed halfway. In mode M, exposure can be adjusted with the assistance of an exposure indicator (0 78).

49

5 Take the picture.
Press the shutter-release button the rest of the way down to shoot. The monitor will turn off.
6 Exit live view mode.
Press the a button to exit live view mode.

D Ending Live View

x

Live view ends automatically if the lens is removed. Live view may also end

automatically to prevent damage to the camera's internal circuits; exit live view when

the camera is not in use. Note that the temperature of the camera's internal circuits

may rise and noise (bright spots, randomly-spaced bright pixels, or fog) may be

displayed in the following instances (the camera may also become noticeably warm,

but this does not indicate a malfunction):

· The ambient temperature is high

· The camera has been used for extended periods in live view or to record movies

· The camera has been used in continuous release mode for extended periods

If live view does not start when you press the a button, wait for the internal circuits to

cool and then try again.

A Choosing a Picture Control (P, S, A, and M Modes Only)
Pressing c (b) during live view displays a list of Picture Controls. Highlight the desired Picture Control and press 2 to adjust Picture Control settings (0 129).

c (b) button
A Movies
Movie recording is not available during live view photography and pressing the movie-record button has no effect. Select movie live view (0 57) to shoot movies.

50

Focusing in Live View
To focus using autofocus, rotate the focus-mode selector to AF and follow the steps below to choose autofocus and AF-area modes. For information on focusing manually, see page 55.

Focus-mode selector

 Choosing a Focus Mode
The following autofocus modes are available in live view:

Mode

Description

AF-S

Single-servo AF: For stationary subjects. Focus locks when shutter-release button is pressed halfway.

x

AF-F

Full-time servo AF: For moving subjects. Camera focuses continuously until shutterrelease button is pressed. Focus locks when shutter-release button is pressed halfway.

To choose an autofocus mode, press the AF-mode button and rotate the main command dial until the desired mode is displayed in the monitor.

AF-mode button Main command dial

Monitor

D Using Autofocus in Live View
Use an AF-S lens. The desired results may not be achieved with other lenses or teleconverters. Note that in live view, autofocus is slower and the monitor may brighten or darken while the camera focuses. The focus point may sometimes be displayed in green when the camera is unable to focus. The camera may be unable to focus in the following situations: · The subject contains lines parallel to the long edge of the frame · The subject lacks contrast · The subject in the focus point contains areas of sharply contrasting brightness, or includes
spot lighting or a neon sign or other light source that changes in brightness · Flicker or banding appears under fluorescent, mercury-vapor, sodium-vapor, or similar
lighting · A cross (star) filter or other special filter is used · The subject appears smaller than the focus point · The subject is dominated by regular geometric patterns (e.g., blinds or a row of windows
in a skyscraper) · The subject is moving
51

 Choosing an AF-Area Mode
The following AF-area modes can be selected in live view:

Mode

Description

Face-priority AF: Use for portraits. The camera automatically detects and focuses on

portrait subjects; the selected subject is indicated by a double yellow border (if

!

multiple faces, up to a maximum of 35, are detected, the camera will focus on the closest subject; to choose a different subject, use the multi selector). If the camera can

no longer detect the subject (because, for example, the subject has turned to face

away from the camera), the border will no longer be displayed.

Wide-area AF: Use for hand-held shots of landscapes and other non-portrait subjects.

$ Use the multi selector to move the focus point anywhere in the frame, or press J to

position the focus point in the center of the frame.

x

Normal-area AF: Use for pin-point focus on a selected spot in the frame. Use the multi % selector to move the focus point anywhere in the frame, or press J to position the

focus point in the center of the frame. A tripod is recommended.

Subject-tracking AF: Position the focus point over your subject and press J. The focus

point will track the selected subject as it moves through the frame. To end tracking,

&

press J again. Note that the camera may be unable to track subjects if they move quickly, leave the frame or are obscured by other objects, change visibly in size, color,

or brightness, or are too small, too large, too bright, too dark, or similar in color or

brightness to the background.

To choose an AF-area mode, press the AF-mode button and rotate the sub-command dial until the desired mode is displayed in the monitor.

AF-mode button Sub-command dial

Monitor

52

The Live View Display: Live View Photography
er
q t

y

w

u

x

Item q Time remaining w Guide e Autofocus mode r AF-area mode t Focus point
y Monitor brightness indicator
u Exposure indicator

Description

0

The amount of time remaining before live view ends automatically. Displayed if shooting will end in 30 s or less.

56

A guide to the options available during live view photography. --

The current autofocus mode.

51

The current AF-area mode.

52

The current focus point. The display varies with the option selected for AF-area mode.

49

Keeping the L (U) button pressed, press 1 or 3 to adjust

monitor brightness (note that monitor brightness has no

effect on photographs taken with the camera). If A (auto) is selected, the camera will automatically adjust brightness in

--

response to ambient lighting conditions as measured by the

ambient brightness sensor when the monitor is on (0 4).

Indicates whether the photograph would be under- or overexposed at current settings (mode M only).

78

53

D The Live View Display
Although they will not appear in the final picture, jagged edges, color fringing, moire, and bright spots may appear in the monitor, while bright bands may appear in some areas with flashing signs and other intermittent light sources or if the subject is briefly illuminated by a strobe or other bright, momentary light source. In addition, distortion may occur if the camera is panned horizontally or an object moves at high speed through the frame. Flicker and banding visible in the monitor under fluorescent, mercury vapor, or sodium lamps can be reduced using Flicker reduction (0 252), although they may still be visible in the final photograph at some shutter speeds. When shooting in live view mode, avoid pointing the camera at the sun or other strong light sources. Failure to observe this precaution could result in damage to the camera's internal circuitry.
A Exposure
Depending on the scene, exposure may differ from that which would be obtained when live
x view is not used. Metering in live view is adjusted to suit the live view display, producing
photographs with exposure close to what is seen in the monitor. In P, S, A, and M modes, exposure can be adjusted by ±5 EV (0 112). Note that the effects of values over +3 EV or under ­3 EV can not be previewed in the monitor.
54

The Information Display: Live View Photography

To hide or display indicators in the monitor during live view photography, press the R button.

Information on

Information off

x

Virtual horizon (0 258)

Framing guides

Manual Focus
To focus in manual focus mode (0 103), rotate the lens focus ring until the subject is in focus.

To magnify the view in the monitor up to about 19 × for precise focus, press the X (T) button. While the view through the lens is zoomed in, a navigation window will appear in a gray frame at the bottom right corner of the display. Use the multi selector to scroll to areas of the frame not visible in the monitor (available only if wide- or normal-area AF is selected for AFarea mode), or press W (S) to zoom out.

X (T) button

Navigation window
55

A Non-CPU Lenses
When using non-CPU lenses, be sure to enter the focal length and maximum aperture using the Non-CPU lens data option in the setup menu (0 172). Non-CPU lenses can be used only in A and M modes (0 73); aperture can be adjusted using the lens aperture ring.
D The Count Down Display
A count down will be displayed 30 s before live view ends automatically (0 53; the timer turns red if live view is about to end to protect the internal circuits or, if an option other than No limit is selected for Custom Setting c4--Monitor off delay > Live view; 0 228--5 s before the monitor is due to turn off automatically). Depending on shooting conditions, the timer may appear immediately when live view is selected. Note that although the count down does not appear during playback, live view will still end automatically when the timer expires.
x A HDMI If the camera is attached to an HDMI video device during live view photography, the camera monitor will remain on and the video device will display the view through the lens as shown at right. If the device supports HDMI-CEC, select Off for the HDMI > Device control option in the setup menu (0 205) before shooting in live view.
56

yMovie Live View
Movies can be recorded in live view.
1 Rotate the live view selector to 1 (movie live view).

Live view selector

2 Press the a button.

y

The mirror will be raised and the view through the lens will

be displayed in the camera monitor as it would appear in

the actual movie, modified for the effects of exposure. The

subject will no longer be visible in the viewfinder.

a button

A The 0 Icon
A 0 icon (0 61) indicates that movies can not be recorded.
A Before Recording
Before recording, choose an aperture (modes A and M only, 0 77, 78); you can also choose a Picture Control (modes P, S, A, and M only, 0 129) or color space (0 217). In modes P, S, A, and M, white balance (0 115) can be set at any time by pressing the L (U) button and rotating the main command dial.

3 Choose a focus mode (0 51).

4 Choose an AF-area mode (0 52).

57

5 Focus.
Frame the opening shot and focus as described in Steps 3 and 4 on pages 49 (for more information on focusing in movie live view, see page 51). Note that the number of subjects that can be detected in face-priority AF drops in movie live view.

A Exposure
The following settings can be adjusted in movie live view:

P, S, A M
Other shooting modes

Aperture -- --
--

Shutter speed -- 
--

ISO sensitivity -- 
--

Exposure compensation  --
--

In mode M, ISO sensitivity can be set to values between 100 and Hi 2 and shutter speed

y

to values between 1/25 s and 1/4,000 s (the slowest available shutter speed varies with

the frame rate; 0 65). In other modes, shutter speed and ISO sensitivity are adjusted

automatically. If the result is over- or under-exposed, exit and restart movie live view.

6 Start recording.
Press the movie-record button to start recording. A recording indicator and the time available are displayed in the monitor. Exposure is set using matrix metering and can be locked by pressing the A AE-L/AF-L button (0 110) or (in modes P, S, and A) altered by up to ±3 EV in steps of 1/3 EV using exposure compensation (0 112). In autofocus mode, focus can be locked by pressing the shutter-release button halfway.

Movie-record button Recording indicator

Time remaining
A Audio
The camera can record both video and sound; do not cover the microphone on the front of the camera during movie recording. Note that the built-in microphone may record sounds made by the lens during autofocus or vibration reduction.

58

7 End recording.
Press the movie-record button again to end recording. Recording will end automatically when the maximum length is reached, or the memory card is full.
A Maximum Length
The maximum length for individual movie files is 4 GB (for maximum recording times, see page 65); note that depending on memory card write speed, shooting may end before this length is reached (0 334).
A Taking Photographs
To take a photograph while recording is in progress, press the shutter-release button all the way down (if desired, shooting information display can be assigned to the Fn,
y depth-of-field preview,or AE-L/AF-L button and the button used to display camera still
photography settings before shooting; 0 247, 248). Movie recording will end (the footage recorded to that point will be saved) and the camera will return to live view. The photograph will be recorded at the current image area setting using a crop with an aspect ratio of 16 : 9. Photos will be taken with the flash off. Note that the exposure for photographs can not be previewed during movie live view; mode P, S, or A is recommended but accurate results can be achieved in mode M by using the Fn, depthof-field preview, or AE-L/AF-L button (0 247, 248), using the button to display shooting information and checking the exposure indicator. Exposure compensation for the photograph can be set to values between ­5 and +5 EV, but only values between ­3 and +3 can be previewed in the monitor (modes P, S, and A; 0 112).
D The Count-Down Display
A count down will be displayed 30 s before live view ends automatically (0 53). Depending on shooting conditions, the timer may appear immediately when movie recording begins. Note that regardless of the amount of recording time available, live view will still end automatically when the timer expires. Wait for the internal circuits to cool before resuming movie recording.
8 Exit live view mode.
Press the a button to exit live view mode.
59

Indices

If Index marking is selected for Custom Setting g1 (Assign Fn

button, 0 247), g2 (Assign preview button, 0 248), or g3

(Assign AE-L/AF-L button, 0 248), you can press the button

during recording to add indices that can be used to locate

frames during editing and playback (0 68). Up to 20 indices can

be added to each movie.

Index

y

A See Also
Frame size, microphone sensitivity, and card slot options are available in the Movie settings menu (0 65). Focus can be adjusted manually as described on page 55. The roles played by the J, Fn, depth-of-field preview, and A AE-L/AF-L buttons can be chosen using Custom Settings f1 (OK button (shooting mode); 0 241), g1 (Assign Fn button; 0 247), g2 (Assign preview button; 0 248), and g3 (Assign AE-L/AF-L button, 0 248), respectively (the last three options also allow you to lock exposure without having to keep a button pressed). Custom Setting g4 (Assign shutter button; 0 248) controls whether the shutter-release button can be used to start movie live view or to start and end movie recording.
60

The Live View Display: Movie Live View
ty q

w e

r

u

i

Item

Description

0y

q "No movie" icon

Indicates that movies can not be recorded.

--

w Headphone volume Volume of audio output to headphones.

62

e Microphone sensitivity Microphone sensitivity for movie recording.

62

Sound level for audio recording. Displayed in red if level is too

r Sound level

high; adjust microphone sensitivity accordingly. Left (L) and right (R) channel indicators appear when optional ME-1 or

62

other stereo microphone is used.

t

Time remaining (movie live view)

The recording time available for movies.

58

y Movie frame size

The frame size for movie recording.

65

u

Monitor brightness indicator

A monitor brightness indicator.

62

i Guide

A guide to the options available during movie live view.

62

A Using an External Microphone
The optional ME-1 stereo microphone can be used to record sound in stereo or to avoid recording lens noise caused by autofocus (0 298).
A Headphones
Third-party headphones can be used. Note that high sound levels may result in high volume; particular care should be taken when headphones are used.
61

 Adjusting Settings in the Live View Display
Microphone sensitivity, headphone volume, and monitor brightness can be adjusted as described below. Note that microphone sensitivity and headphone volume can not be adjusted during recording, and that brightness affects the monitor only (0 61); movies recorded with the camera are unaffected.
1 Highlight a setting.
Press and hold L (U) and press 4 or 2 to highlight the indicator for the desired setting.

L (U) button

2 y

Adjust the highlighted setting.

Keeping the L (U) button pressed, press 1 or 3 to

adjust the highlighted setting.

The Information Display: Movie Live View

To hide or display indicators in the monitor during movie live view, press the R button.

Information on

Information off

Virtual horizon (0 258)

Framing guides

62

Image Area
Regardless of the option selected for Image area in the shooting menu (0 89), all movies and photographs recorded in movie live view (0 57) have an aspect ratio of 16 : 9. Images recorded with On selected for Image area > Auto DX crop and a DX lens attached use a DX-based movie format, as do images recorded with DX (24×16) 1.5× selected for Image area > Choose image area. An FX-based movie format is used when FX (36 × 24) 1.0× is selected. A a icon is displayed when the DX-based movie format is selected.
y

A Movie Live View Photographs
The following table shows the size of photographs taken in movie live view:

Image area

Option

Size (pixels)

Print size (cm/in.) *

FX-based format (35.5 × 20.0 mm)

Large Medium
Small

6,016 × 3,376 4,512 × 2,528 3,008 × 1,688

50.9 × 28.6/20.1 × 11.3 38.2 × 21.4/15.0 × 8.4 25.5 × 14.3/10.0 × 5.6

DX-based format (23.5 × 13.2 mm)

Large Medium
Small

3,936 × 2,224 2,944 × 1,664 1,968 × 1,112

33.3 × 18.8/13.1 × 7.4 24.9 × 14.1/ 9.8 × 5.5 16.7 × 9.4/ 6.6 × 3.7

* Approximate size when printed at 300 dpi. Print size in inches equals image size in pixels divided by printer resolution in dots per inch (dpi; 1 inch = approximately 2.54 cm).

Image quality is determined by the option selected for Image quality in the shooting menu (0 93).

63

A HDMI
If the camera is connected to an HDMI device (0 204), the view through the lens will appear both in the camera monitor and on the HDMI device. The indicators that appear in the HDMI device during movie recording are shown at right. The camera monitor does not show the sound level or virtual horizon; indicators in the monitor and on the HDMI device can not be hidden or displayed using the R button. To use live view when the camera is connected to an HDMI-CEC device, select Off for HDMI > Device control in the setup menu (0 205).
A Remote Cords
If Record movies is selected for Custom Setting g4 (Assign shutter button, 0 248), the shutter-release buttons on optional MC-DC2 remote cords (0 298) can be used to start movie live view and to start and end movie recording.
y D Recording Movies Flicker, banding, or distortion may be visible in the monitor and in the final movie under fluorescent, mercury vapor, or sodium lamps or if the camera is panned horizontally or an object moves at high speed through frame (for information on reducing flicker and banding, see Flicker reduction, 0 252). Jagged edges, color fringing, moiré, and bright spots may also appear. Bright bands may appear in some areas of the frame with flashing signs and other intermittent light sources or if the subject is briefly illuminated by a strobe or other bright, momentary light source. When recording movies, avoid pointing the camera at the sun or other strong light sources. Failure to observe this precaution could result in damage to the camera's internal circuitry. Note that noise (randomly-spaced bright pixels, fog, or lines) and unexpected colors may appear if you zoom in on the view through the lens (0 55) during movie live view.
Flash lighting can not be used during movie live view.
Recording ends automatically if the lens is removed, the mode dial is rotated, or a remote control release mode is selected.
Live view may end automatically to prevent damage to the camera's internal circuits; exit live view when the camera is not in use. Note that the temperature of the camera's internal circuits may rise and noise (bright spots, randomly-spaced bright pixels, or fog) may be displayed in the following instances (the camera may also become noticeably warm, but this does not indicate a malfunction): · The ambient temperature is high · The camera has been used for extended periods in live view or to record movies · The camera has been used in continuous release mode for extended periods If live view does not start when you press the a button, wait for the internal circuits to cool and then try again.
64

Movie Settings

Use the Movie settings option in the shooting menu to adjust the following settings.

· Frame size/frame rate, Movie quality: Choose from the following options:

Frame size/frame rate Frame size (pixels) Frame rate *

Movie quality

Maximum length

Maximum bit rate (Mbps) ( high quality/Normal)

( high quality/Normal)

o/1 1920 × 1080

30p

p/2 1920 × 1080

25p

q/3 1920 × 1080

24p

r/4 1280 × 720

60p

s/5 1280 × 720

50p

24/12

20 min./ 29 min. 59 s

t/6 1280 × 720

30p

u/7 1280 × 720

25p

12/ 8

29 min. 59 s/ 29 min. 59 s

* Listed value. Actual frame rates for 60p, 50p, 30p, 25p, and 24p are 59.94, 50, 29.97, 25, and 23.976

fps respectively.

y

· Microphone: Turn the built-in or optional ME-1 stereo microphones on or off or

adjust microphone sensitivity. Choose Auto sensitivity to adjust sensitivity

automatically, Microphone off to turn sound recording off; to select microphone

sensitivity manually, select Manual sensitivity and choose a sensitivity.

· Destination: Choose the slot to which movies are recorded. The menu shows the time available on each card; recording ends automatically when no time remains.

65

1 Select Movie settings.
Press the G button to display the menus. Highlight Movie settings in the shooting menu and press 2.
G button
2 Choose movie options.
Highlight the desired item and press 2, then highlight an option and press J.
y
D Frame Size and Rate
Frame size and rate affects the distribution and amount of noise (randomly-spaced bright pixels, fog, or bright spots).
66

Viewing Movies

Movies are indicated by a 1 icon in full-frame playback (0 177). Press J to start playback.

1 icon

Length

Current position/total length

Movie progress bar Volume Guide

The following operations can be performed:

To

Use

Description

y

Pause

Pause playback.

Play
Rewind/ advance

J

Resume playback when movie is paused or during rewind/ advance.

Speed increases with each press, from

2× to 4× to 8× to 16×; keep pressed to skip to beginning or end of movie (first frame is indicated by h in top right corner of monitor, last frame by i). If playback is

paused, movie rewinds or advances one frame at a time; keep

pressed for continuous rewind or advance.

Skip 10 s

Rotate the main command dial to skip ahead or back 10 s.

Skip ahead/ back
Adjust volume Trim movie

Use sub-command dial to skip to next or previous index, or to skip to the last or first frame if the movie contains no indices.

X (T)/ W (S)

Press X (T) to increase volume, W (S) to decrease.

c (b) See page 69 for more information.

Exit

/K Exit to full-frame playback.

Return to shooting mode

Press the shutter-release button halfway to exit to shooting mode.

67

A The p Icon
Movies with indices (0 60) are indicated by a p icon in full-frame playback.
A The 2 Icon
2 is displayed in full-frame and movie playback if the movie was recorded without sound.
y
68

Editing Movies

Trim footage to create edited copies of movies or save selected frames as JPEG stills.

Option 9 Choose start/end point 4 Save selected frame

Description Create a copy from which the opening or closing footage has been removed. Save a selected frame as a JPEG still.

Trimming Movies
To create trimmed copies of movies:

1 Display a movie full frame.

Press the K button to display pictures full

frame in the monitor and press 4 and 2 to scroll through pictures until the movie you

y

wish to edit is displayed.

K button

2 Choose a starting or end point.
Play the movie back as described on page 67, pressing J to start and resume playback and 3 to pause and pressing 4 or 2 or rotating the main or sub-command dials to locate the desired frame (0 67). Your approximate position in the movie can be ascertained from the movie progress bar.

Movie progress bar

3 Display movie edit options.
Press the c (b) button to display movie edit options.

c (b) button

69

4 Select Choose start/end point.
Highlight Choose start/end point and press J.

The dialog shown at right will be displayed; choose whether the current frame will be the starting or end point of the copy and press J.

5 Delete frames.

y

If the desired frame is not currently displayed, press 4 or 2 to advance or

rewind (to skip to 10 s ahead or back, rotate

the main command dial; to skip to an index,

or to the first or last frame if the movie contains no indices, rotate the sub-

L (U) button

command dial). To switch the current selection from start point (w) to end point

(x) or vice versa, press L (U).

Once you have selected the start point and/ or end point, press 1. All frames before the selected start point and after the selected end point will be removed from the copy.

6 Save the copy.
Highlight one of the following and press J: · Save as new file: Save the copy to a new file. · Overwrite existing file: Replace the original
movie file with the edited copy. · Cancel: Return to Step 5. · Preview: Preview the copy.
Edited copies are indicated by a 9 icon in full-frame playback.

70

A Trimming Movies
Movies must be at least two seconds long. If a copy can not be created at the current playback position, the current position will be displayed in red in Step 5 and no copy will be created. The copy will not be saved if there is insufficient space available on the memory card. Copies have the same time and date of creation as the original.
A The Retouch Menu
Movies can also be edited using the Edit movie option in the retouch menu (0 261).
y
71

Saving Selected Frames
To save a copy of a selected frame as a JPEG still:

1 View the movie and choose a frame.
Play the movie back as described on page 67; your approximate position in the movie can be ascertained from the movie progress bar. Press 4 or 2 to rewind or advance and press 3 to pause the movie at the frame you intend to copy.

2 Display movie edit options.

Press the c (b) button to display movie

y

edit options.

c (b) button
3 Choose Save selected frame.
Highlight Save selected frame and press J.

4 Create a still copy.
Press 1 to create a still copy of the current frame.
5 Save the copy.
Highlight Yes and press J to create a finequality (0 93) JPEG copy of the selected frame. Movie stills are indicated by a 9 icon in full-frame playback.
A Save Selected Frame
JPEG movie stills created with the Save selected frame option can not be retouched. JPEG movie stills lack some categories of photo information (0 179).
72

#P, S, A, and M Modes
P, S, A, and M modes offer different degrees of control over shutter speed and aperture.
#
A Lens Types
When using a CPU lens equipped with an aperture ring (0 287), lock the aperture ring at the minimum aperture (highest f-number). Type G lenses are not equipped with an aperture ring. Non-CPU lenses can only be used in modes A (aperture-priority auto) and M (manual), when aperture can only be adjusted using the lens aperture ring. Selecting any other mode disables the shutter release.
A Non-CPU Lenses (0 285)
Use the lens aperture ring to adjust aperture. If the maximum aperture of the lens has been specified using the Non-CPU lens data item in setup menu (0 172) when a non-CPU lens is attached, the current f-number will be displayed in the viewfinder and control panel, rounded to the nearest full stop. Otherwise the aperture displays will show only the number of stops (F, with maximum aperture displayed as FA) and the f-number must be read from the lens aperture ring.
73

A Shutter Speed and Aperture
Two of the chief factors in determining exposure are shutter speed and aperture. By slowing shutter speed while increasing aperture, or increasing shutter speed while reducing aperture, you can achieve different effects while keeping exposure constant. Fast shutter speeds and large apertures freeze moving objects and soften background details, while slow shutter speeds and small apertures blur moving objects and bring out background details.

Shutter speed

Aperture

#

Fast shutter speed (1/1,600 s)

Slow shutter speed (1/6 s)

Large aperture (f/5.6) Small aperture (f/22) (Remember, the higher the f-number, the smaller the aperture.)

74

P: Programmed Auto
In this mode, the camera automatically adjusts shutter speed and aperture according to a built-in program to ensure optimal exposure in most situations. This mode is recommended for snapshots and other situations in which you want to leave the camera in charge of shutter speed and aperture.
#
A Flexible Program
In mode P, different combinations of shutter speed and aperture can be selected by rotating the main command dial while the exposure meters are on ("flexible program"). Rotate the dial to the right for large apertures (low f-numbers) that blur background details or fast shutter speeds that "freeze" motion. Main command dial Rotate the dial to the left for small apertures (high f-numbers) that increase depth of field or slow shutter speeds that blur motion. All combinations produce the same exposure. While flexible program is in effect, a U indicator appears in the control panel. To restore default shutter speed and aperture settings, rotate the main command dial until the indicator is no longer displayed, choose another mode, or turn the camera off.
A See Also
See page 315 for information on the built-in exposure program. For information on activating the exposure meters, see "The Standby Timer" on page 39.
75

S: Shutter-Priority Auto
In shutter-priority auto, you choose the shutter speed while the camera automatically selects the aperture that will produce the optimal exposure. Use slow shutter speeds to suggest motion by blurring moving subjects, fast shutter speeds to "freeze" motion.

Fast shutter speed (1/1,600 s)

Slow shutter speed (1/6 s)

To choose a shutter speed, rotate the main

command dial while the exposure meters are on.

Shutter speed can be set to "v" or to values

between 30 s and 1/4,000 s.
#

Main command dial

A See Also
See page 323 for information on what to do if flashing "A" or "%" indicator appears in the shutter-speed displays.
76

A: Aperture-Priority Auto
In aperture-priority auto, you choose the aperture while the camera automatically selects the shutter speed that will produce the optimal exposure. Large apertures (low f-numbers) increase flash range (0 147) and reduce depth of field, blurring objects behind and in front of the main subject. Small apertures (high f-numbers) increase depth of field, bringing out details in the background and foreground. Short field depths are generally used in portraits to blur background details, long field depths in landscape photographs to bring the foreground and background into focus.

Large aperture (f/5.6)

Small aperture (f/22)

To choose an aperture between the minimum and

maximum values for the lens, rotate the sub-

#

command dial while the exposure meters are on.

Sub-command dial

A Depth-of-Field Preview
To preview the effects of aperture, press and hold the depth-of-field preview button. The lens will be stopped down to the aperture value selected by the camera (modes P and S) or the value chosen by the user (modes A and M), allowing depth of field to be previewed in the viewfinder.
Depth-of-field preview button
A Custom Setting e5--Modeling Flash
This setting controls whether the built-in flash and optional flash units such as the SB-910, SB-900, SB-800, SB-700, and SB-600 (0 293) will emit a modeling flash when the depth-offield preview button is pressed. See page 241 for more information.
77

M: Manual

In manual exposure mode, you control both shutter speed and aperture. While the exposure meters are on, rotate the main command dial to choose a shutter speed, and the sub-command dial to set aperture. Shutter speed can be set to "v" or to values between 30 s and 1/4,000 s, or the shutter can be held open indefinitely for a long time-exposure (A, 0 79). Aperture can be set to values between the minimum and maximum values for the lens. Use the exposure indicators to check exposure.

Shutter speed

Aperture

Main command dial
#

Sub-command dial

A AF Micro NIKKOR Lenses
Provided that an external exposure meter is used, the exposure ratio need only be taken into account when the lens aperture ring is used to set aperture.

A The Exposure Indicator
If a shutter speed other than "bulb" or "time" is selected, the exposure indicator in the viewfinder shows whether the photograph would be under- or over-exposed at current settings. Depending on the option chosen for Custom Setting b2 (EV steps for exposure cntrl, 0 224), the amount of under- or over-exposure is shown in increments of 1/3 EV or 1/2 EV (the illustrations below show the display in the viewfinder when 1/3 step is selected for Custom Setting b2). If the limits of the exposure metering system are exceeded, the displays will flash.

Optimal exposure

Underexposed by 1/3 EV

Overexposed by over 2 EV

A See Also
For information reversing the exposure indicators so that negative values are displayed on the right and positive values on the left, see Custom Setting f8 (Reverse indicators, 0 246).
78

 Long Time-Exposures (M Mode Only)
Select the following shutter speeds for long timeexposures of moving lights, the stars, night scenery, or fireworks. · Bulb (A): The shutter remains open while
the shutter-release button is held down. To prevent blur, use a tripod or an optional MC-DC2 remote cord (0 298). · Time (%): Requires an optional ML-L3 remote control (0 298). Start the exposure by pressing the ML-L3 shutter-release button. The shutter remains open for thirty minutes or until the button is pressed a second time.

Length of exposure: 35 s Aperture: f/25

1 Ready the camera.

Mount the camera on a tripod or place it on a stable, level surface. To prevent light entering via the viewfinder interfering with exposure, remove the rubber

#

eyecup and cover the viewfinder with the supplied DK-5 eyepiece cap (0 86).

To prevent loss of power before the exposure is complete, use a fully charged

EN-EL15 battery or an optional EH-5b AC adapter and EP-5B power connector.

Note that noise (bright spots, randomly-spaced bright pixels, or fog) may be

present in long exposures; before shooting, choose On for Long exposure NR

in the shooting menu (0 218).

2 Rotate the mode dial to M.

Mode dial

79

3 Choose a shutter speed.
While the exposure meters are on, rotate the main command dial to choose a shutter speed of A.
Main command dial
For a shutter speed of "time" (%), select remote control release mode (0 85) after choosing the shutter speed.

4 Open the shutter.

Bulb: After focusing, press the shutter-release button on the camera or optional

remote cord all the way down. Keep the shutter-release button pressed until

#

the exposure is complete.

Time: Press the ML-L3 shutter-release button all the way down.

5 Close the shutter.
Bulb: Take your finger off the shutter-release button.
Time: Press the ML-L3 shutter-release button all the way down. Shooting ends automatically after thirty minutes.

80

$User Settings: U1 and U2 Modes

Assign frequently-used settings to the U1 and U2 positions on the mode dial.

Saving User Settings

1 Select a mode.
Rotate the mode dial to the desired mode.

Mode dial

2 Adjust settings.

Make the desired adjustments to flexible program (mode P), shutter speed

$

(modes S and M), aperture (modes A and M), exposure and flash compensation,

flash mode, focus point, metering, autofocus and AF-area modes, bracketing,

and settings in the shooting (0 214) and Custom Settings (0 219) menus (note

that the camera will not store the options selected for Storage folder, File

naming, Image area, Manage Picture Control, Multiple exposure, or

Interval timer shooting).

3 Select Save user settings.
Press the G button to display the menus. Highlight Save user settings in the setup menu and press 2.

4 Select Save to U1 or Save to U2.
Highlight Save to U1 or Save to U2 and press 2.

G button

81

5 Save user settings.
Highlight Save settings and press J to assign the settings selected in Steps 1 and 2 to the mode dial position selected in Step 4.

Recalling User Settings
Simply rotate the mode dial to U1 to recall the settings assigned to Save to U1, or to U2 to recall the settings assigned to Save to U2.

Mode dial

Resetting User Settings
To reset settings for U1 or U2 to default values:
$
1 Select Reset user settings.
Press the G button to display the menus. Highlight Reset user settings in the setup menu and press 2.
G button
2 Select Reset U1 or Reset U2.
Highlight Reset U1 or Reset U2 and press 2.

3 Reset user settings.
Highlight Reset and press J.

82

kRelease Mode
Choosing a Release Mode
To choose a release mode, press the release mode dial lock release and turn the release mode dial to the desired setting.

Mode

Description

S Single frame: Camera takes one photograph each time shutter-release button is pressed.

Continuous low speed: While shutter-release button is held down, camera records 1­5
CL frames per second. 1 Frame rate can be chosen using Custom Setting d5 (CL mode shooting speed, 0 229). Note that only one picture will be taken if the flash fires.

CH

Continuous high speed: While shutter-release button is held down, camera records up to 5.5 frames per second. 2 Note that only one picture will be taken if the flash fires.

k Quiet shutter-release: As for single frame, except that mirror does not click back into place

J while shutter-release button is fully pressed, allowing user to control timing of click made by mirror, which is also quieter than in single frame mode. In addition, beep

does not sound regardless of setting selected for Custom Setting d1 (Beep; 0 228).

E Self-timer: Use self-timer for self-portraits or to reduce blurring caused by camera shake (0 85).

4 Remote control: Shutter is controlled using shutter-release button on optional ML-L3 remote control (0 85).

Mirror up: Choose this mode to minimize camera shake in telephoto or close-up
MUP photography or in other situations in which the slightest camera movement can result
in blurred photographs.

1 Average frame rate with an EN-EL15 battery, continuous-servo AF, manual or shutter-priority auto exposure, a shutter speed of 1/200 s or faster, remaining settings other than Custom Setting d5 at default values, and memory remaining in memory buffer.
2 Average frame rate with an EN-EL15 battery, continuous-servo AF, manual or shutter-priority auto exposure, a shutter speed of 1/200 s or faster, other settings at default values, and memory remaining in memory buffer.

Frame rate drops at slow shutter speeds or very small apertures (high f-numbers), when vibration reduction (available with VR lenses) or auto ISO sensitivity control is on (0 105, 107), or when the battery is low.

83

A The Memory Buffer
The camera is equipped with a memory buffer for temporary storage, allowing shooting to continue while photographs are being saved to the memory card. Up to 100 photographs can be taken in succession; note, however, that the frame rate will drop when the buffer is full (t00). The approximate number of images that can be stored in the buffer at current settings is shown in the exposure-count displays in the viewfinder and control panel while the shutter-release button is pressed. The illustration at right shows the display when space remains in the buffer for about 28 pictures. While photographs are being recorded to the memory card, the access lamp next to the memory card slot will light. Depending on shooting conditions and memory card performance, recording may take from a few seconds to a few minutes. Do not remove the memory card or remove or disconnect the power source until the access lamp has gone out. If the camera is switched off while data remain in the buffer, the power will not turn off until all images in the buffer have been recorded. If the battery is exhausted while images remain in the buffer, the shutter release will be disabled and the images transferred to the memory card.
A Live View
If a continuous release mode is used during live view photography (0 49) or in movie live
k view (0 57), photographs will be displayed in place of the view through the lens while the shutter-release button is pressed. A See Also For information on choosing the maximum number of photographs that can be taken in a single burst, see Custom Setting d6 (Max. continuous release, 0 230). For information on the number of pictures that can be taken in a single burst, see page 335.
84

Self-Timer and Remote Control Modes

The self-timer and optional ML-L3 remote control (0 298) can be used to reduce camera shake or for self-portraits.
1 Mount the camera on a tripod.
Mount the camera on a tripod or place the camera on a stable, level surface.
2 Select a release mode.
Press the release mode dial lock release and rotate the release-mode dial to E (self-timer) or 4 (remote control) mode.

Release mode dial

In remote control mode, the timing of the

shutter release can be selected using the

Remote control mode option in the

shooting menu. After pressing the G

button to display the menus, highlight

Remote control mode in the shooting

G button

k

menu and press 2 to display the following

options. Press the selector up or down to highlight an option and press J.

Option

Description

%

Delayed remote

Shutter is released 2 s after ML-L3 shutter-release button is pressed.

$

Quick-response Shutter is released when ML-L3 shutter-release button is

remote

pressed.

&

Remote mirror-up

Press ML-L3 shutter-release button once to raise mirror, again to release shutter and take photograph. Prevents blur caused by camera moving when mirror is raised.

85

3 Frame the photograph.

A Cover the Viewfinder
When taking photos without your eye to the viewfinder, remove the DK-21 rubber eyecup (q) and insert the supplied DK-5 eyepiece cap as shown (w). This prevents light entering via the viewfinder interfering with exposure. Hold the camera firmly when removing the rubber eyecup.

DK-21 rubber eyecup

DK-5 eyepiece cap

4 Take the photograph.

Self-timer mode: Press the shutter-release

button halfway to focus, and then press the

button the rest of the way down to start the

self-timer (note that the timer will not start if the camera is unable to focus or in

other situations in which the shutter can not be released). The self-timer lamp

will start to flash. Two seconds before the photograph is taken, the self-timer

k

lamp will stop flashing. The shutter will be released ten seconds after the timer

starts.

Remote control mode: From a distance of 5 m (16 ft) or less, aim the transmitter on the ML-L3 at either of the infrared receivers on the camera (0 2, 4) and press the ML-L3 shutter-release button. In delayed remote mode, the self-timer lamp will light for about two seconds before the shutter is released. In quick-response remote mode, the self-timer lamp will flash after the shutter has been released. In remote mirrorup mode, pressing the ML-L3 shutter-release button once raises the mirror; the shutter will be released and the self-timer lamp will flash after 30 s or when the button is pressed a second time. Note that the remote control can not be used to record movies; even if Record movies is selected for Custom Setting g4 (Assign shutter button, 0 248), pressing the shutter-release button on the remote control will release the shutter and record a photograph.

To cancel shooting, select another release mode.

86

D Before Using the Remote Control
Before using the remote control for the first time, remove the clear plastic battery-insulator sheet.
D Using the Built-in Flash
Before taking a photograph with the flash in P, S, A, M, or 0 modes, press the M (Y) button to raise the flash and wait for the M indicator to be displayed in the viewfinder (0 143). Shooting will be interrupted if the flash is raised while remote control mode is in effect or after the self-timer has started. If the flash is required, the camera will only respond to the ML-L3 shutter-release button once the flash has charged. In auto or scene modes in which the flash pops up automatically, the flash will begin charging when remote control mode is selected; once the flash is charged, it will automatically pop up and fire when required. Note that only one photograph will be taken when the flash fires, regardless of the number of exposures selected for Custom Setting c3 (Self-timer; 0 227).
In flash modes that support red-eye reduction, the red-eye reduction lamp will light for about one second before the shutter is released. In delayed remote mode, the self-timer lamp will light for two seconds, followed by the red-eye reduction lamp which light for one second before the shutter is released.
A Focusing in Remote Control Mode
The camera will not adjust focus in remote mirror-up mode or when continuous-servo
k autofocus is selected; note however that if any autofocus mode is selected, you can focus by
pressing the camera shutter-release button halfway before shooting (pressing the button all the way down will not release the shutter). If auto- or single-servo autofocus is selected or the camera is in live view in delayed or quick-response remote mode, the camera will automatically adjust focus before shooting; if the camera is unable to focus in viewfinder photography, it will return to stand-by without releasing the shutter.
A Remote Mirror-up Mode
Metering is not performed in remote mirror-up mode. Photos can not be framed in the viewfinder while the mirror is raised.
AA
Time (bulb) exposures can not be recorded using the self-timer. A fixed shutter speed will be used if a speed of A is selected in mode M.
A See Also
For information on choosing the duration of the self-timer, the number of shots taken, and the interval between shots, see Custom Setting c3 (Self-timer; 0 227). For information on choosing the length of time the camera will remain in stand-by mode waiting for a signal from the remote control, see Custom Setting c5 (Remote on duration; 0 228). For information on controlling the beeps that sound when the self-timer and remote control are used, see Custom Setting d1 (Beep; 0 228).
87

Mirror up Mode
Choose this mode to minimize blurring caused by camera movement when the mirror is raised. Use of a tripod is recommended.
1 Select mirror up mode.
Press the release mode dial lock release and rotate the release mode dial to MUP.
Release mode dial
2 Raise the mirror.
Frame the picture, focus, and then press the shutter-release button the rest of the way down to raise the mirror.
D Mirror Up
While the mirror is raised, photos can not be framed in the viewfinder and autofocus and metering will not be performed.
k
3 Take a picture.
Press the shutter-release button all the way down again to take a picture. To prevent blurring caused by camera movement, press the shutter-release button smoothly, or use an optional remote cord (0 298). The mirror lowers when shooting ends.
A Mirror up Mode
A picture will be taken automatically if no operations are performed for about 30 s after the mirror is raised.
A See Also
For information on using the optional ML-L3 remote control for mirror-up photography, see page 85.
88

dImage Recording Options

Image Area

Choose the aspect ratio and angle of view (image area). Thanks to the camera's FX format (35.9 × 24 mm) image sensor, you can choose from angles of view as wide as those supported by 35 mm (135) format film cameras, while automatically cropping pictures to the DX angle of view when using DX format lenses. See page 335 for information on the number of pictures that can be stored at different image area settings.

 Auto DX Crop
Choose whether to automatically select a DX crop when a DX lens is attached.

Option

Description

Camera automatically selects DX crop when DX lens is

On attached. If another lens is attached, the crop selected for

Choose image area will be used.

Off Crop selected for Choose image area is used.

d

A DX Lenses
DX lenses are designed for use with DX format cameras and have a smaller angle of view than lenses for 35mm format cameras. If Auto DX crop is off and FX (36×24) 1.0× (FX format) is selected for Choose image area when a DX lens is attached, the edges of the image may be eclipsed. This may not be apparent in the viewfinder, but when the images are played back you may notice a drop in resolution or that the edges of the picture are blacked out.
89

 Choose Image Area
Choose the image area used when a non-DX lens is attached or a DX-lens is attached with Off selected for Auto DX crop (0 91).

Option
FX (36×24) c 1.0×
(FX format)
DX (24×16) a 1.5×
(DX format)

Description Images are recorded in FX format using the full area of the image sensor (35.9 × 24.0 mm), producing an angle of view equivalent to a NIKKOR lens on a 35 mm format camera. An area at the center of the image sensor 23.5 × 15.7 mm is used to record pictures in DX format. To calculate the approximate focal length of the lens in 35mm format, multiply by 1.5.

FX format (36×24) image circle
FX format

DX format (24×16) image circle
DX format

d

A Image Area
The selected option is shown in the information display.

A The Viewfinder Display
The DX format crop is shown at right; the area outside the crop can be
viewed in gray when Off is selected for Custom Setting a4 (AF point illumination, 0 222).

A See Also
See page 63 for information on the crops available in movie live view.

DX format

90

Image area can be set using the Image area option in the shooting menu or by pressing a control and rotating a command dial.
 The Image Area Menu

1 Select Image area in the shooting
menu.
Press G to display the menus. Highlight Image area in the shooting menu (0 214) and press 2.

G button

2 Choose an option.
Highlight Auto DX crop or Choose image area and press 2.

3 Adjust settings.

Choose an option and press J. The

selected crop is displayed in the viewfinder

d

(0 90).

91

 Camera Controls
1 Assign image area selection to a camera control.
Select Choose image area for a camera control in the Custom Settings menu (0 219). Image area selection can be assigned to the Fn button (Custom Setting f2, Assign Fn button, 0 242) or the depth-of-field preview button (Custom Setting f3, Assign preview button, 0 244).
2 Use the selected control to choose an image area.
The image area can be selected by pressing the selected button and rotating the main or subcommand dial until the desired crop is displayed in the viewfinder (0 90).

Fn button Main command dial

The option currently selected for image area can

be viewed by pressing the button to display the

image area in the control panel, viewfinder, or

d

information display. FX format is displayed as "36 ­ 24" and DX format as "24 ­ 16".

D Auto DX Crop
The selected control can not be used to select image area when a DX lens is attached and Auto DX crop is on.
A Image Size
Image size varies with the option selected for image area (0 95).
92

Image Quality and Size

Together, image quality and size determine how much space each photograph occupies on the memory card. Larger, higher quality images can be printed at larger sizes but also require more memory, meaning that fewer such images can be stored on the memory card (0 335).

Image Quality
Choose a file format and compression ratio (image quality).

Option File type

Description

Raw data from the image sensor are saved directly to the memory card.

NEF (RAW) NEF Settings such as white balance and contrast can be adjusted after

shooting.

JPEG fine

Record JPEG images at a compression ratio of roughly 1:4 (fine quality). *

JPEG normal

JPEG

Record JPEG images at a compression ratio of roughly 1:8 (normal quality). *

JPEG basic

Record JPEG images at a compression ratio of roughly 1:16 (basic quality). *

NEF (RAW)+

Two images are recorded, one NEF (RAW) image and one fine-quality

JPEG fine

JPEG image.

NEF (RAW)+ NEF/ Two images are recorded, one NEF (RAW) image and one normal-

JPEG normal JPEG quality JPEG image.

d

NEF (RAW)+

Two images are recorded, one NEF (RAW) image and one basic-quality

JPEG basic

JPEG image.

* Size priority selected for JPEG compression.

Image quality can be set by pressing the X (T) button and rotating the main command dial until the desired setting is displayed in the control panel.

X (T) button

Main command dial

Control panel

A The Shooting Menu
Image quality can also be adjusted using the Image quality option in the shooting menu (0 214).

93

The following options can be accessed from the shooting menu. Press the G button to display the menus, highlight the desired option and press 2.

 JPEG Compression
Choose the type of compression for JPEG images.

Option

Description

O Size priority Images are compressed to produce relatively uniform file size. P Optimal quality Optimal image quality. File size varies with scene recorded.

 NEF (RAW) Recording > Type
Choose the type of compression for NEF (RAW) images.

Option

N

Lossless compressed

O Compressed

Description NEF images are compressed using a reversible algorithm, reducing file size by about 20­40% with no effect on image quality. NEF images are compressed using a non-reversible algorithm, reducing file size by about 35­55% with almost no effect on image quality.

 NEF (RAW) Recording > NEF (RAW) Bit Depth
Choose a bit depth for NEF (RAW) images.

Option
d q 12-bit
r 14-bit

Description NEF (RAW) images are recorded at a bit-depth of 12 bits. NEF (RAW) images are recorded at a bit depth of 14 bits, producing files larger than those with a bit depth of 12 bits but increasing the color data recorded.

A NEF (RAW) Images
NEF (RAW) images can be viewed on the camera or using software such as Capture NX 2 (available separately; 0 298) or ViewNX 2 (available on the supplied ViewNX 2 CD). Note that the option selected for image size does not affect the size of NEF (RAW) images; when viewed on a computer, NEF (RAW) images have the dimensions given for large (#-size) images in the table on page 95. JPEG copies of NEF (RAW) images can be created using the NEF (RAW) processing option in the retouch menu (0 271).
A NEF+JPEG
When photographs taken at settings of NEF (RAW) + JPEG are viewed on the camera with only one memory card inserted, only the JPEG image will be displayed. If both copies are recorded to the same memory card, both copies will be erased when the photo is deleted. If the JPEG copy is recorded to a separate memory card using the Role played by card in Slot 2 > RAW Slot 1--JPEG Slot 2 option, deleting the JPEG copy will not delete the NEF (RAW) image.
94

Image Size
Image size is measured in pixels. Choose from # Large, $ Medium, or % Small (note that image size varies depending on the option selected for Image area, 0 89):

Image area

Option

Size (pixels)

Print size (cm/in.) *

FX (36×24) 1.0× (FX format)

Large Medium
Small

6,016 × 4,016 4,512 × 3,008 3,008 × 2,008

50.9 × 34.0/20.1 × 13.4 38.2 × 25.5/15.0 × 10.0 25.5 × 17.0/10.0 × 6.7

DX (24×16) 1.5× (DX format)

Large Medium
Small

3,936 × 2,624 2,944 × 1,968 1,968 × 1,312

33.3 × 22.2/13.1 × 8.7 24.9 × 16.7/ 9.8 × 6.6 16.7 × 11.1/ 6.6 × 4.4

* Approximate size when printed at 300 dpi. Print size in inches equals image size in pixels

divided by printer resolution in dots per inch (dpi; 1 inch=approximately 2.54 cm).

Image size can be set by pressing the X (T) button and rotating the subcommand dial until the desired setting is displayed in the control panel.

X (T) button

Sub command dial Control panel

d

A The Shooting Menu
Image size can also be adjusted using the Image size option in the shooting menu (0 214).
95

Using Two Memory Cards
When two memory cards are inserted in the camera, you can use the Role played by card in Slot 2 item in the shooting menu to choose the role played by the card in Slot 2. Choose from Overflow (the card in Slot 2 is used only when the card in Slot 1 is full), Backup (each picture is recorded twice, once to the card in Slot 1 and again to the card in Slot 2), and RAW Slot 1--JPEG Slot 2 (as for Backup, except that the NEF/ RAW copies of photos recorded at settings of NEF/RAW + JPEG are recorded only to the card in Slot 1 and the JPEG copies only to the card in Slot 2).
d
A "Backup" and "RAW Slot 1--JPEG Slot 2"
The camera shows the number of exposures remaining on the card with the least amount of memory. Shutter release will be disabled when either card is full.
A Recording Movies
When two memory cards are inserted in the camera, the slot used to record movies can be selected using the Movie settings > Destination option in the shooting menu (0 65).
96

NFocus
This section describes the focus options available when photographs are framed in the viewfinder. Focus can be adjusted automatically (see below) or manually (0 103). The user can also select the focus point for automatic or manual focus (0 101) or use focus lock to focus to recompose photographs after focusing (0 102).
Autofocus
To use autofocus, rotate the focus-mode selector to AF. Focus-mode selector

Autofocus Mode

Choose from the following autofocus modes:

Mode

Description

N AF-A

Auto-servo AF: Camera automatically selects single-servo autofocus if subject is stationary, continuous-servo autofocus if subject is moving.

Single-servo AF: For stationary subjects. Focus locks when shutter-release button is pressed

AF-S halfway. At default settings, shutter can only be released when in-focus indicator is

displayed (focus priority; 0 221).

Continuous-servo AF: For moving subjects. Camera focuses continuously while shutter-

release button is pressed halfway; if subject moves, camera will engage predictive focus

AF-C tracking (0 100) to predict final distance to subject and adjust focus as necessary. At

default settings, shutter can be released whether or not subject is in focus (release

priority; 0 221).

A Predictive Focus Tracking
In AF-C mode or when continuous-servo autofocus is selected in AF-A mode, the camera will initiate predictive focus tracking if the subject moves toward or away from the camera while the shutter-release button is pressed halfway. This allows the camera to track focus while attempting to predict where the subject will be when the shutter is released.
97

Autofocus mode can be selected by pressing the AFmode button and rotating the main command dial until the desired setting is displayed in the viewfinder or control panel.
AF-mode button Main command dial

AF-A

AF-S

AF-C

A Getting Good Results with Autofocus

Autofocus does not perform well under the conditions listed below. The shutter release may

be disabled if the camera is unable to focus under these conditions, or the in-focus indicator

(I) may be displayed and the camera may sound a beep, allowing the shutter to be released

even when the subject is not in focus. In these cases, focus manually (0 103) or use focus

lock (0 102) to focus on another subject at the same distance and then recompose the

photograph.

N

There is little or no contrast

The focus point contains

between the subject and the

areas of sharply contrasting

background.

brightness.

Example: Subject is the same color as the background. The focus point contains objects at different distances from the camera.
Example: Subject is inside a cage.
The subject is dominated by regular geometric patterns.
Example: Blinds or a row of windows in a skyscraper.

Example: Subject is half in the shade.
Background objects appear larger than the subject.
Example: A building is in the frame behind the subject.
The subject contains many fine details.
Example: A field of flowers or other subjects that are small or lack variation in brightness.

A See Also
For information on using focus priority in continuous-servo AF, see Custom Setting a1 (AF-C priority selection, 0 221). For information on using release priority in single-servo AF, see Custom Setting a2 (AF-S priority selection, 0 221). See page 51 for information on the autofocus options available in live view or during movie recording.

98

AF-Area Mode
Choose how the focus point for autofocus is selected. · Single-point AF: Select the focus point as described on page 101; the camera will
focus on the subject in the selected focus point only. Use with stationary subjects. · Dynamic-area AF: Select the focus point as described on page 101. In AF-A and AF-C
focus modes, the camera will focus based on information from surrounding focus points if the subject briefly leaves the selected point. The number of focus points varies with the mode selected: - 9-point dynamic-area AF: Choose when there is time to compose the photograph or
when photographing subjects that are moving predictably (e.g., runners or race cars on a track). - 21-point dynamic-area AF: Choose when photographing subjects that are moving unpredictably (e.g., players at a football game). - 39-point dynamic-area AF: Choose when photographing subjects that are moving quickly and can not be easily framed in the viewfinder (e.g., birds). · 3D-tracking: Select the focus point as described on page 101. In AF-A and AF-C focus modes, the camera will track subjects that leave the selected focus point and select new focus points as required. Use to quickly compose pictures with subjects that are moving erratically from side to side (e.g., tennis players). If the subject leaves viewfinder, remove your finger from the shutter-release button and recompose the photograph with the subject in the selected focus point.
N
· Auto-area AF: The camera automatically detects the subject and selects the focus point. If a type G or D lens is used (0 287), the camera can distinguish human subjects from the background for improved subject detection. The active focus points are highlighted briefly after the camera focuses; in AF-C mode or when continuous-servo autofocus is selected in AF-A mode, the main focus point remains highlighted after the other focus points have turned off.
99

AF-area mode can be selected by pressing the AF-mode button and rotating the subcommand dial until the desired setting is displayed in the viewfinder or control panel.
AF-mode button Sub-command dial

Control panel

Viewfinder

A 3D-tracking
When the shutter-release button is pressed halfway, the colors in the area surrounding the focus point are stored in the camera. Consequently 3D-tracking may not produce the desired results with subjects that are the same color as the background or that occupy a very small area of the frame.
N A AF-Area Mode
AF-area mode is shown in the control panel and viewfinder.

AF-area mode

Control panel Viewfinder

AF-area mode

Control panel Viewfinder

Single-point AF

39-point dynamic-area AF *

9-point dynamic-area AF *

3D-tracking

21-point dynamic-area AF *

Auto-area AF

* Only active focus point is displayed in the viewfinder. Remaining focus points provide information to assist focus operation.
A Manual Focus
Single-point AF is automatically selected when manual focus is used.

A See Also
For information on adjusting how long the camera waits before refocusing when an object moves in front of the camera, see Custom Setting a3 (Focus tracking with lock-on, 0 222). See page 52 for information on the autofocus options available in live view or during movie recording.

100

Focus Point Selection
The camera offers a choice of 39 focus points that can be used to compose photographs with the main subject positioned almost anywhere in the frame.
1 Rotate the focus selector lock to .
This allows the multi selector to be used to select the focus point.
Focus selector lock
2 Select the focus point.
Use the multi selector to select the focus point in the viewfinder while the exposure meters are on. Press J to select the center focus point.

The focus selector lock can be rotated to the

N

locked (L) position following selection to prevent

the selected focus point from changing when

the multi selector is pressed.

A Auto-area AF
The focus point for auto-area AF is selected automatically; manual focus-point selection is not available.
A See Also
For information on choosing when the focus point is illuminated, see Custom Setting a4 (AF point illumination, 0 222). For information on setting focus-point selection to "wrap around," see Custom Setting a5 (Focus point wrap-around, 0 222). For information on choosing the number of focus points that can be selected using the multi selector, see Custom Setting a6 (Number of focus points, 0 223). For information on changing the role of the J button, see Custom Setting f1, OK button (shooting mode); 0 241.
101

Focus Lock
Focus lock can be used to change the composition after focusing, making it possible to focus on a subject that will not be in a focus point in the final composition. If the camera is unable to focus using autofocus (0 98), focus lock can also be used to recompose the photograph after focusing on another object at the same distance as your original subject. Focus lock is most effective when an option other than autoarea AF is selected for AF-area mode (0 99).

1 Focus.
Position the subject in the selected focus point and press the shutter-release button halfway to initiate focus. Check that the in-focus indicator (I) appears in the viewfinder.

2 Lock focus.
AF-A and AF-C focus modes: With the shutter-release button pressed halfway (q), press the A AE-L/AF-L button (w) to lock both focus and exposure (an AE-L icon will be displayed in the viewfinder). Focus will remain locked while the A AE-L/AF-L button is pressed, even if you later remove your finger from the shutter-release button.
N
AF-S focus mode: Focus locks automatically when the in-focus indicator appears, and remain locked until you remove your finger from the shutter-release button. Focus can also be locked by pressing the A AE-L/AF-L button (see above).

Shutter-release button A AE-L/AF-L button

3 Recompose the photograph and shoot.
Focus will remain locked between shots if you keep the shutter-release button pressed halfway (AF-S) or keep the A AE-L/AF-L button pressed, allowing several photographs in succession to be taken at the same focus setting.
Do not change the distance between the camera and the subject while focus lock is in effect. If the subject moves, focus again at the new distance.
A See Also
See Custom setting c1 (Shutter-release button AE-L, 0 226) for information on using the shutter-release button to lock exposure, Custom Setting f4 (Assign AE-L/AF-L button, 0 244) for information on choosing the role played by the A AE-L/AF-L button.

102

Manual Focus

Manual focus is available for lenses that do not support autofocus (non-AF NIKKOR lenses) or when the autofocus does not produce the desired results (0 98). · AF-S lenses: Set the lens focus mode switch to M. · AF lenses: Set the lens focus mode switch (if present) Focus-mode selector
and camera focus-mode selector to M.
D AF Lenses
Do not use AF lenses with the lens focus mode switch set to M and the camera focus-mode selector set to AF. Failure to observe this precaution could damage the camera or lens.
· Manual focus lenses: Set the camera focus-mode selector to M.
To focus manually, adjust the lens focus ring until the image displayed on the clear matte field in the viewfinder is in focus. Photographs can be taken at any time, even when the image is not in focus.

 The Electronic Rangefinder

If the lens has a maximum aperture of f/5.6 or faster,

the viewfinder focus indicator can be used to confirm

whether the subject in the selected focus point is in

focus (the focus point can be selected from any of the

N

39 focus points). After positioning the subject in the

selected focus point, press the shutter-release button

halfway and rotate the lens focus ring until the in-focus indicator (I) is displayed.

Note that with the subjects listed on page 98, the in-focus indicator may sometimes

be displayed when the subject is not in focus; confirm focus in the viewfinder before

shooting.

A Focal Plane Position
To determine the distance between your subject and the camera, measure from the focal plane mark (E) on the camera body. The distance between the lens mounting flange and the focal plane is 46.5 mm (1.83 in.).

46.5 mm Focal plane mark
103

N
104

SISO Sensitivity

"ISO sensitivity" is the digital equivalent of film speed. Choose from settings that range from ISO 100 to ISO 6400 in steps equivalent to 1/3 EV. Settings of from about 0.3 to 1 EV below ISO 100 and 0.3 to 2 EV above ISO 6400 are also available for special situations. Auto and scene modes also offer an AUTO option, which allows the camera to set ISO sensitivity automatically in response to lighting conditions. The higher the ISO sensitivity, the less light needed to make an exposure, allowing higher shutter speeds or smaller apertures.

ISO sensitivity can be adjusted by pressing the W (S) button and rotating the main command dial until the desired setting is displayed in the control panel or viewfinder.

W (S) button Main command dial

Control panel

Viewfinder
S

105

A AUTO
If the mode dial is rotated to P, S, A, or M after AUTO is selected for ISO sensitivity in another mode, the ISO sensitivity last selected in P, S, A, or M mode will be restored.
A Hi 0.3­Hi 2
The settings Hi 0.3 through Hi 2 correspond to ISO sensitivities 0.3­2 EV over ISO 6400 (ISO 8000­25600 equivalent). Pictures taken at these settings are more likely to be subject to noise (randomly-spaced bright pixels, fog, or lines).
A Lo 0.3­Lo 1
The settings Lo 0.3 through Lo 1 correspond to ISO sensitivities 0.3­1 EV below ISO 100 (ISO 80­50 equivalent). Use for larger apertures when lighting is bright. Contrast is slightly higher than normal; in most cases, ISO sensitivities of ISO 100 or above are recommended.
A The Shooting Menu
ISO sensitivity can also be adjusted using the ISO sensitivity settings option in the shooting menu (0 214).
A See Also
For information on choosing the ISO sensitivity step size, see Custom Setting b1 (ISO sensitivity step value; 0 224). For information on displaying ISO sensitivity in the control panel or adjusting ISO sensitivity without using the W (S) button, see Custom Setting d3 (ISO display and adjustment; 0 229). For information on using the High ISO NR option in the shooting menu to reduce noise at high ISO sensitivities, see page 218.
S
106

Auto ISO Sensitivity Control (P,S,A,andMModesOnly)

If On is selected for ISO sensitivity settings > Auto ISO sensitivity control in the shooting menu, ISO sensitivity will automatically be adjusted if optimal exposure can not be achieved at the value selected by the user (ISO sensitivity is adjusted appropriately when the flash is used).

1 Select Auto ISO sensitivity control for

ISO sensitivity settings in the shooting

menu.

To display the menus, press the G button.

Select ISO sensitivity settings in the

shooting menu, highlight Auto ISO

G button

sensitivity control and press 2.

2 Select On.
Highlight On and press J (if Off is selected, ISO sensitivity will remain fixed at the value selected by the user).

3 Adjust settings.

The maximum value for auto ISO sensitivity

can be selected using Maximum sensitivity

(the minimum value for auto ISO sensitivity

S

is automatically set to ISO 100; note that if

the value selected for Maximum sensitivity

is lower than the value currently selected for ISO sensitivity, the value selected

for Maximum sensitivity will be used). In modes P and A, sensitivity will only

be adjusted if underexposure would result at the shutter speed selected for

Minimum shutter speed (1/2000­1 s, or Auto; in modes S and M, ISO sensitivity

will be adjusted for optimal exposure at the shutter speed selected by the user).

If Auto (available only with CPU lenses; equivalent to 1/30 s when a non-CPU

lens is used) is selected, the camera will choose the minimum shutter speed

based on the focal length of the lens (auto shutter-speed selection can be fine-

tuned by highlighting Auto and pressing 2; for example, even faster values

than those usually selected automatically by the camera can be used with

telephoto lenses to reduce blur). Shutter speeds slower than the minimum

value may be used if optimum exposure can not be achieved at the ISO

sensitivity value selected for Maximum sensitivity. Press J to exit when

settings are complete.

107

When On is selected, the viewfinder and control panel show ISO-AUTO. When sensitivity is altered from the value selected by the user, these indicators flash and the altered value is shown in viewfinder.

Control panel

Viewfinder

S
A Auto ISO Sensitivity Control
Noise (randomly-spaced bright pixels, fog, or lines) is more likely at higher sensitivities. Use the High ISO NR option in the shooting menu to reduce noise (see page 218). When a flash is used, the value selected for Minimum shutter speed is ignored in favor of the option selected for Custom Setting e1 (Flash sync speed, 0 234). Note that ISO sensitivity may be raised automatically when auto ISO sensitivity control is used in combination with slow sync flash modes (available with the built-in flash and the optional flash units listed on page 293), possibly preventing the camera from selecting slow shutter speeds.
A Turning Auto ISO Sensitivity Control On or Off
You can turn auto ISO sensitivity control on or off by pressing the W (S) button and rotating the subcommand dial. ISO-AUTO is displayed when auto ISO sensitivity control is on.
W (S) button Sub-command dial
108

ZExposure

Metering

(P, S, A, and M Modes Only)

Choose how the camera sets exposure in P, S, A, and M modes (in other modes, the camera selects the metering method automatically).

Option

Description

Matrix: Produces natural results in most situations. Camera meters a wide area of the

frame and set exposure according to tone distribution, color, composition, and, with

type G or D lenses (0 287), distance information (3D color matrix metering II; with

a other CPU lenses, camera uses color matrix metering II, which does not include 3D

distance information). With non-CPU lenses, camera uses color matrix metering if focal

length and maximum aperture are specified using Non-CPU lens data option in setup

menu (0 173); otherwise camera uses center-weighted metering.

Center-weighted: Camera meters entire frame but assigns greatest weight to center area

(if CPU lens is attached, size of area can be selected using Custom Setting b4, Center-

Z weighted area, 0 226; if non-CPU lens is attached, area is 12 mm in diameter). Classic

meter for portraits; recommended when using filters with an exposure factor (filter factor) over 1×. *

Spot: Camera meters circle 4 mm (0.16 in.) in diameter (approximately 1.5% of frame).

Circle is centered on current focus point, making it possible to meter off-center subjects

b (if non-CPU lens is used or if auto-area AF is in effect, camera will meter center focus

point). Ensures that subject will be correctly exposed, even when background is much brighter or darker. *

* For improved precision with non-CPU lenses, specify lens focal length and maximum aperture in Non-CPU lens data menu (0 173).

Z

To choose a metering option, press the Z (Q) button and rotate the main command dial until the desired setting is displayed in the viewfinder and control panel.
A See Also
For information on making separate adjustments to optimal exposure for each metering method, see Custom Setting b5 (Fine-tune optimal exposure, 0 226).

Z (Q) button Main command dial

Control panel

Viewfinder

109

Autoexposure Lock

Use autoexposure lock to recompose photographs after using center-weighted metering and spot metering to meter exposure. Note that matrix metering will not produce the desired results.

1 Lock exposure.
Position the subject in the selected focus point and press the shutter-release button halfway. With the shutter-release button pressed halfway and the subject positioned in the focus point, press the A AE-L/AF-L button to lock focus and exposure (if you are using autofocus, confirm that the I in-focus indicator appears in the viewfinder).
While exposure lock is in effect, an AE-L indicator will appear in the viewfinder.

Shutter-release button A AE-L/AF-L button

2 Recompose the photograph.
Keeping the A AE-L/AF-L button pressed, recompose the photograph and shoot.
Z

110

A Metered Area
In spot metering, exposure will be locked at the value metered in a 4-mm (0.16 in.) circle centered on the selected focus point. In center-weighted metering, exposure will be locked at the value metered in a 12-mm circle in the center of the viewfinder.

A Adjusting Shutter Speed and Aperture
While exposure lock is in effect, the following settings can be adjusted without altering the metered value for exposure:

Mode

Setting

P

Shutter speed and aperture (flexible program; 0 75)

S

Shutter speed

A

Aperture

The new values can be confirmed in the viewfinder and control panel. Note that metering can not be changed while exposure lock is in effect.

A See Also
If On is selected for Custom Setting c1 (Shutter-release button AE-L, 0 226), exposure will
lock when the shutter-release button is pressed halfway. For information on changing the role of the A AE-L/AF-L button, see Custom Setting f4 (Assign AE-L/AF-L button, 0 244).

Z

111

Exposure Compensation

(P, S, A, and M Modes Only)

Exposure compensation is used to alter exposure from the value suggested by the camera, making pictures brighter or darker. It is most effective when used with center-weighted or spot metering (0 109). Choose from values between ­5 EV (underexposure) and +5 EV (overexposure) in increments of 1/3 EV. In general, positive values make the subject brighter while negative values make it darker.

­1 EV

No exposure compensation

To choose a value for exposure compensation, press the E button and rotate the main command dial until the desired value is displayed in the control panel or viewfinder.

+1 EV E button

Main command dial

±0 EV (E button pressed)

­0.3 EV

+2.0 EV

At values other than ±0.0, the 0 at the center of the exposure indicators will flash (modes P, S, and A only) and a E icon will be
Z displayed in the control panel and viewfinder after you release
the E button. The current value for exposure compensation can be confirmed in the exposure indicator by pressing the E button.

Normal exposure can be restored by setting exposure compensation to ±0. Exposure compensation is not reset when the camera is turned off.

112

A Mode M
In mode M, exposure compensation affects only the exposure indicator; shutter speed and aperture do not change.
A Using a Flash
When a flash is used, exposure compensation affects both flash level and exposure, altering the brightness of both the main subject and the background. Custom Setting e4 (Exposure comp. for flash, 0 240) can be used to restrict the effects of exposure compensation to the background only.
A See Also
For information on choosing the size of the increments available for exposure compensation, see Custom Setting b2 (EV steps for exposure cntrl, 0 224). For information on making adjustments to exposure compensation without pressing the E button, see Custom Setting b3 (Easy exposure compensation, 0 225). For information on automatically varying exposure, flash level, white balance, or Active D-Lighting, see page 153.
Z
113

Z
114

rWhite Balance

(P, S, A, and M Modes Only)

White balance ensures that colors are unaffected by the color of the light source. In modes other than P, S, A, and M, white balance is set automatically by the camera. Auto white balance is recommended for most light sources in P, S, A, and M modes, but other values can be selected if necessary according to the type of source:

Option

Colortemp. *

Description

v Auto Normal Keep warm lighting colors

3,500­ 8,000 K

White balance is adjusted automatically. For best results, use type G or D lens. If built-in or optional flash fires, results are adjusted for flash.

J Incandescent

3,000 K Use under incandescent lighting.

I Fluorescent

Use with:

Sodium-vapor lamps

2,700 K · Sodium-vapor lighting (found in sports venues).

Warm-white fluorescent 3,000 K · Warm-white fluorescent lights.

White fluorescent

3,700 K · White fluorescent lights.

Cool-white fluorescent

4,200 K · Cool-white fluorescent lights.

Day white fluorescent

5,000 K · Daylight white fluorescent lights.

Daylight fluorescent

6,500 K · Daylight fluorescent lights.

High temp. mercury-vapor

7,200 K

· High color temperature light sources (e.g. mercury-vapor lamps).

H Direct sunlight

5,200 K Use with subjects lit by direct sunlight.

N Flash

5,400 K Use with built-in or optional flash.

G Cloudy

6,000 K Use in daylight under overcast skies.

M Shade

8,000 K Use in daylight with subjects in the shade.

K Choose color temp. L Preset manual

2,500­ Choose color temperature from list of values

10,000 K (0 120).

--

r Use subject, light source, or existing photograph as
reference for white balance (0 121).

* All values are approximate and do not reflect fine-tuning (if applicable).

White balance is set by pressing the L (U) button and rotating the main command dial until the desired setting is displayed in the control panel.
L (U) button Main command dial

Control panel

115

A The Shooting Menu
White balance can also be adjusted using the White balance option in the shooting menu (0 214), which also can be used to fine-tune white balance (0 117) or measure a value for preset white balance (0 121). The Auto option in the White balance menu offers a choice of Normal and Keep warm lighting colors,
which preserves the warm colors produced by incandescent lighting, while the I Fluorescent option can be used to select the light source from the bulb types.

A Studio Flash Lighting
Auto white balance may not produce the desired results with large studio flash units. Use preset white balance or set white balance to Flash and use fine tuning to adjust white balance.

A Color Temperature

The perceived color of a light source varies with the viewer and other conditions. Color

temperature is an objective measure of the color of a light source, defined with reference to

the temperature to which an object would have to be heated to radiate light in the same

wavelengths. While light sources with a color temperature in the neighborhood of 5,000­

5,500 K appear white, light sources with a lower color temperature, such as incandescent

light bulbs, appear slightly yellow or red. Light sources with a higher color temperature

appear tinged with blue. The camera white balance options are adapted to the following

color temperatures:

· I (sodium-vapor lamps): 2,700 K

· H (direct sunlight): 5,200 K

· J (incandescent)/

· N (flash): 5,400 K

I (warm-white fluorescent): 3,000 K

· G (cloudy): 6,000 K

· I (white fluorescent): 3,700 K

· I (daylight fluorescent): 6,500 K

· I (cool-white fluorescent): 4,200 K

· I (high temp. mercury-vapor): 7,200 K

· I (day white fluorescent): 5,000 K

· M (shade): 8,000 K

A See Also
r When WB bracketing is selected for Custom Setting e6 (Auto bracketing set, 0 241), the camera will create several images each time the shutter is released. White balance will be
varied with each image, "bracketing" the value currently selected for white balance (0 156).

116

Fine-Tuning White Balance

White balance can be "fine-tuned" to compensate for variations in the color of the light source or to introduce a deliberate color cast into an image. White balance is fine-tuned using the White balance option in the shooting menu or by pressing the L (U) button and rotating the sub-command dial.
 The White Balance Menu

1 Select a white balance option in the

shooting menu.

To display the menus, press the G button.

Select White balance in the shooting menu,

then highlight a white balance option and

press 2. If an option other than Auto,

G button

Fluorescent, Choose color temp., or Preset

manual is selected, proceed to Step 2. If Auto, Fluorescent, or Choose color

temp. is selected, highlight the desired setting and press 2. For information on

fine-tuning preset white balance, see page 125.

2 Fine tune white balance.

Use the multi selector to fine-tune white

balance. White balance can be fine-tuned

on the amber (A)­blue (B) axis and the green

(G)­magenta (M) axis. The horizontal

(amber-blue) axis corresponds to color temperature, with each increment equivalent to about 5 mired. The vertical

Coordinates Adjustment

(green-magenta) axis has the similar effects to the corresponding color compensation (CC) filters.

r

Increase green

Green (G)

Blue (B)

Amber (A)

Increase magenta Increase blue

Magenta (M)

Increase amber

117

3 Press J.
Press J to save settings and return to the shooting menu. If white balance has been fine-tuned, an asterisk ("E") will be displayed in the control panel.

 The L (U) Button

At settings other than K (Choose color temp.) and

L (Preset manual), the L (U) button can be

used to fine-tune white balance on the amber (A)­

blue (B) axis (0 117; to fine-tune white balance when

K or L is selected, use the shooting menu as

described on page 117). Six settings in both

L (U) button Sub-command

directions are available; each increment is equivalent

dial

to about 5 mired (0 119). Press the L (U) button

and rotate the sub-command dial until the desired

value is displayed in the control panel. Rotating the

sub-command dial to the left increases the amount of

amber (A). Rotating the sub-command dial to the right increases the amount of blue (B). At settings

Control panel

other than 0, an asterisk ("E") appears in the control

panel.

r

118

A White Balance Fine-Tuning
The colors on the fine-tuning axes are relative, not absolute. For example, moving the cursor to B (blue) when a "warm" setting such as J (incandescent) is selected for white balance will make photographs slightly "colder" but will not actually make them blue.
A Color Temperature Fine-Tuning
When Choose color temp. is selected, you can view the color temperature while fine-tuning white balance.
A "Mired"
Any given change in color temperature produces a greater difference in color at low color temperatures than it would at higher color temperatures. For example, a change of 1000 K produces a much greater change in color at 3000 K than at 6000 K. Mired, calculated by multiplying the inverse of the color temperature by 10 6, is a measure of color temperature that takes such variation into account, and as such is the unit used in color-temperature compensation filters. E.g.: · 4000 K­3000 K (a difference of 1000 K)=83 mired · 7000 K­6000 K (a difference of 1000 K)=24 mired
r
119

Choosing a Color Temperature
When K (Choose color temp.) is selected for white balance, color temperature can be selected by pressing the L (U) button and rotating the subcommand dial. The color temperature is displayed in the control panel.
L (U) button Sub-command dial
Control panel
r
D Choose Color Temperature
Note that the desired results will not be obtained with flash or fluorescent lighting. Choose N (Flash) or I (Fluorescent) for these sources. With other light sources, take a test shot to determine if the selected value is appropriate.
A The White Balance Menu
Color temperature can also be selected in the white balance menu. Note that the color temperature with the L (U) button and the sub-command dial replaces the value selected in the white balance menu.
120

Preset Manual

Preset manual is used to record and recall custom white balance settings for shooting under mixed lighting or to compensate for light sources with a strong color cast. The camera can store up to four values for preset white balance in presets d-1 through d-4. Two methods are available for setting preset white balance:

Method
Direct measurement
Copy from existing photograph

Description Neutral gray or white object is placed under lighting that will be used in final photo and white balance measured by camera (0 121).
White balance is copied from photo on memory card (0 124).

 Measuring a Value for White Balance
1 Light a reference object.
Place a neutral gray or white object under the lighting that will be used in the final photograph. In studio settings, a standard gray panel can be used as a reference object. Note that exposure is automatically increased by 1 EV when measuring white balance; in mode M, adjust exposure so that the exposure indicator shows ±0 (0 78).
2 Set white balance to L (Preset manual).
Press the L (U) button and rotate the main command dial until L is displayed in the control panel.

r

L (U) button

Main command dial

Control panel

A Measuring Preset White Balance
Preset manual white balance can not be measured during live view (0 49, 57), while you are shooting an HDR photograph (0 139) or multiple exposure (0 160), or when Record movies is selected for Custom Setting g4 (Assign shutter button, 0 248).
121

3 Select a preset.
Press the L (U) button and rotate the sub-command dial until the desired white balance preset (d-1 to d-4) is displayed in the control panel.

L (U) button

Sub-command dial Control panel

4 Select direct measurement mode.
Release the L (U) button briefly and then press the button until the L icon in the control panel starts to flash. A flashing D will also appear in the viewfinder. The displays will flash for about six seconds.

Control panel

Viewfinder
5 Measure white balance.
Before the indicators stop flashing, frame the reference object so that it fills the viewfinder and press the shutter-release button all the way down. The camera will measure a value for white balance and store it in the preset selected in Step 3. No photograph will be recorded; white balance can be measured accurately even when the camera is not in focus.
r

A Protected Presets
If the current preset is protected (0 127), 3 will flash in the control panel and viewfinder if you attempt to measure a new value.
122

6 Check the results.
If the camera was able to measure a value for white balance, C will flash in the control panel for about six seconds, while the viewfinder will show a flashing a.

Control panel

If lighting is too dark or too bright, the camera may be unable to measure white balance. A flashing b a will appear in the control panel and viewfinder for about six seconds. Press the shutter-release button halfway to return to Step 5 and measure white balance again.

Viewfinder
Control panel Viewfinder

r
D Direct Measurement Mode
If no operations are performed while the displays are flashing, direct measurement mode will end in the time selected for Custom Setting c2 (Standby timer, 0 227).
A Selecting a Preset
Selecting Preset manual for the White balance option in the shooting menu displays the dialog shown at right; highlight a preset and press J. If no value currently exists for the selected preset, white balance will be set to 5,200 K, the same as Direct sunlight.
123

 Copying White Balance from a Photograph
Follow the steps below to copy a value for white balance from an existing photograph to a selected preset.

1 Select L (Preset manual) for White
balance in the shooting menu.
Press the G button and select White balance in the shooting menu. Highlight Preset manual and press 2.

G button

2 Select a destination.
Highlight the destination preset (d-1 to d-4) and press W (S).

3 Choose Select image.
Highlight Select image and press 2.

W (S) button

4 Highlight a source image.
Highlight the source image.
r
5 Press J.
Press J to copy the white balance value for the highlighted photograph to the selected preset. If the highlighted photograph has a comment (0 253), the comment will be copied to the comment for the selected preset.

124

A Choosing a Source Image
To view the image highlighted in Step 4 full frame, press and hold the X (T) button.

X (T) button
To view images in other locations, hold the D button and press 1. The dialog shown at right will be displayed; select the desired card and folder (0 178).

A Choosing a White Balance Preset
Press 1 to highlight the current white balance preset
(d-1­ d-4) and press 2 to select another preset.

D button

A Fine-Tuning Preset White Balance
The selected preset can be fine-tuned by selecting Fine-tune and adjusting white balance as described on page 117.

r

125

 Entering a Comment
Follow the steps below to enter a descriptive comment of up to thirty-six characters for a selected white balance preset.
1 Select L (Preset manual).
Highlight Preset manual in the white balance menu and press 2.

2 Select a preset.
Highlight the desired preset and press W (S).

3 Select Edit comment.
Highlight Edit comment and press 2.

W (S) button

4 Edit the comment.
Edit the comment as described on page 135.
r

126

 Protecting a White Balance Preset
Follow the steps below to protect the selected white balance preset. Protected presets can not be modified and the Fine-tune and Edit comment options can not be used.
1 Select L (Preset manual).
Highlight Preset manual in the white balance menu and press 2.

2 Select a preset.
Highlight the desired preset and press W (S).

3 Select Protect.
Highlight Protect and press 2.

W (S) button

4 Select On.

Highlight On and press J to protect the

selected white balance preset. To remove

protection, select Off.

r

127

r
128

JImage Enhancement

Picture Controls

(P, S, A, and M Modes Only)

Nikon's unique Picture Control system makes it possible to share image processing settings, including sharpening, contrast, brightness, saturation, and hue, among compatible devices and software.

Selecting a Picture Control

The camera offers a choice of preset Picture Controls. In P, S, A, and M modes, you can choose a Picture Control according to the subject or type of scene (in other modes, the camera selects a Picture Control automatically).

Option

Description

Q Standard

Standard processing for balanced results. Recommended for most situations.

R Neutral

Minimal processing for natural results. Choose for photographs that will later be extensively processed or retouched.

S Vivid

Pictures are enhanced for a vivid, photoprint effect. Choose for photographs that emphasize primary colors.

T Monochrome Take monochrome photographs.

e Portrait Process portraits for skin with natural texture and a rounded feel.

f Landscape Produces vibrant landscapes and cityscapes.

1 Press c (b).
A list of Picture Controls will be displayed.
J

2 Choose a Picture Control.
Highlight the desired Picture Control and press J.

c (b) button

129

A Custom Picture Controls
Custom Picture Controls are created through modifications to existing Picture Controls using the Manage Picture Control option in the shooting menu (0 134). Custom Picture Controls can be saved to a memory card for sharing among other cameras of the same model and compatible software (0 136).
A The Picture Control Indicator
The current Picture Control is shown in the information display when the R button is pressed.

A The Shooting Menu
Picture Controls can also be selected using the Set Picture Control option in the shooting menu (0 214).

Picture Control indicator

J
130

Modifying Picture Controls
Existing preset or custom Picture Controls (0 134) can be modified to suit the scene or the user's creative intent. Choose a balanced combination of settings using Quick adjust, or make manual adjustments to individual settings.
1 Select a Picture Control.
Highlight the desired Picture Control in the Picture Control list (0 129) and press 2.
2 Adjust settings.
Press 1 or 3 to highlight the desired setting (0 132) and press 4 or 2 to choose a value. Repeat this step until all settings have been adjusted, or select Quick adjust to choose a preset combination of settings. Default settings can be restored by pressing the O (Q) button.
3 Press J.

A Modifications to Original Picture Controls
Picture Controls that have been modified from default settings are indicated by an asterisk ("E").

J
131

 Picture Control Settings

Manual adjustments (all Picture Controls)

Option

Description

Choose from options between ­2 and +2 to reduce or exaggerate the effect

Quick adjust

of the selected Picture Control (note that this resets all manual adjustments). For example, choosing positive values for Vivid makes pictures more vivid.

Not available with Neutral or Monochrome Picture Controls.

Control the sharpness of outlines. Select A to adjust sharpening

Sharpening automatically according to the type of scene, or choose from values between

0 (no sharpening) and 9 (the higher the value, the greater the sharpening).

Select A to adjust contrast automatically according to the type of scene, or

choose from values between ­3 and +3 (choose lower values to prevent

Contrast highlights in portrait subjects from being "washed out" in direct sunlight,

higher values to preserve detail in misty landscapes and other low-contrast

subjects).

Brightness

Choose ­1 for reduced brightness, +1 for enhanced brightness. Does not affect exposure.

Control the vividness of colors. Select A to adjust saturation automatically Saturation according to the type of scene, or choose from values between ­3 and +3
(lower values reduce saturation and higher values increase it).

Hue
Filter effects

Choose negative values (to a minimum of ­3) to make reds more purple, blues more green, and greens more yellow, positive values (up to +3) to make reds more orange, greens more blue, and blues more purple.
Simulate the effect of color filters on monochrome photographs. Choose from Off, yellow, orange, red, and green (0 133).

Toning

Choose the tint used in monochrome photographs from B&W (black-andwhite), Sepia, Cyanotype (blue-tinted monochrome), Red, Yellow, Green, Blue Green, Blue, Purple Blue, Red Purple (0 133).

Manual adjustments Manual adjustments (non-monochrome only) (monochrome only)

J

D "A" (Auto)
Results for auto sharpening, contrast, and saturation vary with exposure and the position of the subject in the frame. Use a type G or D lens for best results.
A Custom Picture Controls
The options available with custom Picture Controls are the same as those on which the custom Picture Control was based.
132

A The Picture Control Grid
Pressing the W (S) button in Step 2 on page 131 displays a Picture Control grid showing the contrast and saturation for the selected Picture Control in relation to the other Picture Controls (only contrast is displayed when Monochrome is selected). Release the W (S) button to return to the Picture Control menu.
The icons for Picture Controls that use auto contrast and saturation are displayed in green in the Picture Control grid, and lines appear parallel to the axes of the grid.

A Previous Settings
The line under the value display in the Picture Control setting menu indicates the previous value for the setting. Use this as a reference when adjusting settings.

A Filter Effects (Monochrome Only)
The options in this menu simulate the effect of color filters on monochrome photographs. The following filter effects are available:

Option

Description

Y Yellow Enhances contrast. Can be used to tone down the brightness of the sky in

O Orange landscape photographs. Orange produces more contrast than yellow, red

R Red more contrast than orange.

G Green Softens skin tones. Can be used for portraits.

Note that the effects achieved with Filter effects are more pronounced than those produced by physical glass filters.

A Toning (Monochrome Only)

Pressing 3 when Toning is selected displays saturation options.

Press 4 or 2 to adjust saturation. Saturation control is not available

when B&W (black-and-white) is selected.

J

133

Creating Custom Picture Controls
The Picture Controls supplied with the camera can be modified and saved as custom Picture Controls.

1 Select Manage Picture Control in the
shooting menu.
To display the menus, press the G button. Highlight Manage Picture Control in the shooting menu and press 2.

G button

2 Select Save/edit.
Highlight Save/edit and press 2.

3 Select a Picture Control.
Highlight an existing Picture Control and press 2, or press J to proceed to Step 5 to save a copy of the highlighted Picture Control without further modification.
4 Edit the selected Picture Control.
See page 132 for more information. To abandon any changes and start over from default settings, press the O (Q) button. Press J when settings are complete.
J
5 Select a destination.
Choose a destination for the custom Picture Control (C-1 through C-9) and press 2.

134

6 Name the Picture Control.

The text-entry dialog shown at right will be displayed. By default, new Picture Controls

Keyboard area

are named by adding a two-digit number (assigned automatically) to the name of the

Name area

existing Picture Control; to use the default

name, proceed to Step 7. To move the cursor in the name area, hold the

W (S) button and press 4 or 2. To enter a new letter at the current cursor

position, use the multi selector to highlight the desired character in the

keyboard area and press J. To delete the character at the current cursor

position, press the O (Q) button.

Custom Picture Control names can be up to nineteen characters long. Any characters after the nineteenth will be deleted.

7 Press X (T).
Press the X (T) button to save changes and exit. The new Picture Control will appear in the Picture Control list.

X (T) button

A Manage Picture Control > Rename
Custom Picture Controls can be renamed at any time using the Rename option in the Manage Picture Control menu.
A Manage Picture Control > Delete
The Delete option in the Manage Picture Control menu can be used to delete selected custom Picture Controls when they are no longer needed.
A The Original Picture Control Icon
The original preset Picture Control on which the custom Picture Control is based is indicated by an icon in the top right corner of the edit display.

J
Original Picture Control icon

135

Sharing Custom Picture Controls
Custom Picture Controls created using the Picture Control Utility available with ViewNX 2 or optional software such as Capture NX 2 can be copied to a memory card and loaded into the camera, or custom Picture Controls created with the camera can be copied to the memory card to be used in other D600 cameras and software and then deleted when no longer needed. To copy custom Picture Controls to or from the memory card, or to delete custom Picture Controls from the memory card, highlight Load/save in the Manage Picture Control menu and press 2. The following options will be displayed: · Copy to camera: Copy custom Picture Controls from the
memory card to custom Picture Controls C-1 through C-9 on the camera and name them as desired. · Delete from card: Delete selected custom Picture Controls from the memory card. The confirmation dialog shown at right will be displayed before a Picture Control is deleted; to delete the selected Picture Control, highlight Yes and press J. · Copy to card: Copy a custom Picture Control (C-1 through C-9) from the camera to a selected destination (1 through 99) on the memory card.
J
A Saving Custom Picture Controls
Up to 99 custom Picture Controls can be stored on the memory card at any one time. The memory card can only be used to store user-created custom Picture Controls. The preset Picture Controls supplied with the camera (0 129) can not be copied to the memory card, renamed, or deleted. The options in the Manage Picture Control menu apply only to the memory card in Slot 1. Custom Picture Controls can not be deleted from or copied to or from the card in Slot 2.
136

Preserving Detail in Highlights and Shadows

Active D-Lighting

(P, S, A, and M Modes Only)

Active D-Lighting preserves details in highlights and shadows, creating photographs with natural contrast. Use for high contrast scenes, for example when photographing brightly lit outdoor scenery through a door or window or taking pictures of shaded subjects on a sunny day. It is most effective when used with matrix metering (0 109).

Active D-Lighting off

Active D-Lighting: Y Auto

J
D "Active D-Lighting" Versus "D-Lighting"
The Active D-Lighting option in the shooting menu adjusts exposure before shooting to optimize the dynamic range, while the D-Lighting option in the retouch menu optimizes dynamic range in images after shooting.
137

To use Active D-Lighting:
1 Select Active D-Lighting in the
shooting menu.
To display the menus, press the G button. Highlight Active D-Lighting in the shooting menu and press 2.
G button
2 Choose an option.
Highlight the desired option and press J. If Y Auto is selected, the camera will automatically adjust Active D-Lighting according to shooting conditions (in mode M, however, Y Auto is equivalent to Q Normal).
J
D Active D-Lighting
Active D-Lighting can not be used with movies. Noise (randomly-spaced bright pixels, fog, or lines) may appear in photographs taken with Active D-Lighting. Uneven shading may be visible with some subjects. Active D-Lighting can not be used at ISO sensitivities of Hi 0.3 or above.
A See Also
When ADL bracketing is selected for Custom Setting e6 (Auto bracketing set, 0 241), the camera varies Active D-Lighting over a series of shots (0 158). For information on using the Fn button and main command dial to select an Active D-Lighting option, see page 242.
138

High Dynamic Range (HDR)
Used with high-contrast subjects, High Dynamic Range (HDR) preserves details in highlights and shadows by combining two shots taken at different exposures. HDR is most effective when used with matrix metering (0 109; with other metering methods and a non-CPU lens, an exposure differential of Auto is equivalent to about 2 EV). It can not be used to record NEF (RAW) images. Movie recording (0 57), flash lighting, bracketing (0 153), multiple exposure (0 160), and time-lapse photography (0 168) can not be used while HDR is in effect and a shutter speed of A is not available.

+

First exposure (darker) Second exposure (brighter)
1 Select HDR (high dynamic range).
Press the G button to display the menus. Highlight HDR (high dynamic range) in the shooting menu and press 2.

Combined HDR image

G button

J

139

2 Select a mode.
Highlight HDR mode and press 2.

Highlight one of the following and press J. · To take a series of HDR photographs, select
6 On (series). HDR shooting will continue until you select Off for HDR mode. · To take one HDR photograph, select On (single photo). Normal shooting will resume automatically after you have created a single HDR photograph. · To exit without creating additional HDR photographs, select Off.
If On (series) or On (single photo) is selected, a k icon will be displayed in the control panel.

3 Choose the exposure differential.
To choose the difference in exposure between the two shots, highlight Exposure differential and press 2.

The options shown at right will be

displayed. Highlight an option and press J.

Choose higher values for high-contrast

subjects, but note that choosing a value

J

higher than required may not produce the

desired results; if Auto is selected, the

camera will automatically adjust exposure to suit the scene.

140

4 Choose the amount of smoothing.
To choose how much the boundaries between the two images are smoothed, highlight Smoothing and press 2.

The options shown at right will be displayed. Highlight an option and press J. Higher values produce a smoother composite image. Uneven shading may be visible with some subjects.

5 Frame a photograph, focus, and shoot.
The camera takes two exposures when the shutter-release button is pressed all the way down. l k will be displayed in the control panel and l u in the viewfinder while the images are combined; no photographs can be taken until recording is complete. Regardless of the option currently selected for release mode, only one photograph will be taken each time the shutter-release button is pressed.

Control panel Viewfinder

If On (series) is selected, HDR will only turn off when Off is selected for HDR mode; if On (single photo) is selected, HDR turns off automatically after the photograph is taken. The k icon clears from the display when HDR shooting ends.

J
D Framing HDR Photographs
The edges of the image will be cropped out. The desired results may not be achieved if the camera or subject moves during shooting. Use of a tripod is recommended. Depending on the scene, shadows may appear around bright objects or halos may appear around dark objects; this effect can be reduced by adjusting the amount of smoothing.
A Interval Timer Photography
If On (series) is selected for HDR mode before interval timer shooting begins, the camera will continue to shoot HDR photographs at the selected interval (if On (single photo) is selected, interval timer shooting will end after a single shot).
141

J
142

lFlash Photography

Using the Built-in Flash
The built-in flash has a Guide Number (GN) 12/39 (m/ft, ISO 100, 20 °C/68 °F) and provides coverage for the angle of view of 24 mm lens, or a 16 mm lens in DX format. It can be used not only when natural lighting is inadequate but to fill in shadows and backlit subjects or to add a catch light to the subject's eyes.
 Using the Built-in Flash: i, k, p, n, o, s, and w Modes

1 Choose a flash mode (0 144).

2 Take pictures.
The flash will pop up as required when the shutter-release button is pressed halfway, and fire when a photograph is taken. If the flash does not pop up automatically, DO NOT attempt to raise it by hand. Failure to observe this precaution could damage the flash.
 Using the Built-in Flash: P, S, A, M, and 0 Modes

1 Raise the flash.
Press the M (Y) button to raise the flash.

2 Choose a flash mode (P, S, A, and M modes
only; 0 144).
3 Take pictures.
The flash will fire whenever a picture is taken.

l
M (Y) button

A Metering
Select matrix or center-weighted metering to activate i-TTL balanced fill-flash for digital SLR. Standard i-TTL flash for digital SLR is activated automatically when spot metering is selected.
143

Flash Mode

The flash modes available vary with shooting mode:

i, k, p, n, s, w Auto

o
Auto +slow sync+ red-eye reduction

Auto +red-eye reduction

Auto +slow sync

j Off

j Off

P, A

Fill flash

Fill flash

0 Fill flash
S, M

Red-eye reduction

Red-eye reduction

Slow sync +red-eye reduction

Rear-curtain sync

Slow sync

Rear curtain+slow sync *
* S is displayed when setting is complete.
To choose a flash mode, press the M (Y) button and rotate the main command dial until the desired setting is displayed in the control panel.

M (Y) button

Main command dial

Control panel

l

A Lowering the Built-in Flash
To save power when the flash is not in use, press it gently downward until the latch clicks into place.

144

A Default Flash Modes
Default flash modes are shown below.

Mode

Default

i, k, p, n, w

Auto

s

Auto+red-eye reduction

Mode o
0, P, S, A, M

Default Auto+slow sync
Fill flash

A Flash Modes
The flash modes listed on the previous page may combine one or more of the following settings, as shown by the flash mode icon: · AUTO (auto flash): When lighting is poor or subject is back lit, flash pops up automatically
when shutter-release button is pressed halfway and fires as required. · Y (red-eye reduction): Use for portraits. Red-eye reduction lamp lights before flash fires,
reducing "red-eye." · j (off): Flash does not fire even when lighting is poor or subject is back-lit. · SLOW (slow sync): Shutter speed slows automatically to capture background lighting at night
or under low light. Use to include background lighting in portraits. · REAR (rear-curtain sync): Flash fires just before shutter closes, creating a stream of light behind
moving light sources (below at right). If this icon is not displayed, flash will fire as the shutter opens (front-curtain sync; the effect this produces with moving light sources is shown below at left).

Front-curtain sync

Rear-curtain sync

D The Built-in Flash
Use with lenses with focal lengths in FX format of 24­300 mm (16­300 mm in DX format; 0 288). Remove lens hoods to prevent shadows. The flash has a minimum range of 0.6 m (2 ft) and can not be used in the macro range of zoom lenses with a macro function. i-TTL flash control can be used at ISO sensitivities between 100 and 6400. At values over 6400, the desired results may not be achieved at some ranges or aperture settings.

l If the flash fires in continuous release mode (0 83), only one picture will be taken each time
the shutter-release button is pressed.

The shutter release may be briefly disabled to protect the flash after it has been used for several consecutive shots. The flash can be used again after a short pause.

145

A Shutter Speeds Available with the Built-in Flash
The following shutter speeds are available with the built-in flash.

Mode

Shutter speed

Mode

Shutter speed

i, P *, A *, k, p, s, w

1/200­1/60 s

S*

1/200­30 s

n, 0

1/200­1/125 s

M*

1/200­30 s, A

o

1/200­1 s

* Speeds as fast as 1/4,000 s are available with optional SB-910, SB-900, SB-800, SB-700, and SB-600 flash

units when 1/250 s (Auto FP) or 1/200 s (Auto FP) is selected for Custom Setting e1 (Flash sync

speed, 0 234). When 1/250 s (Auto FP) is selected, shutter speeds as fast as 1/250 s are available with

the built-in flash.

A Flash Control Mode
The camera supports the following i-TTL flash control modes: · i-TTL balanced fill-flash for digital SLR: Flash emits series of nearly invisible preflashes (monitor
preflashes) immediately before main flash. Preflashes reflected from objects in all areas of frame are picked up by 2,016-pixel RGB sensor and are analyzed in combination with range information from matrix metering system to adjust flash output for natural balance between main subject and ambient background lighting. If type G or D lens is used, distance information is included when calculating flash output. Precision of calculation can be increased for non-CPU lenses by providing lens data (focal length and maximum aperture; see 0 172). Not available when spot metering is used. · Standard i-TTL flash for digital SLR: Flash output adjusted to bring lighting in frame to standard level; brightness of background is not taken into account. Recommended for shots in which main subject is emphasized at expense of background details, or when exposure compensation is used. Standard i-TTL flash for digital SLR is activated automatically when spot metering is selected.

The flash control mode for the built-in flash can be selected using Custom Setting e3 (Flash cntrl for built-in flash, 0 236). The information display shows the flash control mode for the built-in flash as follows:

Flash sync

Auto FP (0 234)

i-TTL

--

Manual

--

l

Repeating flash

--

Commander mode

146

A Aperture, Sensitivity, and Flash Range
Flash range varies with sensitivity (ISO equivalency) and aperture.

Aperture at ISO equivalent of 100 200 400 800 1600 3200 6400 1.4 2 2.8 4 5.6 8 11 2 2.8 4 5.6 8 11 16 2.8 4 5.6 8 11 16 22 4 5.6 8 11 16 22 32 5.6 8 11 16 22 32 -- 8 11 16 22 32 -- -- 11 16 22 32 -- -- -- 16 22 32 -- -- -- --

m 0.7­8.5 0.6­6.0 0.6­4.2 0.6­3.0 0.6­2.1 0.6­1.5 0.6­1.1 0.6­0.8

Range ft
2ft 4in.­27ft 11in. 2ft­19ft 8in. 2ft­13ft 9in. 2ft­9ft 10in. 2ft­6ft 11in. 2ft­4ft 11in. 2ft­3ft 7in. 2ft­2ft 7in.

The built-in flash has a minimum range of 0.6 m (2 ft).

In mode P, the maximum aperture (minimum f-number) is limited according to ISO sensitivity, as shown below:

Maximum aperture at ISO equivalent of:

100

200

400

800

1600

3200

6400

2.8

3.5

4

5

5.6

7.1

8

If the maximum aperture of the lens is smaller than given above, the maximum value for aperture will be the maximum aperture of the lens.

A See Also
See page 149 for information on locking flash value (FV) for a metered subject before recomposing a photograph.

For information on auto FP high-speed sync and choosing a flash sync speed, see Custom Setting e1 (Flash sync speed, 0 234). For information on choosing the slowest shutter speed available when using the flash, see Custom Setting e2 (Flash shutter speed, 0 235). For information on flash control and using the built-in flash in commander mode, see Custom Setting e3 (Flash cntrl for built-in flash, 0 236).

See page 292 for information on using optional flash units.

l

147

Flash Compensation

(P, S, A, and M Modes Only)

Flash compensation is used to alter flash output by from ­3EV to +1EV in increments of 1/3EV, changing the brightness of the main subject relative to the background. Flash output can be increased to make the main subject appear brighter, or reduced to prevent unwanted highlights or reflections.

Press the M (Y) button and rotate the sub-command dial until the desired value is displayed in the control panel. In general, choose positive values to make the main subject brighter, negative values to make it darker.

M (Y) button

Sub-command dial

At values other than ±0.0, a Y icon will be displayed in the control panel and viewfinder after you release the M (Y) button. The current value for flash compensation can be confirmed by pressing the M (Y) button.

Normal flash output can be restored by setting flash compensation to ±0.0. Flash compensation is not reset when the camera is turned off.

±0 EV (M (Y) button pressed)
­0.3 EV

+1.0 EV

l A Optional Flash Units
Flash compensation is also available with optional SB-910, SB-900, SB-800, SB-700, SB-600, SB-400, and SB-R200 flash units. The SB-910, SB-900, SB-800, SB-700, and SB-600 also allow flash compensation to be set using the controls on the flash unit; the value selected with the flash unit is added to the value selected with the camera.
A See Also
For information on choosing the size of the increments available for flash compensation, see Custom Setting b2 (EV steps for exposure cntrl, 0 224). For information on choosing how flash and exposure compensation combine, see Custom Setting e4 (Exposure comp. for flash, 0 240). For information on automatically varying flash level over a series of shots, see page 153.
148

FV Lock
This feature is used to lock flash output, allowing photographs to be recomposed without changing the flash level and ensuring that flash output is appropriate to the subject even when the subject is not positioned in the center of the frame. Flash output is adjusted automatically for any changes in ISO sensitivity and aperture.
To use FV lock:
1 Assign FV lock to the Fn button.
Select FV lock for Custom Setting f2 (Assign Fn button, 0 242).

2 Raise the flash.
In P, S, A, M, and 0 modes, the flash can be raised by pressing the M (Y) button. In i, k, p, n, o, s, and w modes, the flash will pop up automatically when required.
3 Focus.
Position the subject in the center of the frame and press the shutter-release button halfway to focus.
4 Lock flash level.
After confirming that the flash ready indicator (M) is displayed in the viewfinder, press the Fn button. The flash will emit a monitor preflash to determine the appropriate flash level. Flash output will be locked at this level and FV lock icons (e) will appear in the viewfinder.

M (Y) button
l
Fn button

149

5 Recompose the photograph.
6 Take the photograph.
Press the shutter-release button the rest of the way down to shoot. If desired, additional pictures can be taken without releasing FV lock.
7 Release FV lock.
Press the Fn button to release FV lock. Confirm that the FV lock icon (e) is no longer displayed in the viewfinder.

D Using FV Lock with the Built-in Flash
FV lock is only available with the built-in flash when TTL is selected for Custom Setting e3 (Flash cntrl for built-in flash, 0 236).

A Using FV Lock with Optional Flash Units
FV lock is also available with optional flash units in TTL and (where supported) monitor preflash AA and monitor pre-flash A flash control modes. Note that when commander mode is selected for Custom Setting e3 (Flash cntrl for built-in flash, 0 236), you will need to set the flash control mode for the master or at least one remote group to TTL or AA.

A Metering

l The metering areas for FV lock when using optional flash unit are as follows:

Flash unit

Flash mode

Metered area

Stand-alone flash unit

i-TTL AA

5-mm circle in center of frame Area metered by flash exposure meter

i-TTL

Used with other flash units (Advanced Wireless Lighting)

AA

A (master flash)

Entire frame Area metered by flash exposure meter

A See Also
For information on using the depth-of-field preview or A AE-L/AF-L button for FV lock, see Custom Setting f3 (Assign preview button, 0 244) or Custom Setting f4 (Assign AE-L/AF-L button, 0 244).

150

tOther Shooting Options

Two-Button Reset: Restoring Default

Settings

The camera settings listed below can be restored to default values by holding the W (S) and E buttons down together for more than two seconds (these buttons are marked by a green dot). The control panel turns off briefly while settings are reset.

E button

W (S) button

Option

Default

0

Image quality

JPEG normal

93

Image size

Large

95

White balance

Auto > Normal

115

Fine tuning

A-B: 0, G-M: 0

117

HDR (high dynamic range)

Off 1

139

ISO sensitivity settings

ISO sensitivity

Auto and scene modes P, S, A, M

AUTO 105
100

Auto ISO sensitivity control

Off

107

Interval timer shooting

Off 2

164

Autofocus (viewfinder)

Autofocus mode

AF-A

97

AF-area mode

n, x, 0, 1, 2, 3 m, w

Single-point AF

t

39-point dynamic-area AF 99

i, j, k, l, p, o, r, s, t, u, v, y, z, P, S, A, M

Auto-area AF

151

Option

Default

0

Autofocus (live view/movie)

Autofocus mode

AF-S

51

AF-area mode

m, r, w, 1, 2, 3, P, S, A, M

Wide-area AF

n, 0

Normal-area AF

52

i, j, k, l, p, o, s, t, u, v, x, y, z

Face-priority AF

Focus point 3

Center

101

Metering

Matrix

109

AE lock hold

Off

102, 110

Bracketing

Off

153

Picture Control settings 4

Unmodified

129

Flash compensation

Off

148

Exposure compensation

Off

112

Exposure delay mode

Off

231

Flash mode

i, k, p, n, w

Auto

s

Auto+red-eye reduction

144

o

Auto+slow sync

0, P, S, A, M

Fill flash

FV lock

Off

149

Multiple exposure

Off 5

160

Flexible program

Off

75

+ NEF (RAW)

Off

242

1 Exposure differential and smoothing are not reset. 2 If interval timer shooting is currently in progress, shooting will end. Starting time, shooting interval, and
number of intervals and shots are not reset. 3 Focus point not displayed if auto-area AF is selected for AF-area mode. 4 Current Picture Control only. 5 If multiple exposure is currently in progress, shooting will end and multiple exposure will be created
from exposures recorded to that point. Gain and number of shots are not reset.

t

152

Bracketing

(P, S, A, and M Modes Only)

Bracketing automatically varies exposure, flash level, Active D-Lighting (ADL), or white balance slightly with each shot, "bracketing" the current value. Choose in situations in which it is difficult to set exposure, flash level (i-TTL and, where supported, auto aperture flash control modes only; see pages 146, 236, and 294), white balance, or Active D-Lighting and there is not time to check results and adjust settings with each shot, or to experiment with different settings for the same subject.
 Exposure and Flash Bracketing
To vary exposure and/or flash level over a series of photographs:

1 Select flash or exposure bracketing for
Custom Setting e6 (Auto bracketing set) in the Custom Settings menu.
To display the menus, press the G button. Select Custom Setting e6 (Auto bracketing set) in the Custom Settings menu, highlight G button an option, and press J. Choose AE & flash to vary both exposure and flash level, AE only to vary only exposure, or Flash only to vary only flash level.

2 Choose the number of shots.
Pressing the D button, rotate the main command dial to choose the number of shots in the bracketing sequence and the order in which they will be taken.

Number of shots

Bracketing progress indicator

D button Main command dial

Control panel

No. of shots Bracketing progress indicator

Bracketing order

t

Normal exposure, underexposure, overexposure

Normal exposure, overexposure

Normal exposure, underexposure

D will be displayed in the viewfinder (see right); the control panel will show M.

153

3 Select a bracketing increment.
Pressing the D button and rotate the sub-command dial to choose a bracketing increment.

Bracketing increment

D button Sub-command dial

Control panel

A See Also
For information on choosing the size of the increment, see Custom Setting b2 (EV steps for exposure cntrl, 0 224). For information on choosing the order in which bracketing is performed, see Custom Setting e7 (Bracketing order, 0 241).

4 Frame a photograph, focus, and shoot.
The camera will vary exposure and/or flash level shot-byshot according to the bracketing program selected. Modifications to exposure are added to those made with exposure compensation (0 112), making it possible to achieve exposure compensation values of more than 5 EV.
While bracketing is in effect, a bracketing progress indicator will be displayed in the control panel. A segment will disappear from the indicator after each shot: the y segment when the unmodified shot is taken, the z segment when the shot with the negative increment is taken, and the x segment when the shot with the positive increment is taken.

t

Exposure modified by: 0 EV (y)

Exposure modified by: ­1 EV (z)

Exposure modified by: +1 EV (x)

To cancel bracketing, press the D button and rotate the main command dial until the bracketing progress indicator and M icon are no longer displayed.

154

A Exposure and Flash Bracketing
In continuous low speed and continuous high speed release modes, shooting will pause after the number of shots specified in the bracketing program have been taken. Shooting will resume the next time the shutter-release button is pressed. In self-timer mode, the camera will take the number of shots selected in Step 2 on page 153 each time the shutterrelease button is pressed, regardless of the option selected for Custom Setting c3 (Selftimer) > Number of shots (0 227); the interval between shots is however controlled by Custom Setting c3 (Self-timer) > Interval between shots. In other modes, one shot will be taken each time the shutter-release button is pressed. If the memory card fills before all shots in the sequence have been taken, shooting can be resumed from the next shot in the sequence after the memory card has been replaced or shots have been deleted to make room on the memory card. If the camera is turned off before all shots in the sequence have been taken, bracketing will resume from the next shot in the sequence when the camera is turned on.
A Exposure Bracketing
The camera modifies exposure by varying shutter speed and aperture (mode P), aperture (mode S), or shutter speed (modes A and M). If On is selected for ISO sensitivity settings > Auto ISO sensitivity control (0 107) in modes P, S, and A, the camera will automatically vary ISO sensitivity for optimum exposure when the limits of the camera exposure system are exceeded; in mode M, the camera will first use auto ISO sensitivity control to bring exposure as close as possible to the optimum and then bracket this exposure by varying shutter speed.
t
155

 White Balance Bracketing
The camera creates multiple copies of each photograph, each with a different white balance. For more information on white balance, see page 115.
1 Select white balance bracketing.
Choose WB bracketing for Custom Setting e6 Auto bracketing set.

2 Choose the number of shots.
Pressing the D button, rotate the main command dial to choose the number of shots in the bracketing sequence and the order in which they will be taken.

Number of shots

Bracketing progress indicator

D button Main command dial

Control panel

D will be displayed in the viewfinder (see right); the control panel will show W.

3 Select a white balance increment.
Pressing the D button, rotate the sub-command dial to choose from increments of 1 (5 mired; 0 119), 2 (10 mired), or 3 (15 mired). The B value indicates the amount of blue, the A value the amount of amber (0 117).

White balance increment

t

D button Sub-command dial

Control panel

The bracketing programs with an increment of 1 are listed below.

Control panel

Bracketing progress indicator

No. of shots 2 2 3

Increment 1B 1A
1A, 1B

Bracketing order 0/1B 0/1A
0/1A/1B

156

4 Frame a photograph, focus, and shoot.
Each shot will be processed to create the number of copies specified in the bracketing program, and each copy will have a different white balance. Modifications to white balance are added to the white balance adjustment made with white balance fine-tuning.
If the number of shots in the bracketing program is greater than the number of exposures remaining, n and the icon for the affected card will flash in the control panel, a flashing j icon will appear in the viewfinder as shown at right, and the shutter release will be disabled. Shooting can begin when a new memory card is inserted.
To cancel bracketing, press the D button and rotate the main command dial until the bracketing progress indicator and W icon are no longer displayed.

A White Balance Bracketing

White balance bracketing is not available at an image quality of NEF (RAW). Selecting NEF

(RAW), NEF (RAW)+JPEG fine, NEF (RAW)+JPEG normal, or NEF (RAW)+JPEG basic

t

cancels white balance bracketing.

White balance bracketing affects only color temperature (the amber-blue axis in the white balance fine-tuning display, 0 117). No adjustments are made on the green-magenta axis.

In self-timer mode (0 85), the number of copies specified in the white-balance program will be created each time the shutter is released, regardless of the option selected for Custom Setting c3 (Self-timer) > Number of shots (0 227).

If the camera is turned off while the memory card access lamp is lit, the camera will power off only after all photographs in the sequence have been recorded.

157

 ADL Bracketing
The camera varies Active D-Lighting over a series of exposures. For more information on Active D-Lighting, see page 137.
1 Select ADL bracketing.
Choose ADL bracketing for Custom Setting e6 Auto bracketing set.

2 Choose the number of shots.
Pressing the D button, rotate the main command dial to choose the number of shots in the bracketing sequence. Choose two shots to take one photograph with Active D-Lighting off and another at the value currently selected for Active D-Lighting in the shooting menu (if Active D-Lighting is off, the second shot will be taken with Active D-Lighting set to Auto). Choose three shots to take a series of photographs with Active D-Lighting set to Off, Normal, and High.

Number of shots

Bracketing progress indicator

D button Main command dial

Control panel

D will be displayed in the viewfinder (see right); the control panel will show d.

t

158

3 Frame a photograph, focus, and shoot.
The camera will vary Active D-Lighting shot-by-shot according to the bracketing program selected. While bracketing is in effect, a bracketing progress indicator will be displayed in the control panel. A segment will disappear from the indicator after each shot: the y segment when the first shot is taken, the 0 segment when the second shot is taken, and the 1 segment when the third shot (if applicable) is taken.
To cancel bracketing, press the D button and rotate the main command dial until the bracketing progress indicator and d icon are no longer displayed.
A ADL Bracketing
In continuous low speed and continuous high speed release modes, shooting will pause after the number of shots specified in the bracketing program have been taken. Shooting will resume the next time the shutter-release button is pressed. In self-timer mode, the
t camera will take the number of shots selected in Step 2 on page 158 each time the shutter-
release button is pressed, regardless of the option selected for Custom Setting c3 (Selftimer) > Number of shots (0 227); the interval between shots is however controlled by Custom Setting c3 (Self-timer) > Interval between shots. In other modes, one shot will be taken each time the shutter-release button is pressed. If the memory card fills before all shots in the sequence have been taken, shooting can be resumed from the next shot in the sequence after the memory card has been replaced or shots have been deleted to make room on the memory card. If the camera is turned off before all shots in the sequence have been taken, bracketing will resume from the next shot in the sequence when the camera is turned on.
159

Multiple Exposure

(P, S, A, and M Modes Only)

Follow the steps below to record a series of two or three exposures in a single photograph. Multiple exposures can make use of RAW data from the camera image sensor to produce colors noticeably superior to those in software-generated photographic overlays.
 Creating a Multiple Exposure
Multiple exposures can not be recorded in live view. Exit live view before proceeding. Note that at default settings, shooting will end and a multiple exposure will be recorded automatically if no operations are performed for 30 s.
A Extended Recording Times
For an interval between exposures of more than 30 s, extend the meter-off delay using Custom Setting c2 (Standby timer, 0 227). The maximum interval between exposures is 30 s longer than the option selected for Custom Setting c2. If the monitor has turned off during playback or menu operations, shooting will end 30 s after the exposure meters turn off and a multiple exposure will be created from the exposures that have been recorded to that point.

1 Select Multiple exposure in the
shooting menu.
Press the G button to display the menus. Highlight Multiple exposure in the shooting menu and press 2.

G button

t

160

2 Select a mode.
Highlight Multiple exposure mode and press 2.
Highlight one of the following and press J. · To take a series of multiple exposures, select
6 On (series). Multiple exposure shooting will continue until you select Off for Multiple exposure mode. · To take one multiple exposure, select On (single photo). Normal shooting will resume automatically after you have created a single multiple exposure. · To exit without creating additional multiple exposures, select Off. If On (series) or On (single photo) is selected, a n icon will be displayed in the control panel.
3 Choose the number of shots.
Highlight Number of shots and press 2.
Press 1 or 3 to choose the number of exposures that will be combined to form a single photograph and press J.
t
161

4 Choose the amount of gain.
Highlight Auto gain and press 2.

The following options will be displayed. Highlight an option and press J. · On: Gain is adjusted according to number
of exposures actually recorded (gain for each exposure is set to 1/2 for 2 exposures, 1/3 for 3 exposures, etc.). · Off: Gain is not adjusted when recording multiple exposure. Recommended if background is dark.

5 Frame a photograph, focus, and shoot.
In continuous high-speed and continuous low-speed release modes (0 83), the camera records all exposures in a single burst. If On (series) is selected, the camera will continue to record multiple exposures while the shutter-release button is pressed; if On (single photo) is selected, multiple exposure shooting will end after the first photograph. In self-timer mode, the camera will automatically record the number of exposures selected in Step 3 on page 161, regardless of the option selected for Custom Setting c3 (Self-timer) > Number of shots (0 227); the interval between shots is however controlled by Custom Setting c3 (Self-timer) > Interval between shots. In other release modes, one photograph will be taken each time the shutter-release button is pressed; continue shooting until all exposures have been recorded (for information on interrupting a multiple exposure before all photographs are recorded, see page 163).

The n icon will flash until shooting ends. If

On (series) is selected, multiple exposure

t

shooting will only end when Off is selected for multiple exposure mode; if On (single

photo) is selected, multiple exposure

shooting ends automatically when the multiple exposure is complete. The n

icon clears from the display when multiple exposure shooting ends.

162

 Interrupting Multiple Exposures
To interrupt a multiple exposure before the specified number of exposures have been taken, select Off for multiple exposure mode. If shooting ends before the specified number of exposures have been taken, a multiple exposure will be created from the exposures that have been recorded to that point. If Auto gain is on, gain will be adjusted to reflect the number of exposures actually recorded. Note that shooting will end automatically if: · A two-button reset is performed (0 151) · The camera is turned off · The battery is exhausted · Pictures are deleted
D Multiple Exposures
Do not remove or replace the memory card while recording a multiple exposure. Multiple exposures can not be recorded in live view. Taking photographs in live view resets Multiple exposure mode to Off. Noise (randomly-spaced bright pixels, fog, or lines) may appear in photographs taken with Off selected for auto gain (0 162). The information listed in the playback photo information display (including metering, exposure, shooting mode, focal length, date of recording and camera orientation) is for the first shot in the multiple exposure.
A Interval Timer Photography
t If interval timer photography is activated before the first exposure is taken, the camera will
record exposures at the selected interval until the number of exposures specified in the multiple exposure menu have been taken (the number of shots listed in the interval timer shooting menu is ignored). These exposures will then be recorded as a single photograph and interval timer shooting will end (if On (single photo) is selected for multiple exposure mode, multiple exposure shooting will also end automatically).
A Other Settings
While a multiple exposure is being shot, memory cards can not be formatted and some menu items are grayed out and can not be changed.
163

Interval Timer Photography

The camera is equipped to take photographs automatically at preset intervals.
D Before Shooting
Do not select self-timer (E), remote (4), or MUP release mode when using the interval timer. Before beginning interval timer photography, take a test shot at current settings and view the results in the monitor.
Before choosing a starting time, select Time zone and date in the setup menu and make sure that the camera clock is set to the correct time and date (0 253).
Use of a tripod is recommended. Mount the camera on a tripod before shooting begins. To ensure that shooting is not interrupted, be sure the camera EN-EL15 battery is fully charged. If in doubt, charge the battery before use or use an EH-5b AC adapter and EP-5B power connector (available separately).

1 Select Interval timer shooting in the
shooting menu.
Press the G button to display the menus. Highlight Interval timer shooting in the shooting menu and press 2.

G button

2 Choose a starting time.
Chose from the following starting triggers. · To start shooting immediately, highlight Now
and press 2. Shooting begins about 3 s after settings are completed; proceed to Step 3. · To choose a starting time, highlight Start time and press 2 to display the start time options shown at right. Press 4 or 2 to highlight hours or minutes and press 1 or 3 to change. Press 2 to continue.
3 t Choose the interval. Press 4 or 2 to highlight hours, minutes, or seconds; press 1 or 3 to change. Choose an interval longer than the time needed to take the number of shots selected in Step 4. If the interval is too short, the number of photos taken may be less than the total listed in Step 4 (the number of intervals multiplied by the number of shots per interval). Press 2 to continue.

164

4 Choose the number of intervals and
number of shots per interval.
Press 4 or 2 to highlight number of intervals or number of shots; press 1 or 3 to change. Press 2 to continue.
Number of Number Total intervals of shots/ number of interval shots
5 Start shooting.
Highlight On and press J (to return to the shooting menu without starting the interval timer, highlight Off and press J). The first series of shots will be taken at the specified starting time, or after about 3 s if Now was selected for Choose start time in Step 2. Shooting will continue at the selected interval until all shots have been taken. Note that because the shutter speed, frame rate, and time needed to record images may vary from one interval to the next, the time between the end of one interval and the beginning of the next may vary. If shooting can not proceed at current settings (for example, if a shutter speed of A is currently selected in manual exposure mode or the start time is in less than a minute), a warning will be displayed in the monitor.
t
D Out of Memory
If the memory card is full, the interval timer will remain active but no pictures will be taken. Resume shooting (0 167) after deleting some pictures or turning the camera off and inserting another memory card.
A Cover the Viewfinder
To prevent light entering via the viewfinder interfering with exposure, remove the rubber eyecup and cover the viewfinder with the supplied DK-5 eyepiece cap (0 86).
165

A Interval Timer Photography
Interval timer photography can not be combined with long time-exposures (bulb photography, 0 79) or live view (0 49) or time-lapse (0 168) photography and is not available in movie live view (0 57) or when Record movies is selected for Custom Setting g4 (Assign shutter button, 0 248).
A Release Mode
Regardless of the release mode selected, the camera will take the specified number of shots at each interval. In CH (continuous high speed) mode, photographs will be taken at a rate of up to 5.5 shots per second. In S (single frame) and CL (continuous low-speed) modes, photographs will be taken at the rate chosen for Custom Setting d5 (CL mode shooting speed, 0 229); in mode J, camera noise will be reduced.
A Bracketing
Adjust bracketing settings before starting interval timer photography. If exposure, flash, or ADL bracketing is active while interval timer photography is in effect, the camera will take the number of shots in the bracketing program at each interval, regardless of the number of shots specified in the interval timer menu. If white balance bracketing is active while interval timer photography is in effect, the camera will take one shot at each interval and process it to create the number of copies specified in the bracketing program.
A During Shooting
During interval timer photography, the Q icon in the control panel will flash. Immediately before the next shooting interval begins, the shutter speed display will show the number of intervals remaining, and the aperture display will show the number of shots remaining in the current interval. At other times, the number of intervals remaining and the number of shots in each interval can be viewed by pressing the shutterrelease button halfway (once the button is released, the shutter speed and aperture will be displayed until the standby timer expires).
To view current interval timer settings, select Interval timer shooting between shots. While interval timer photography is in progress, the interval timer menu will show the starting time, the shooting interval, and the number of intervals and shots remaining. None of these items can be changed while interval timer photography is in progress.
Pictures can be played back and shooting and menu settings can be adjusted freely while
t interval timer photography is in progress. The monitor will turn off automatically about four seconds before each interval.
166

 Pausing Interval Timer Photography
Interval timer photography can be paused by: · Pressing the J button between intervals · Highlighting Start > Pause in the interval timer menu and pressing J · Turning the camera off and then on again (if desired, the memory card can be
replaced while the camera is off) · Selecting self-timer (E), remote (4), or MUP release mode
To resume shooting:
1 Choose a new starting time.
Choose a new starting time as described on page 164.
2 Resume shooting.
Highlight Restart and press J. Note that if interval timer photography was paused during shooting, any shots remaining in the current interval will be canceled.
 Interrupting Interval Timer Photography
Interval timer shooting will end automatically if the battery is exhausted. Interval timer photography can also be ended by: · Selecting Start > Off in the interval timer menu · Performing a two button reset (0 151) · Selecting Reset shooting menu in the shooting menu (0 214) · Changing bracketing settings (0 153) · Terminating HDR (0 139) or multiple exposure shooting (0 163) Normal shooting will resume when interval timer photography ends.
 No Photograph
The camera will skip the current interval if any of the following situations persist for t
eight seconds or more after the interval was due to start: the photograph or photographs for the previous interval have yet to be taken, the memory buffer is full, or the camera is unable to focus in AF-S or when single-servo AF is selected in AF-A (note that the camera focuses again before each shot). Shooting will resume with the next interval.
167

Time-Lapse Photography

The camera automatically takes photos at selected intervals to create a silent timelapse movie using the options currently selected for Movie settings in the shooting menu (0 65).
A Before Shooting
Before beginning time-lapse photography, take a test shot at current settings (framing the photo in the viewfinder for an accurate exposure preview) and view the results in the monitor. To record changes in brightness, choose manual exposure (0 78); for consistent coloration, choose a white balance setting other than auto (0 115). We recommend that you briefly switch to movie live view and check the current image area crop in the monitor (0 57); note, however, that time-lapse photography is not available in live view.
Use of a tripod is recommended. Mount the camera on a tripod before shooting begins. To ensure that shooting is not interrupted, use an optional EH-5b AC adapter and EP-5B power connector or a fully-charged EN-EL15 battery.

1 Select Time-lapse photography in the
shooting menu.
Press the G button to display the menus. Highlight Time-lapse photography in the shooting menu and press 2.
G button

2 Press 2.
Press 2 to proceed to Step 3 and choose an interval and shooting time. To record a timelapse movie using the default interval of 5 seconds and shooting time of 25 minutes, proceed to step 5.

3 Choose the interval.

Press 4 or 2 to highlight minutes or

t

seconds; press 1 or 3 to change. Choose an interval longer than the slowest anticipated

shutter speed. Press 2 to continue.

168

4 Select the shooting time.
Press 4 or 2 to highlight hours or minutes; press 1 or 3 to change. The maximum shooting time is 7 hours and 59 minutes. Press 2 to continue.
5 Start shooting.
Highlight On and press J (to return to the shooting menu without starting time-lapse photography, highlight Off and press J). Time-lapse photography starts after 3 s. The camera takes photographs at the interval selected in Step 3 for the time selected in Step 4. The memory card access lamp lights while each shot is recorded; note that because shutter speed and the time needed to record the image to the memory card may vary from shot to shot, the interval between a shot being recorded and the start of the next shot may vary. Shooting will not begin if a time-lapse movie can not be recorded at current settings (for example, if the memory card is full, the interval or shooting time is zero, the interval is longer than the shooting time, or remote (4) release mode is selected). When complete, time-lapse movies are recorded to the memory card selected for Movie settings > Destination (0 65).
t
169

D Time-Lapse Photography
Time-lapse is not available in live view (0 49, 57), at a shutter speed of A (0 79), when bracketing (0 153), High Dynamic Range (HDR, 0 139), multiple exposure (0 160), or interval timer photography (0 164) is active.

A Release Mode
Regardless of the release mode selected, the camera will take one shot at each interval. The self-timer can not be used. Time-lapse photography is not available in remote (4) release mode.

A Calculating the Length of the Final Movie
The total number of frames in the final movie can be approximated by dividing the shooting time by the interval and rounding up. The length of the final movie can then be calculated by diving the number of shots by the frame rate selected for Movie settings > Frame size/frame rate. A 48 frame movie recorded at 1920 × 1080; 24p, for example, will be about two seconds long. The maximum length for movies recorded using time-lapse photography is 20 minutes.

Length recorded/ maximum length

A Cover the Viewfinder
To prevent light entering via the viewfinder interfering with
exposure, remove the rubber eyecup and cover the viewfinder with the supplied DK-5 eyepiece cap (0 86).

Memory card indicator
Frame size/ frame rate

A During Shooting
During time-lapse photography, a Q icon will flash and the timelapse recording indicator will be displayed in the control panel. The time remaining (in hours and minutes) appears in the shutter-speed display immediately before each frame is recorded. At other times, the time remaining can be viewed by pressing the shutter-release button halfway. Regardless of the option selected for Custom Setting c2 (Standby timer, 0 227), the standby timer will not expire during shooting.

To view current time-lapse photography settings, press the G button between shots. While time-lapse photography is in progress, the time-lapse photography menu will show the interval and the time remaining. These settings can not be changed while time-lapse photography is in progress, nor can pictures be played back or other
t menu settings adjusted.

170

 Interrupting Time-Lapse Photography
Time-lapse photography will end automatically if the battery is exhausted. The following will also end time-lapse photography: · Selecting Start > Off in the Time-lapse photography menu · Pressing the J button between frames or immediately after a frame is recorded · Turning the camera off · Removing the lens · Connecting a USB or HDMI cable · Inserting a memory card into an empty slot · Pressing the shutter-release button all the way down to take a photograph · Selecting remote (4) release mode · Selecting mode U1 or U2, or selecting another mode after starting time-lapse
photography in mode U1 or U2 A movie will be created from the frames shot to the point where time-lapse photography ended. Note that time-lapse photography will end and no movie will be recorded if the power source is removed or disconnected or the destination memory card is ejected.
 No Photograph
The camera will skip the current frame if it is unable to focus using single-servo autofocus (AF-S or single-servo autofocus selected for AF-A; note that the camera focuses again before each shot). Shooting will resume with the next frame.
t
A Image Review
The K button can not be used to view pictures while time-lapse photography is in progress, but the current frame will be displayed for a few seconds after each shot if On is selected for Image review in the playback menu (0 212). Other playback operations can not be performed while the frame is displayed.
A See Also
For information on setting a beep to sound when time-lapse photography is complete, see Custom Setting d1 (Beep, 0 228).
171

Non-CPU Lenses
By specifying lens data (lens focal length and maximum aperture), the user can gain access to a variety of CPU lens functions when using a non-CPU lens. If the focal length of the lens is known: · Power zoom can be used with optional flash units (0 294) · Lens focal length is listed (with an asterisk) in the playback photo info display If the maximum aperture of the lens is known: · The aperture value is displayed in the control panel and viewfinder · Flash level is adjusted for changes in aperture if the flash unit supports AA (auto
aperture) mode · Aperture is listed (with an asterisk) in the playback photo info display Specifying both the focal length and maximum aperture of the lens: · Enables color matrix metering (note that it may be necessary to use center-
weighted or spot metering to achieve accurate results with some lenses, including Reflex-NIKKOR lenses) · Improves the precision of center-weighted and spot metering and i-TTL balanced fill-flash for digital SLR
t
172

The camera can store data for up to nine non-CPU lenses. To enter or edit data for a non-CPU lens:
1 Select Non-CPU lens data.
Press the G button to display the menus. Highlight Non-CPU lens data in the setup menu and press 2.
G button
2 Choose a lens number.
Highlight Lens number and press 4 or 2 to choose a lens number between 1 and 9.

3 Enter the focal length and aperture.
Highlight Focal length (mm) or Maximum aperture and press 4 or 2 to edit the highlighted item. Focal length can be selected from values between 6 and 4,000 mm, maximum aperture from values between f/1.2 and f/22.

A Focal Length Not Listed
If the correct focal length is not listed, choose the closest value greater than the actual focal length of the lens.

A Teleconverters and Zoom Lenses
The maximum aperture for teleconverters is the combined maximum aperture of the teleconverter and the lens. Note that lens data are not adjusted when non-CPU lenses are zoomed in or out. The data for different focal lengths can be entered as separate lens numbers, or the data for the lens can be edited to reflect the new values for lens focal length and maximum aperture each time zoom is adjusted.

4 Select Done.

t

Highlight Done and press J. The specified

focal length and aperture will be stored

under the chosen lens number.

173

To recall lens data when using a non-CPU lens:
1 Assign non-CPU lens number selection to a camera control.
Select Choose non-CPU lens number for Custom Setting f2 (Assign Fn button, 0 242) or Custom Setting f3 (Assign preview button, 0 244).
2 Use the selected control to choose the lens number.
Press the selected button and rotate the main command dial until the desired lens number is displayed in the control panel.
Focal length Maximum aperture

Fn button Main command dial

Lens number Control panel

t
174

The GP-1 GPS Unit

The GP-1 GPS unit (available separately) can be connected to the camera's accessory terminal (0 298) using the cable supplied with the GP-1, allowing information on the camera's current position to be recorded when photographs are taken. Turn the camera off before connecting the GP-1; for more information, see the GP-1 manual.

 Setup Menu Options

The GPS item in the setup menu contains the options listed below.

· Standby timer: Choose whether the exposure meters turn off automatically when the

GP-1 is attached.

Option

Description

Exposure meters turn off automatically if no operations are performed for the time selected for Custom Setting c2 (Standby timer, 0 227; to allow the camera Enable time to acquire GPS data, the delay is extended by up to one minute after the exposure meters are activated or the camera is turned on). This reduces the drain on the battery.

Disable Exposure meters do not turn off while the GP-1 is connected.

· Position: This item is only available if the GP-1 is connected, when it displays the

current latitude, longitude, altitude, and Coordinated Universal Time (UTC) as

reported by the GP-1.

· Use GPS to set camera clock: Select Yes to synchronize the camera clock with the time

reported by the GPS device.

A Coordinated Universal Time (UTC)
UTC data is provided by the GPS device and is independent of the camera clock.

A The n Icon

t

Connection status is shown by the n icon:

· n (static): Camera has established communication with GP-1.

Photo information for pictures taken while this icon is displayed

include an additional page of GPS data (0 183).

· n (flashing): The GP-1 is searching for a signal. Pictures taken while

the icon is flashing do not include GPS data.

· No icon: No new GPS data have been received from the GP-1 for at

least two seconds. Pictures taken when the n icon is not displayed do not include GPS

data.

175

t
176

IMore on Playback
Full-Frame Playback
To play photographs back, press the K button. The most recent photograph will be displayed in the monitor.

O (Q) button K button

K button Multi selector Sub-command dial

G button c (b) button L (U) button X (T) button W (S) button

J button

Main command dial

A Rotate Tall
To display "tall" (portrait-orientation) photographs in tall orientation, select On for the Rotate tall option in the playback menu (0 212).
I
A Image Review
When On is selected for Image review in the playback menu (0 212), photographs are automatically displayed in the monitor for about 4 s after shooting (because the camera is already in the correct orientation, images are not rotated automatically during image review). In continuous release mode, display begins when shooting ends, with the first photograph in the current series displayed.
177

To
View additional photographs

Use

Description

Press 2 to view photographs in order recorded, 4 to view photographs in reverse order.

View photo information

Press 1 or 3 to view information about current photograph (0 179).

View thumbnails Zoom in on photograph
Delete images
Change protect status

W (S) See page 185 for more information.

X (T) See page 187 for more information.

O (Q) L (U)

Confirmation dialog will be displayed. Press O (Q) again to delete photo.
To protect image, or to remove protection from protected image, press L (U) (0 188).

Return to shooting mode

/ K

Monitor will turn off. immediately.

Photographs can be taken

Retouch photo or play movie

Create retouched copy of current photograph (0 261). If c (b)/J current picture is marked with 1 icon to show that it is a
movie, pressing J starts movie playback (0 67).

A Choosing a Memory Card Slot

If two memory cards are inserted, you can select a card for

playback by holding the D button and pressing 1 during full-

frame or thumbnail playback. The dialog shown at right will be

displayed; highlight the desired slot and press 2 to list the folders

on the selected card, then highlight a folder and press J to view

the pictures in the highlighted folder. The same procedure can be

used when selecting pictures for operations in the playback

D button

I (0 207) and retouch (0 261) menus or when copying white balance from an existing photograph (0 125).

A See Also
For information on choosing how long the monitor will remain on when no operations are performed, see Custom Setting c4 (Monitor off delay, 0 228).
178

Photo Information
Photo information is superimposed on images displayed in full-frame playback. Press 1 or 3 to cycle through photo information as shown below. Note that "image only", shooting data, RGB histograms, highlights, and overview data are only displayed if corresponding option is selected for Playback display options (0 209). GPS data are only displayed if a GPS device was used when the photo was taken.

1/12

100ND600 DSC_0001. JPG 15/04/2012 10: 02: 28

NORMAL 6016x4016

File information

None (image only)

1/12

NIKON D600

1/ 125 F5. 6 100

85mm

0, 0 100ND600 DSC_0001. JPG 15/04/2012 10: 02: 28

NORMAL 6016x4016

Overview

LAT I TUDE LONG I TUDE ALT I TUDE T I ME (UTC)

:N : 35º 35. 971` :E : 139º 43. 696` : 35m : 15 / 04 / 2012 : 01 : 15 : 00

N I KON D600

100-1

GPS data

100-1

RGB Highlights

Select R, G, B

Highlights

Highlights

100-1

RGB

Select R, G, B

RGB histogram

MTR, SPD, AP. EXP. MODE, I SO FOCAL LENGTH LENS AF / VR FLASH TYPE SYNC MODE ,

: , 1 / 125 , F5. 6

: , 100

: 0. 0 , +1 / 6

: 85mm

: 85

/ 1. 4

:S

:

:

:

N I KON D600

100-1

Shooting data

 File Information

1 Protect status ................................................... 188

1/12

2 Retouch indicator ........................................... 261

3 Focus point 1, 2 .................................................. 101

4 AF area brackets 1...............................................33

5 Frame number/total number of frames

6 Image quality ......................................................93

7 Image size.............................................................95

100ND600 DSC_0001. JPG 15/04/2012 10: 02: 28

NORMAL 6016x4016

8 Image area 3 .........................................................89 9 Time of recording .................................... 27, 253

10 Date of recording..................................... 27, 253

11 Current card slot....................................... 46, 178

12 Folder name...................................................... 215

13 File name............................................................ 216

1 Displayed only if Focus point is selected for Playback display options (0 209).

I

2 If photograph was taken using AF-S or with single-servo autofocus selected during AF-A, display shows

point where focus first locked. If photograph was taken using AF-C or with continuous-servo autofocus

selected during AF-A, focus point is only displayed if option other than auto-area AF was selected for AF-

area mode and camera was able to focus.

3 Displayed in yellow if picture is in non-FX format (including DX-based movie format; 0 63, 89).

179

 Highlights

1 Image highlights 1

100-1

2 Folder number--frame number 2 ............. 215

3 Current channel 1

RGB Highlights

Select R, G, B

1 Flashing areas indicate highlights (areas that may be overexposed) for the current channel. Hold W (S) button and press 4 or 2 to cycle through channels as follows:

RGB

R

(all channels)

(red)

G (green)

B (blue)

W (S) button
2 Displayed in yellow if picture is in non-FX format (including DX-based movie format; 0 63, 89).

 RGB Histogram

Highlights

100-1

RGB

Select R, G, B

1 Image highlights 1 2 Folder number--frame number 2 ............. 215

3 White balance .................................................. 115 Color temperature....................................... 120 White balance fine-tuning ....................... 117 Preset manual ............................................... 121
4 Current channel 1 5 Histogram (RGB channel). In all histograms,
horizontal axis gives pixel brightness, vertical axis number of pixels. 6 Histogram (red channel) 7 Histogram (green channel) 8 Histogram (blue channel)

1 Flashing areas indicate highlights (areas that may be overexposed) for the current channel. Hold W (S) button and press 4 or 2 to cycle through channels as follows:

RGB

R

G

B

(all channels)

(red)

(green)

(blue)

I

Highlight display off

W (S) button

2 Displayed in yellow if picture is in non-FX format (including DX-based movie format; 0 63, 89).

180

A Playback Zoom
To zoom in on the photograph when the histogram is displayed, press X (T). Use the X (T) and W (S) buttons to zoom in and out and scroll the image with the multi selector. The histogram will be updated to show only the data for the portion of the image visible in the monitor.
A Histograms
Camera histograms are intended as a guide only and may differ from those displayed in imaging applications. Some sample histograms are shown below: If the image contains objects with a wide range of brightnesses, the distribution of tones will be relatively even. If the image is dark, tone distribution will be shifted to the left. If the image is bright, tone distribution will be shifted to the right.
Increasing exposure compensation shifts the distribution of tones to the right, while decreasing exposure compensation shifts the distribution to the left. Histograms can provide a rough idea of overall exposure when bright ambient lighting makes it difficult to see photographs in the monitor.
I
181

 Shooting Data

MTR, SPD, AP. : , 1 / 4000 , F2. 8

EXP. MODE, I SO : , H i 0. 3,

: +1. 3, +5 / 6

FOCAL LENGTH : 85mm

LENS

: 85

/ 1. 4

AF / VR

: S / VR-On

F LASH TYPE : Bu i l t - i n, CMD

SYNC MODE

: SLOW

, :M: TTL, +3. 0 A : TTL, +3. 0

B : ---

C : ---

N I KON D600

100-1

WH I TE BALANCE : AUTO1, 0, 0

COLOR SPACE : sRGB

P I CTURE CTRL : STANDARD

QU I CK ADJ UST : 0

SHARPEN I NG : 3

CONTRAST : 0

BR I GHTNESS : 0

SATURAT I ON : 0

HUE

:0

N I KON D600

100-1

NO I SE REDUC. : H I I SO, NORM

ACT. D-L I GHT. : NORMAL

HDR

: AUTO, H I GH

V I GNETTE CTRL : NORMAL

RETOUCH

: D-L I GHT I NG

WARM F I LTER

CYANOTYPE

TR I M

COMMENT

: SPR I NG HAS COME.

N I KON D600

100-1

ART I ST COPYR I GHT

: N I KON TARO : N I KON

N I KON D600

100-1

1 Metering............................................................. 109 Shutter speed ......................................................74
Aperture ................................................................74
I 2 Shooting mode .....................................35, 40, 73
ISO sensitivity 1................................................. 105

3 Exposure compensation............................... 112 Optimal exposure tuning 2 .......................... 226
4 Focal length ................................... 172, 288, 291 5 Lens data............................................................ 172 6 Focus mode................................................ 97, 103
Lens VR (vibration reduction) 3 7 Flash type..................................................143, 292
Commander mode ......................................... 237 8 Flash mode........................................................ 144 9 Flash control .................................. 236, 294, 295
Flash compensation....................................... 148 10 Camera name 11 Image area 4 .........................................................89 12 Folder number--frame number 4 ............. 215 13 White balance .................................................. 115
Color temperature....................................... 120 White balance fine-tuning ....................... 117 Preset manual ............................................... 121 14 Color space........................................................ 217 15 Picture Control................................................. 129 16 Quick adjust 5.................................................... 132 Original Picture Control 6 ............................. 135 17 Sharpening........................................................ 132 18 Contrast.............................................................. 132 19 Brightness.......................................................... 132 20 Saturation 7........................................................ 132 Filter effects 8 .................................................... 132 21 Hue 7 .................................................................... 132 Toning 8......................................................132, 133 22 High ISO noise reduction............................. 218 Long exposure noise reduction................. 218 23 Active D-Lighting............................................ 137 24 HDR exposure differential............................ 139 HDR smoothing ............................................... 139 25 Vignette control............................................... 218 26 Retouch history ............................................... 261 27 Image comment.............................................. 253 28 Name of photographer 9 .............................. 256 29 Copyright holder 9 .......................................... 256

182

1 Displayed in red if photo was taken with auto ISO sensitivity control on. 2 Displayed if Custom Setting b5 (Fine-tune optimal exposure, 0 226) has been set to a value other
than zero for any metering method. 3 Displayed only if VR lens is attached. 4 Displayed in yellow if picture is in non-FX format (including DX-based movie format; 0 63, 89). 5 Standard, Vivid, Portrait, and Landscape Picture Controls only. 6 Neutral, Monochrome, and custom Picture Controls. 7 Not displayed with monochrome Picture Controls. 8 Monochrome Picture Controls only. 9 The fourth page of the shooting data is only displayed if copyright information was recorded with the
photograph as described on page 256.

 GPS Data *

LAT I TUDE LONG I TUDE ALT I TUDE T I ME (UTC)

:N : 35º 35. 971` :E : 139º 43. 696` : 35m : 15 / 04 / 2012 : 01 : 15 : 00

1 Latitude 2 Longitude 3 Altitude 4 Coordinated Universal Time (UTC)

N I KON D600

100-1

* Data for movies are for start of recording.

I
183

 Overview Data

1/12

NIKON D600

1/ 4000 F2. 8 Hi 0. 3 85mm

­1. 3 +1. 0

SLOW

0, 0

100ND600 DSC_0001. JPG 15/04/2012 10: 02: 28

NORMAL 6016x4016

1/ 4000 F2. 8 Hi 0. 3

­1. 3 +1. 0

SLOW

0, 0

85mm

1 Frame number/total number of images

17 Aperture ................................................................74

2 Protect status.................................................... 188 18 ISO sensitivity 2................................................. 105

3 Camera name

19 Focal length ................................... 172, 288, 291

4 Retouch indicator............................................ 261 20 GPS data indicator .......................................... 175

5 Histogram showing the distribution of tones in the image (0 181).
6 Image quality.......................................................93 7 Image size .............................................................95 8 Image area 1..........................................................89 9 File name............................................................ 216 10 Time of recording..................................... 27, 253

21 Image comment indicator........................... 253 22 Active D-Lighting............................................ 137 23 Picture Control................................................. 129 24 Color space........................................................ 217 25 Flash mode........................................................ 144 26 White balance .................................................. 115
Color temperature....................................... 120

11 Folder name ...................................................... 215 12 Date of recording ..................................... 27, 253 13 Current card slot ....................................... 46, 178 14 Metering............................................................. 109 15 Shooting mode .....................................35, 40, 73

White balance fine-tuning ....................... 117 Preset manual ............................................... 121 27 Flash compensation....................................... 148 Commander mode ......................................... 237 28 Exposure compensation............................... 112

16 Shutter speed ......................................................74

1 Non-FX formats (including DX-based movie format) displayed in yellow (0 63, 89).

2 Displayed in red if photo was taken with auto ISO sensitivity control on.

I

184

Thumbnail Playback
To display images in "contact sheets" of four, nine, or 72 images, press the W (S) button.

W (S)

W (S)

X (T)

X (T)

Full-frame playback

Thumbnail playback

Calendar playback

To Display more images
Display fewer images
Highlight images
View highlighted image Delete highlighted image
Change protect status of highlighted image Return to shooting mode
Retouch photo

Use W (S) X (T)
J

Description
Press W (S) to increase the number of images displayed.
Press X (T) to reduce the number of images displayed. When four images are displayed, press to view highlighted image full frame.
Use multi selector to highlight images for full-frame playback, playback zoom (0 187), deletion (0 189), or protection (0 188). Press J to display the highlighted image full frame.

O (Q) See page 189 for more information.

L (U) See page 188 for more information.

/ K

Monitor will turn off. immediately.

Photographs can be taken

c (b)

Create retouched copy of current photograph (0 69, 261).

I

185

Calendar Playback

To view images taken on a selected date, press the W (S) button when 72 images are displayed.
Date list

W (S)

W (S)

X (T)

X (T)

Thumbnail list

Full-frame playback

Thumbnail playback

Calendar playback

The operations can be performed depend on whether the cursor is in the date list or the thumbnail list:

To Toggle between date list and thumbnail list
Exit to thumbnail playback/Zoom in on
highlighted photo

Use W (S)
X (T)

Description Press W (S) button in date list to place cursor in thumbnail list. Press again to return to date list. · Date list: Exit to 72-frame playback. · Thumbnail list: Press and hold X (T) button to zoom
in on highlighted picture.

Highlight dates/ Highlight images

· Date list: Highlight date. · Thumbnail list: Highlight picture.

Toggle full frame playback
Delete highlighted photo(s)
Change protect status of highlighted
photo

J O (Q)

· Date list: View pictures taken on selected date. · Thumbnail list: View highlighted picture.
· Date list: Delete all pictures taken on selected date. · Thumbnail list: Delete highlighted picture (0 189).

L (U) See page 188 for more information.

Return to shooting mode

/ K

Monitor will turn off. immediately.

Photographs can be taken

Retouch photo
I

c (b)

Create retouched copy of photo highlighted in thumbnail list (0 69, 261).

186

Taking a Closer Look: Playback Zoom

Press the X (T) button to zoom in on the image displayed in full-frame playback or on the image currently highlighted in thumbnail playback. The following operations can be performed while zoom is in effect:

To Zoom in or out
View other areas of image

Use
X (T)/ W (S)

Description
Press X (T) to zoom in to maximum of approximately 38 × (large images in 36 × 24/3 : 2 format), 28 × (medium images) or 19 × (small images). Press W (S) to zoom out. While photo is zoomed in, use multi selector to view areas of image not visible in monitor. Keep multi selector pressed to scroll rapidly to other areas of frame. Navigation window is displayed when zoom ratio is altered; area currently visible in monitor is indicated by yellow border.

Select faces

Faces (up to 35) detected during zoom are indicated by white borders in navigation window. Rotate subcommand dial to view other faces.

View other images
Change protect status
Return to shooting mode
Retouch photo

Rotate main command dial to view same location in other photos at current zoom ratio. Playback zoom is cancelled when a movie is displayed.
L (U) See page 188 for more information.
/ K Monitor will turn off. Photographs can be taken immediately.
c (b) Create retouched copy of current photograph (0 69, 261).

I

187

Protecting Photographs from Deletion
In full-frame, zoom, thumbnail, and calendar playback, the L (U) button can be used to protect photographs from accidental deletion. Protected files can not be deleted using the O (Q) button or the Delete option in the playback menu. Note that protected images will be deleted when the memory card is formatted (0 31, 250). To protect a photograph:
1 Select an image.
Display the image in full-frame playback or playback zoom or highlight it in the thumbnail list in thumbnail or calendar playback.
Full-frame playback Thumbnail playback Calendar playback
2 Press the L (U) button.
The photograph will be marked with a P icon. To remove protection from the photograph so that it can be deleted, display the photograph or highlight it in the thumbnail list and then press the L (U) L (U) button button.
I
A Removing Protection from All Images
To remove protection from all images in the folder or folders currently selected in the Playback folder menu, press the L (U) and O (Q) buttons together for about two seconds during playback.
188

Deleting Photographs
To delete the photograph displayed in full-frame playback or highlighted in the thumbnail list, press the O (Q) button. To delete multiple selected photographs, all photographs taken on a selected date, or all photographs in the current playback folder, use the Delete option in the playback menu. Once deleted, photographs can not be recovered. Note that pictures that are protected or hidden can not be deleted.
Full-Frame, Thumbnail, and Calendar Playback
Press the O (Q) button to delete the current photograph.
1 Select an image.
Display the image or highlight it in the thumbnail list in thumbnail or calendar playback.
2 Press the O (Q) button.
A confirmation dialog will be displayed.

O (Q) button

Full-frame playback Thumbnail playback Calendar playback (thumbnail list)

3 Press the O (Q) button again.
To delete the photograph, press the O (Q) button. To exit
without deleting the photograph, press the K button.

O (Q) button

I
A Calendar Playback
During calendar playback, you can delete all photographs taken on a selected date by highlighting the date in the date list and pressing the O (Q) button (0 186).
A See Also
The After delete option in the playback menu determines whether the next image or the previous image is displayed after an image is deleted (0 212).
189

The Playback Menu
The Delete option in the playback menu contains the following options. Note that depending on the number of images, some time may be required for deletion.

Option

Description

Q Selected Delete selected pictures.

n Select date Delete all pictures taken on a selected date (0 191).

R All

Delete all pictures in the folder currently selected for playback (0 207). If two cards are inserted, you can select the card from which pictures will be deleted.

 Selected: Deleting Selected Photographs
1 Choose Selected for the Delete option
in the playback menu.
Press the G button and select Delete in the playback menu. Highlight Selected and press 2.
G button

2 Highlight a picture.
Use the multi selector to highlight a picture (to view the highlighted picture full screen, press and hold the X (T) button; to view images in other locations, hold the D button, press 1, and select the desired card and folder as described on page 178).

3 Select the highlighted picture.

Press the W (S) button to select the

highlighted picture. Selected pictures are

marked by a O icon. Repeat steps 2 and 3 to

select additional pictures; to deselect a

I

picture, highlight it and press W (S).

W (S) button

190

4 Press J to complete the operation.
A confirmation dialog will be displayed; highlight Yes and press J.
 Select Date: Deleting Photographs Taken on a Selected Date
1 Choose Select date.
In the delete menu, highlight Select date and press 2.
2 Highlight a date.
Press 1 or 3 to highlight a date.

To view the pictures taken on the

highlighted date, press W (S). Use the

multi selector to scroll through the pictures,

or press and hold X (T) to view the

current picture full screen. Press W (S) to

return to the date list.

W (S) button

3 Select the highlighted date.
Press 2 to select all pictures taken on the highlighted date. Selected dates are marked with a M icon. Repeat steps 2 and 3 to select additional dates; to deselect a date, highlight it and press 2.

4 Press J to complete the operation.

I

A confirmation dialog will be displayed;

highlight Yes and press J.

191

I
192

QConnections

Connecting to a Computer
This section describes how to use the supplied UC-E15 USB cable to connect the camera to a computer.

Before Connecting the Camera
Before connecting the camera, install the software on the supplied ViewNX 2 CD. To ensure that data transfer is not interrupted, be sure the camera EN-EL15 battery is fully charged. If in doubt, charge the battery before use or use an EH-5b AC adapter and EP-5B power connector (available separately).
 Supplied Software
ViewNX 2 includes a "Nikon Transfer 2" function for copying pictures from the camera to the computer, where ViewNX 2 can be used to view and print selected images or to edit photographs and movies. For more information, see ViewNX 2 online help.
 Supported Operating Systems
The supplied software can be used with computers running the following operating systems: · Windows: Pre-installed versions of Windows 7 Home Basic/Home Premium/
Professional/Enterprise/Ultimate (Service Pack 1), Windows Vista Home Basic/ Home Premium/Business/Enterprise/ Ultimate (Service Pack 2), or 32-bit editions of Windows XP Home Edition/Professional (Service Pack 3). All installed programs may run as 32-bit applications in 64-bit editions of Windows 7 and Windows Vista. This application is not compatible with computers running 64-bit Windows XP. · Macintosh: Mac OS X (version 10.5.8, 10.6.8, or 10.7.2) See the websites listed on page xxiii for the latest information on supported operating systems.

A Connecting Cables

Be sure the camera is off when connecting or disconnecting interface cables. Do not use

force or attempt to insert the connectors at an angle. Close the camera connector cover

when the connector is not in use.
D During Transfer

Q

Do not turn the camera off or disconnect the USB cable while transfer is in progress.

A Windows
To visit the Nikon website after installing ViewNX 2, select All Programs > Link to Nikon from the Windows start menu (Internet connection required).

193

Connecting the Camera
Connect the camera using the supplied UC-E15 USB cable.
1 Turn the camera off. 2 Turn the computer on.
Turn the computer on and wait for it to start up.
3 Connect the USB cable.
Connect the USB cable as shown.
D USB Hubs
Connect the camera directly to the computer; do not connect the cable via a USB hub or keyboard.
4 Turn the camera on. 5 Start Nikon Transfer 2.
If a message is displayed prompting you to choose a program, select Nikon Transfer 2.
A Windows 7
If the following dialog is displayed, select Nikon Transfer 2 as described below. 1 Under Import pictures and videos, click Change
program. A program selection dialog will be displayed; select Import file using Nikon Transfer 2 and click OK. 2 Double-click Import file.
Q
194

6 Click Start Transfer.
At default settings, all the pictures on the memory card will be copied to the computer (for more information on using Nikon Transfer 2, start ViewNX 2 or Nikon Transfer 2 and select ViewNX 2 Help from the Help menu).
Start Transfer
7 Turn the camera off and disconnect the USB cable when transfer ends.
Nikon Transfer 2 will close automatically when transfer is complete.
Q
A Camera Control Pro 2
Camera Control Pro 2 software (available separately; 0 298) can be used to control the camera from a computer. When Camera Control Pro 2 is used to capture photographs and movies directly to the computer, the PC connection indicator (c) will appear in the control panel.
195

Printing Photographs
Selected JPEG images can be printed on a PictBridge printer (0 333) connected directly to the camera.
Connecting the Printer
Connect the camera using the supplied UC-E15 USB cable.
1 Turn the camera off. 2 Connect the USB cable.
Turn the printer on and connect the USB cable as shown. Do not use force or attempt to insert the connectors at an angle.
D USB Hubs
Connect the camera directly to the printer; do not connect the cable via a USB hub.
3 Turn the camera on.
A welcome screen will be displayed in the monitor, followed by a PictBridge playback display.
Q
196

A Printing Via Direct USB Connection
Be sure the EN-EL15 battery is fully charged or use an optional EH-5b AC adapter and EP-5B power connector. When taking photographs to be printed via direct USB connection, set Color space to sRGB (0 217).
D Selecting Photographs for Printing
NEF (RAW) photographs (0 93) can not be selected for printing. JPEG copies of NEF (RAW) images can be created using the NEF (RAW) processing option in the retouch menu (0 271).
A See Also
See page 325 for information on what to do if an error occurs during printing.
Printing Pictures One at a Time
1 Select a picture.
Press 4 or 2 to view additional pictures. Press the X (T) button to zoom in on the current frame (0 187; press K to exit zoom). To view six pictures at a time, press the W (S) button. Use the multi selector to highlight pictures, or press X (T) to display the highlighted picture full frame; to view images in other locations when thumbnails are displayed, hold the D button, press 1, and select the desired card and folder as described on page 178.
2 Display printing options.
Press J to display PictBridge printing options.
Q
197

3 Adjust printing options.
Press 1 or 3 to highlight an option and press 2 to select.

Option

Description

Highlight a page size (only sizes supported by the current printer are listed)

Page size and press J to select and exit to the previous menu (to print at the default

page size for the current printer, select Printer default).

No. of Press 1 or 3 to choose number of copies (maximum 99), then press J to

copies select and return to the previous menu.

This option is available only if supported by the printer. Highlight Printer

Border

default (use current printer settings), Print with border (print photo with white border), or No border and press J to select and exit to the previous

menu.

Time stamp

Highlight Printer default (use current printer settings), Print time stamp (print times and dates of recording on photos), or No time stamp and press J to select and exit to the previous menu.

This option is available only if supported by the printer. To exit without

cropping, highlight No cropping and press J. To crop the current picture, highlight Crop and press 2.

Selecting Crop displays the dialog shown at right. Press Cropping X (T) to increase the size of the crop, W (S) to

decrease. Position the crop using the multi selector and

press J. Note that print quality may drop if small crops

are printed at large sizes.

4 Start printing.
Select Start printing and press J to start printing. To cancel before all copies have been printed, press J.

Q
198

Printing Multiple Pictures
1 Display the PictBridge menu.
Press the G button in the PictBridge playback display (see Step 3 on page 196).
G button
2 Choose an option.
Highlight one of the following options and press 2. · Print select: Select pictures for printing. · Select date: Print one copy of all the pictures
taken on a selected date. · Print (DPOF): Print an existing print order created with the DPOF print order
option in the playback menu (0 202). The current print order will be displayed in Step 3. · Index print: To create an index print of all JPEG pictures (0 93) on the memory card, proceed to Step 4. Note that if the memory card contains more than 256 pictures, only the first 256 images will be printed.
Q
199

3 Select pictures or choose a date.
If you chose Print select or Print (DPOF) in Step 2, use the multi selector to scroll through the pictures on the memory card; to view images in other locations, hold the D button, press 1, and select the desired card and folder as described on page 178. To display the current picture full screen, press and hold the X (T) button. To select the current picture for printing, hold the W (S) button and press 1. The picture will be marked with a Z icon and the number of prints will be set to 1. Keeping W (S) + 13: Choose number of copies the W (S) button pressed, press 1 or 3 to specify the number of prints (up to 99; to deselect the picture, press 3 when the number of prints is 1). Continue until all the desired pictures have been selected.

X (T) button: View photo full screen

If you chose Select date in Step 2, press 1 or 3

to highlight a date and press 2 to toggle the

highlighted date on or off. To view the

pictures taken on the selected date, press

W (S). Use the multi selector to scroll

through the pictures, or press and hold X (T) to view the current picture full

X (T) button: View

screen. Press W (S) again to return to the highlighted photo

date selection dialog.

full screen

W (S)

button: View

photos for selected

Q

date

200

4 Display printing options.
Press J to display PictBridge printing options.
5 Adjust printing options.
Choose page size, border, and time stamp options as described on page 198 (a warning will be displayed if the selected page size is too small for an index print).
6 Start printing.
Select Start printing and press J to start printing. To cancel before all copies have been printed, press J.
Q
201

Creating a DPOF Print Order: Print Set
The DPOF print order option in the playback menu is used to create digital "print orders" for PictBridge-compatible printers and devices that support DPOF.
1 Choose Select/set for the DPOF print
order item in the playback menu.
Press the G button and select DPOF print order in the playback menu. Highlight Select/set and press 2 (to remove all photographs from the print order, select G button Deselect all?).
2 Select pictures.
Use the multi selector to scroll through the pictures on the memory card (to view images in other locations, hold the D button and press 1). To display the current picture in full screen, press and hold the X (T) button. To select the current picture for printing, hold the W (S) button and press 1. The picture will be marked with a Z icon and the number of prints will be set to 1. Keeping the W (S) button pressed, press 1 or 3 to specify the number W (S) + 13: Choose number of copies of prints (up to 99; to deselect the picture, press 3 when the number of prints is 1). Continue until all the desired pictures have been selected.

3 Display imprint options.
Press J to display data imprint options.

X (T) button: View photo full screen

Q

202

4 Select imprint options.
Highlight the following options and press 2 to toggle the highlighted option on or off (to complete the print order without including this information, proceed to Step 5). · Print shooting data: Print shutter speed and
aperture on all pictures in print order. · Print date: Print date of recording on all pictures in print order.
5 Complete the print order.
Highlight Done and press J to complete the print order.

D DPOF Print Order
To print the current print order when the camera is connected to a PictBridge printer, select Print (DPOF) in the PictBridge menu and follow the steps in "Printing Multiple Pictures" to modify and print the current order (0 199). DPOF print date and shooting data options are not supported when printing via direct USB connection; to print the date of recording on photographs in the current print order, use the PictBridge Time stamp option.

The DPOF print order option can not be used if there is not enough space on the memory

card to store the print order.

Q

NEF (RAW) photographs (0 93) can not be selected using this option. JPEG copies of NEF

(RAW) images can be created using the NEF (RAW) processing option in the retouch menu

(0 271).

Print orders may not print correctly if images are deleted using a computer or other device after the print order is created.

203

Viewing Photographs on TV
A type C mini-pin High-Definition Multimedia Interface (HDMI) cable (available separately from commercial sources) can be used to connect the camera to highdefinition video devices.
1 Turn the camera off.
Always turn the camera off before connecting or disconnecting an HDMI cable.
2 Connect the HDMI cable as shown.

Connect to high-definition device (choose cable with connector for
HDMI device)

Connect to camera

3 Tune the device to the HDMI channel.
4 Turn the camera on and press the K button.
During playback, images will be displayed on the television screen.

D Close the Connector Cover
Close the camera connector cover when the connectors are not in use. Foreign matter in the connectors can interfere with data transfer.
A Television Playback
Use of an EH-5b AC adapter and EP-5B power connector (available separately) is recommended for extended playback. The TV will display images full screen if photo information is hidden during full-frame playback (0 179). Note that the edges may not be
Q visible when photographs are viewed on a television screen.
A Audio
Stereo sound recorded with optional ME-1 (0 298) stereo microphones plays in stereo when movies are viewed on HDMI devices using a camera connected via an HDMI cable (note that audio will not be played back over headphones connected to the camera). Volume can be adjusted using television controls; the camera controls can not be used.
204

 HDMI Options
The HDMI option in the setup menu (0 249) controls output resolution and can be used to enable the camera for remote control from devices that support HDMI-CEC (High-Definition Multimedia Interface­Consumer Electronics Control, a standard that allows HDMI devices to be used to control peripherals to which they are connected).
Output Resolution Choose the format for images output to the HDMI device. If Auto is selected, the camera will automatically select the appropriate format. Regardless of the option selected, Auto will be used for movie live view, movie recording, and playback.
Device Control If On is selected for HDMI >Device control in the setup menu when the camera is connected to a television that supports HDMI-CEC and both the camera and television are on, the display shown at right will appear on the television and the television remote can be used in place of the camera multi selector and J button during fullframe playback and slide shows. If Off is selected, the television remote can not be used to control the camera.

A HDMI and Live View
HDMI displays connected via an HDMI cable can be used for live view photography and movie live view (0 49, 57). During movie live view and movie recording HDMI output is adjusted according to the option selected for Movie settings > Frame size/frame rate in the shooting menu (0 65). Note that some HDMI devices may not support the selected setting; in this case, select 1080i (interlaced) for HDMI > Output resolution. Movies may be output at a frame size smaller than that selected for Frame size/frame rate (0 65).

A HDMI-CEC Devices

Q

When the camera is connected to an HDMI-CEC device, ) will appear in the control panel

in place of the number of exposures remaining.

A Device Control
See the television manual for details.

205

Q
206

MMenu Guide
D The Playback Menu: Managing Images
To display the playback menu, press G and select the D (playback menu) tab.

G button

The playback menu contains the following options:

Option

0

Option

0

Delete

190 Image review

212

Playback folder

207 After delete

212

Hide image

208 Rotate tall

212

Playback display options

209 Slide show

213

Copy image(s)

209 DPOF print order

202

A See Also
Menu defaults are listed on page 312.

Playback Folder

G button  D playback menu

Choose a folder for playback (0 177):

Option ND600 All Current

Description Pictures in all folders created with the D600 will be visible during playback. Pictures in all folders will be visible during playback. Only pictures in the current folder will be visible during playback.

U
207

Hide Image

G button  D playback menu

Hide or reveal pictures. Hidden pictures are visible only in the Hide image menu and can only be deleted by formatting the memory card.

Option

Description

Select/set Hide or reveal selected pictures.

Select date

Selecting this option displays a list of dates. To hide all pictures taken on a date, highlight the date and press 2. Selected dates are marked by a L; to reveal all pictures taken on a selected date, highlight it and press 2. Press J to complete the operation.

Deselect all? Reveal all pictures.

D Protected and Hidden Images
Revealing a protected image will also remove protection from the image.

Follow the steps below to hide or reveal selected pictures.

1 Choose Select/set.
Highlight Select/set and press 2.

2 Select pictures.
Use the multi selector to scroll through the pictures on the memory card (to view the highlighted picture full screen, press and hold the X (T) button; to view images in other locations as described on page 178, W (S) button hold D and press 1) and press W (S) to select the current picture. Selected pictures are marked by a R icon; to deselect a picture, highlight it and press W (S) again. Continue until all the desired pictures have been selected.
3 Press J.
Press J to complete the operation.
U

208

Playback Display Options

G button  D playback menu

Choose the information available in the playback photo information display (0 179). Press 1 or 3 to highlight an option, then press 2 to select the option for the photo information display. A L appears next to selected items; to deselect, highlight and press 2. To return to the playback menu, highlight Done and press J.

Copy Image(s)

G button  D playback menu

Copy pictures from one memory card to another. This option is only available when two memory cards are inserted in the camera.

Option Select source Select image(s) Select destination folder Copy image(s)?

Description Choose card from which pictures will be copied. Select pictures to be copied. Select destination folder on remaining card. Copy selected pictures to specified destination.

1 Choose Select source.
Highlight Select source and press 2.

2 Select the source card.
Highlight the slot for the card containing the images to be copied and press J.

U
209

3 Choose Select image(s).
Highlight Select image(s) and press 2.
4 Select the source folder.
Highlight the folder containing the images to be copied and press 2.
5 Make the initial selection.
Before going on to select or deselect individual images, you can mark all or all protected images in the folder for copying by choosing Select all images or Select protected images. To mark only individually selected images for copying, choose Deselect all before proceeding.
6 Select additional images.
Highlight pictures and press W (S) to select or deselect (to view the highlighted picture full screen, press and hold the X (T) button). Selected images are marked with a L. Press J to proceed to Step W (S) button 7 when your selection is complete.
7 Choose Select destination folder.
Highlight Select destination folder and press 2.
U
210

8 Select a destination folder.
To enter a folder number, choose Select folder by number, enter the number (0 215), and press J. If the folder with the selected number does not already exist, a new folder will be created.
To choose from a list of existing folders, choose Select folder from list, highlight a folder, and press J.
9 Copy the images.
Highlight Copy image(s)? and press J.

A confirmation dialog will be displayed; highlight Yes and press J. Press J again to exit when copying is complete.

D Copying Images
Images will not be copied if there is insufficient space on the destination card. Be sure the battery is fully charged before copying movies.

If the destination folder contains an image with the same name as one of the images to be copied, a confirmation dialog will be displayed. Select Replace existing image to replace the image with the image to be copied, or select Replace all to replace all existing images with the same names without further prompting. To continue without replacing the image, select Skip, or select Cancel to exit without copying any further images.

Protect status is copied with the images but print marking (0 202) is not. Hidden images

can not be copied.

U

211

Image Review

G button  D playback menu

Choose whether pictures are automatically displayed in the monitor immediately after shooting. If Off is selected, pictures can only be displayed by pressing the K button.

After Delete

G button  D playback menu

Choose the picture displayed after an image is deleted.

Option

Description

S Show next

Display following picture. If deleted picture was last frame, previous picture will be displayed.

T Show previous

Display previous picture. If deleted picture was first frame, following picture will be displayed.

If user was scrolling through pictures in order recorded, following

U

Continue as before

picture will be displayed as described for Show next. If user was scrolling through pictures in reverse order, previous picture will be

displayed as described for Show previous.

Rotate Tall

G button  D playback menu

Choose whether to rotate "tall" (portrait-orientation) pictures for display during playback. Note that because the camera itself is already in the appropriate orientation during shooting, images are not rotated automatically during image review.

Option On Off

Description
"Tall" (portrait-orientation) pictures are automatically rotated for display in the camera monitor. Pictures taken with Off selected for Auto image rotation (0 254) will be displayed in "wide" (landscape) orientation. "Tall" (portrait-orientation) pictures are displayed in "wide" (landscape) orientation.

U
212

Slide Show

G button  D playback menu

Create a slide show of the pictures in the current playback folder (0 207). Hidden images (0 208) are not displayed.

Option Start Image type Frame interval

Description Start slide show. Choose type of image displayed from Still images and movies, Still images only, and Movies only. Choose how long each picture will be displayed.

To start the slide show, highlight Start and press J. The following operations can be performed while the slide show is in progress:

To Skip back/skip ahead

Press

Description

Press 4 to return to previous frame, 2 to skip to next frame.

View additional photo info

Change or hide photo info displayed (still images only; 0 179).

Pause/resume

J Pause or resume slide show.

Raise/lower volume

X (T)/ Press X (T) during movie playback to increase W (S) volume, W (S) to decrease.

Exit to playback menu G End slide show and return to playback menu.

Exit to playback mode K End show and return to playback mode.

Exit to shooting mode

Press shutter-release button halfway to return to shooting mode.

The dialog shown at right is displayed when the show ends. Select Restart to restart or Exit to return to the playback menu.

U
213

C The Shooting Menu: Shooting Options
To display the shooting menu, press G and select the C (shooting menu) tab.

G button

The shooting menu contains the following options:

Option

0

Option

0

Reset shooting menu

214 Color space

217

Storage folder

215 Active D-Lighting

137

File naming

216 HDR (high dynamic range)

139

Role played by card in Slot 2

96 Vignette control

218

Image quality

93 Long exposure NR

218

Image size

95 High ISO NR

218

Image area

89 ISO sensitivity settings

105

JPEG compression

94 Remote control mode

85

NEF (RAW) recording

94 Multiple exposure

160

White balance

115 Interval timer shooting

164

Set Picture Control

129 Time-lapse photography

168

Manage Picture Control

134 Movie settings

65

Auto distortion control

217

Note: Depending on camera settings, some items may be grayed out and unavailable. For information on the options available in each shooting mode, see page 309.

Reset Shooting Menu

G button  C shooting menu

Select Yes to restore shooting menu options to their default values (0 312).

U
214

Storage Folder

G button  C shooting menu

Select the folder in which subsequent images will be stored.
 Selecting Folders by Folder Number

1 Choose Select folder by number.
Highlight Select folder by number and press 2.
The dialog shown at right will be displayed.

2 Choose a folder number.
Press 4 or 2 to highlight a digit, press 1 or 3 to change. If a folder with the selected number already exists, a W, X, or Y icon will be displayed to the left of the folder number: · W : Folder is empty. · X : Folder is partially full. · Y : Folder contains 999 pictures or a picture numbered 9999. No further
pictures can be stored in this folder. The card on which the folder is stored is shown by the card slot icon in the top right corner of the Select folder by number dialog. The card used for new folders depends on the option currently selected for Role played by card in slot 2 (0 96).
3 Save changes and exit.
Press J to complete the operation and return to the shooting menu (to exit without choosing the storage folder, press the G button). If a folder with the specified number does not already exist, a new folder will be created. Subsequent photographs will be stored in the selected folder unless it is already full.
D Folder and File Numbers
If the current folder is numbered 999 and contains 999 pictures or a picture numbered 9999, the shutter-release will be disabled and no further photographs can be taken. To continue shooting, create a folder with a number less than 999, or select an existing folder with a number less than 999 and less than 999 images.
A Startup Time
U Additional time may be required for camera startup if the memory card contains a very large
number of files or folders.

215

 Selecting Folders from a List
1 Choose Select folder from list.
Highlight Select folder from list and press 2.

2 Highlight a folder.
Press 1 or 3 to highlight a folder.
3 Select the highlighted folder.
Press J to select the highlighted folder and return to the shooting menu. Subsequent photographs will be stored in the selected folder.

File Naming

G button  C shooting menu

Photographs are saved using file names consisting of "DSC_" or, in the case of images that use the Adobe RGB color space, "_DSC", followed by a four-digit number and a three-letter extension (e.g., "DSC_0001.JPG"). The File naming option is used to select three letters to replace the "DSC" portion of the file name. For information on editing file names, see page 135.
A Extensions
The following extensions are used: ".NEF" for NEF (RAW) images, ".JPG" for JPEG images, ".MOV" for movies, and ".NDF" for dust off reference data. In each pair of photographs recorded at image-quality settings of NEF (RAW)+JPEG, the NEF and JPEG images have the same file names but different extensions.

U
216

Auto Distortion Control

G button  C shooting menu

Select On to reduce barrel distortion when shooting with wideangle lenses and to reduce pin-cushion distortion when shooting with long lenses (note that the edges of the area visible in the viewfinder may be cropped out of the final photograph, and that the time needed to process photographs before recording begins may increase). This option does not apply to movies and is available only with type G and D lenses (PC, fisheye, and certain other lenses excluded); results are not guaranteed with other lenses. Before using auto distortion control with DX lenses, select On for Auto DX crop or choose an image area of DX (24×16) 1.5× (0 90); selecting other options may result in heavily cropped photographs or in photographs with severe peripheral distortion.
A Retouch: Distortion Control
For information on creating copies of existing photographs with reduced barrel and pincushion distortion, see page 274.

Color Space

G button  C shooting menu

The color space determines the gamut of colors available for color reproduction. Choose sRGB for photographs that will be printed or used "as is," with no further modification. Adobe RGB has a wider color gamut and is recommended for images that will be extensively processed or retouched after leaving the camera.
A Color Space
Color spaces define the correspondence between colors and the numeric values that represent them in a digital image file. The sRGB color space is widely used, while the Adobe RGB color space is typically used in publishing and commercial printing. sRGB is recommended when taking photographs that will be printed without modification or viewed in applications that do not support color management, or when taking photographs that will be printed with ExifPrint, the direct printing option on some household printers, or kiosk printing or other commercial print services. Adobe RGB photographs can also be printed using these options, but colors will not be as vivid.
JPEG photographs taken in the Adobe RGB color space are DCF compliant; applications and printers that support DCF will select the correct color space automatically. If the application or device does not support DCF, select the appropriate color space manually. For more information, see the documentation provided with the application or device.
A Nikon Software
U ViewNX 2 (supplied) and Capture NX 2 (available separately) automatically select the correct
color space when opening photographs created with this camera.

217

Vignette Control

G button  C shooting menu

"Vignetting" is a drop in brightness at the edges of a photograph. Vignette control reduces vignetting for type G and D lenses (DX and PC lenses excluded). Its effects vary from lens to lens and are most noticeable at maximum aperture. Choose from High, Normal, Low, and Off.
A Vignette Control
Depending on the scene, shooting conditions, and type of lens, JPEG images may exhibit noise (fog) or variations in peripheral brightness, while custom Picture Controls and preset Picture Controls that have been modified from default settings may not produce the desired effect. Take test shots and view the results in the monitor. Vignette control does not apply to movies (0 57), multiple exposures (0 160), or DX-format images (0 89).

Long Exposure NR (Long Exposure Noise Reduction)

G button  C shooting menu

If On is selected, photographs taken at shutter speeds slower than 1 s will be processed to reduce noise (bright spots, randomly-spaced bright pixels, or fog). The time required for processing roughly doubles; during processing, "l m" will flash in the shutter speed/aperture displays and pictures can not be taken (if the camera is turned off before processing is complete, the picture will be saved but noise reduction will not be performed). In continuous release mode, frame rates will slow and while photographs are being processed, the capacity of the memory buffer will drop. Long exposure noise reduction is not available during movie recording.

High ISO NR

G button  C shooting menu

Photographs taken at high ISO sensitivities can be processed to reduce "noise."

Option

Description

High Reduce noise (randomly-spaced bright pixels, lines, or fog), particularly in

Normal photographs taken at high ISO sensitivities. Choose the amount of noise reduction

Low performed from High, Normal, and Low.

Noise reduction is only performed at ISO sensitivities of ISO 2500 and higher. The

Off amount of noise reduction is less than the amount performed when Low is selected

U

for High ISO NR.

218

A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings
To display the Custom Settings menu, press G and select the A (Custom Settings menu) tab.

G button
Custom Settings are used to customize camera settings to suit individual preferences.

Custom Setting groups

Main menu

Reset custom settings (0 221)

U
219

The following Custom Settings are available:

Custom Setting

0

Custom Setting

0

Reset custom settings

221 d Shooting/display

a Autofocus

d9 LCD illumination

231

a1 AF-C priority selection

221 d10 Exposure delay mode

231

a2 AF-S priority selection

221 d11 Flash warning

231

a3 Focus tracking with lock-on

222 d12 MB-D14 battery type

232

a4 AF point illumination

222 d13 Battery order

233

a5 Focus point wrap-around

222 e Bracketing/flash

a6 Number of focus points

223 e1 Flash sync speed

234

a7 Built-in AF-assist illuminator

223 e2 Flash shutter speed

235

b Metering/exposure

e3 Flash cntrl for built-in flash

236

b1 ISO sensitivity step value

224 e4 Exposure comp. for flash

240

b2 EV steps for exposure cntrl

224 e5 Modeling flash

241

b3 Easy exposure compensation

225 e6 Auto bracketing set

241

b4 Center-weighted area

226 e7 Bracketing order

241

b5 Fine-tune optimal exposure

226 f Controls

c Timers/AE lock

f1 OK button (shooting mode)

241

c1 Shutter-release button AE-L

226 f2 Assign Fn button

242

c2 Standby timer

227 f3 Assign preview button

244

c3 Self-timer

227 f4 Assign AE-L/AF-L button

244

c4 Monitor off delay

228 f5 Customize command dials

245

c5 Remote on duration

228 f6 Release button to use dial

246

d Shooting/display

f7 Slot empty release lock

246

d1 Beep d2 Viewfinder grid display

228 f8 Reverse indicators

246

229 f9 Assign MB-D14 4 button

247

d3 ISO display and adjustment

229 g Movie

d4 Screen tips

229 g1 Assign Fn button

247

d5 CL mode shooting speed

229 g2 Assign preview button

248

d6 Max. continuous release

230 g3 Assign AE-L/AF-L button

248

d7 File number sequence

230 g4 Assign shutter button

248

d8 Information display

231

Note: Depending on camera settings, some items may be grayed out and unavailable. For information on the options available in each shooting mode, see page 309. If settings in the current bank have been modified from default values (0 313), an asterisk will be displayed adjacent to the altered settings in the second level of the Custom Settings menu.

U

220

Reset Custom Settings

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Select Yes to restore Custom Settings to their default values (0 313).

a: Autofocus

a1: AF-C Priority Selection

G button  A Custom Settings menu

When AF-C is selected for viewfinder photography (0 97), this option controls whether photographs can be taken whenever the shutter-release button is pressed (release priority) or only when the camera is in focus (focus priority).

Option G Release F Focus

Description Photos can be taken whenever the shutter-release button is pressed. Photos can only be taken when the in-focus indicator (I) is displayed.

Regardless of the option selected, focus will not lock when AF-C is selected for autofocus mode. The camera will continue to adjust focus until the shutter is released.

a2: AF-S Priority Selection

G button  A Custom Settings menu

When AF-S is selected for viewfinder photography (0 97), this option controls whether photographs can be taken only when the camera is in focus (focus priority) or whenever the shutter-release button is pressed (release priority).

Option G Release F Focus

Description Photos can be taken whenever the shutter-release button is pressed. Photos can only be taken when the in-focus indicator (I) is displayed.

Regardless of the option selected, if the in-focus indicator (I) is displayed when AF-S is selected for autofocus mode, focus will lock while the shutter-release button is pressed halfway. Focus lock continues until the shutter is released.

U

221

a3: Focus Tracking with Lock-On G button  A Custom Settings menu

This option controls how autofocus adjusts to sudden large changes in the distance to the subject when AF-C is selected or continuous-servo autofocus is selected when the camera is in AF-A mode for viewfinder photography (0 97).

Option

Description

C 5 (Long)

(4

When the distance to the subject changes abruptly, the camera waits for the

D

3 (Normal)

specified period before adjusting the distance to the subject. This prevents the camera from refocusing when the subject is briefly obscured by objects

)2

passing through the frame.

E 1 (Short)

The camera immediately adjusts focus when the distance to the subject

Off

changes. Use when photographing a series of subjects at varying distances in

quick succession.

a4: AF Point Illumination

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose whether the active focus point is highlighted in red in the viewfinder.

Option Auto On Off

Description The selected focus point is automatically highlighted as needed to establish contrast with the background. The selected focus point is always highlighted, regardless of the brightness of the background. Depending on the brightness of the background, the selected focus point may be difficult to see. The selected focus point is not highlighted. The area outside the current crop is shown in grey (0 90).

a5: Focus Point Wrap-Around

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose whether focus-point selection "wraps around" from one edge of the viewfinder to another.

Option

Description

Focus-point selection "wraps around" from top to

bottom, bottom to top, right to left, and left to right, w

q

Wrap

so that, for example, pressing 2 when a focus point at the right edge of the display is highlighted (q)

selects the corresponding focus point at the left

U

edge of the display (w).

The focus-point display is bounded by the outermost focus points so that, for

No wrap example, pressing 2 when a focus point at the right edge of the display is

selected has no effect.

222

a6: Number of Focus Points

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose the number of focus points available for manual focus-point selection.

Option

Description

# 39 points Choose from the 39 focus points shown at right.

A 11 points

Choose from the 11 focus points shown at right. Use for quick focus-point selection.

a7: Built-in AF-assist Illuminator G button  A Custom Settings menu
Choose whether the built-in AF-assist illuminator lights to assist the focus operation when lighting is poor.

Option On Off

Description
The AF-assist illuminator lights when lighting is poor (viewfinder photography only). AF-assist illumination is only available when both of the following conditions are met: 1. AF-S is selected for autofocus mode (0 97) or single-servo autofocus is selected
when the camera is in AF-A mode. 2. Auto-area AF is chosen for AF-area mode (0 99), or an option other than auto-
area AF is chosen and the center focus point is selected.
The AF-assist illuminator does not light to assist the focus operation. The camera may not be able to focus using autofocus when lighting is poor.

A The AF-Assist Illuminator
The AF-assist illuminator has a range of about 0.5­3.0 m (1 ft 8 in.­9 ft 10 in.); when using the illuminator, use a lens with a focal length of 24­200 mm and remove the lens hood.
A See Also
For information on the shooting modes in which AF-assist is available, see page 309. See page 290 for restrictions on the lenses that can be used with AF assist.
U

223

b: Metering/Exposure

b1: ISO Sensitivity Step Value

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Select the increments used when making adjustments to ISO sensitivity. If possible, the current ISO sensitivity setting is maintained when the step value is changed. If the current setting is not available at the new step value, ISO sensitivity will be rounded to the nearest available setting.

b2: EV Steps for Exposure Cntrl G button  A Custom Settings menu
Select the increments used when making adjustments to shutter speed, aperture, exposure and flash compensation, and bracketing.

U
224

b3: Easy Exposure Compensation G button  A Custom Settings menu

This option controls whether the E button is needed to set exposure compensation (0 112). If On (Auto reset) or On is selected, the 0 at the center of the exposure display will flash even when exposure compensation is set to ±0.

Option

Description

Exposure compensation is set by rotating one of the command dials (see note

On (Auto reset)

below). The setting selected using the command dial is reset when the camera turns off or the standby timer expires (exposure compensation settings

selected using the E button are not reset).

As above, except that the exposure compensation value selected using the

On command dial is not reset when the camera turns off or the standby timer

expires.

Off

Exposure compensation is set by pressing the E button and rotating the main command dial.

A Change Main/Sub
The dial used to set exposure compensation when On (Auto reset) or On is selected for
Custom Setting b3 (Easy exposure compensation) depends on the option selected for Custom Setting f5 (Customize command dials) > Change main/sub (0 245).

Customize command dials > Change main/sub

Off

On

Mode

P

Sub-command dial

Sub-command dial

S

Sub-command dial

Main command dial

A

Main command dial

Sub-command dial

M

N/A

A Show ISO/Easy ISO
Custom Setting b3 (Easy exposure compensation) can not be used with Custom Setting d3 (Show ISO/Easy ISO). Adjustments to either of these items reset the remaining item; a message is displayed when the item is reset.

U
225

b4: Center-Weighted Area

G button  A Custom Settings menu

When calculating exposure, center-weighted metering assigns the greatest weight to a circle in the center of the frame. The diameter ( ) of this circle can be set to 8, 12, 15, or 20 mm or to the average of the entire frame.

Note that unless Average is selected, the diameter is fixed at 12 mm when a non-CPU lens is used, regardless of the setting selected for Non-CPU lens data in the setup menu (0 172). When Average is selected, the average of the entire frame will be used for both CPU and non-CPU lenses.
b5: Fine-tune Optimal Exposure G button  A Custom Settings menu
Use this option to fine-tune the exposure value selected by the camera. Exposure can be fine-tuned separately for each metering method by from +1 to ­1 EV in steps of 1/6 EV.

D Fine-Tuning Exposure
Exposure fine-tuning is not affected by two-button resets. Note that as the exposure compensation (E) icon is not displayed, the only way to determine how much exposure has been altered is to view the amount in the fine-tuning menu. Exposure compensation (0 112) is preferred in most situations.
c: Timers/AE Lock
c1: Shutter-Release Button AE-L G button  A Custom Settings menu
If On is selected, exposure will lock when the shutter-release button is pressed halfway.

U
226

c2: Standby timer

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose how long the camera continues to meter exposure when no operations are performed. The shutter-speed and aperture displays in the control panel and viewfinder turn off automatically when the timer expires.
Choose a shorter standby timer delay for longer battery life.

c3: Self-Timer

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose the length of the shutter release delay, the number of shots taken, and the interval between shots in self-timer mode.

· Self-timer delay: Choose the length of the shutter-release delay (0 85).

· Number of shots: Press 1 and 3 to choose the number of shots taken each time the shutter-release button is pressed.

· Interval between shots: Choose the interval between shots when the Number of shots is more than 1.

U
227

c4: Monitor off Delay

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose how long the monitor remains on when no operations are performed during playback (Playback; defaults to 10 s) and image review (Image review; defaults to 4 s), when menus (Menus; defaults to 1 minute) or information (Information display; defaults to 10 s) are displayed, or during live view and movie recording (Live view; defaults to 10 minutes). Choose a shorter monitor-off delay for longer battery life.

c5: Remote on Duration

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose how long the camera will remain on stand-by in remote release mode (0 85). If no operations are performed for the selected period, remote shooting will end and the exposure meters will turn off. Choose shorter times for longer battery life. To reactivate remote control mode after the timer has expired, press the camera shutter-release button halfway.

d: Shooting/Display

d1: Beep

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose the pitch and volume of the beep that sounds when the camera focuses using single-servo AF (AF-S or when single-servo AF is selected for AF-A; 0 97), when focus locks during live view photography, while the release timer is counting down in self-timer and delayed remote release modes (0 85), when a photograph is taken in quick-response remote or remote mirror-up mode (0 85), when time-lapse photography ends (0 168), or if you attempt to take a photograph when the memory card is locked (0 32). Note that a beep will not sound in movie live view (0 57) or quiet-shutter release mode (mode J; 0 83), regardless of the option selected.
· Volume: Choose 3 (high), 2 (medium), 1 (low) or Off (mute). When an option other than Off is selected, c appears in the information display.
· Pitch: Choose High or Low.

U

228

d2: Viewfinder Grid Display

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose On to display on-demand grid lines in the viewfinder for reference when composing photographs (0 8).

d3: ISO Display and Adjustment G button  A Custom Settings menu
If Show ISO sensitivity or Show ISO/Easy ISO is selected, the control panel will show ISO sensitivity in place of the number of exposures remaining. If Show ISO/ Easy ISO is selected, ISO sensitivity can be set in modes P and S by rotating the subcommand dial or in mode A by rotating the main command dial. Select Show frame count to display the number of exposures remaining in the control panel.

d4: Screen Tips

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose On to display tool tips for items selected in the information display (0 11).

d5: CL Mode Shooting Speed

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose the maximum frame advance rate in CL (continuous low speed) mode (0 83; during interval timer photography, this setting also determines the frame advance rate for singleframe).

U
229

d6: Max. Continuous Release

G button  A Custom Settings menu

The maximum number of shots that can be taken in a single burst in continuous mode can be set to any value between 1 and 100.
A The Memory Buffer
Regardless of the option selected for Custom Setting d6, shooting will slow when the memory buffer fills (t00). See page 335 for more information on the capacity of the memory buffer.

d7: File Number Sequence

G button  A Custom Settings menu

When a photograph is taken, the camera names the file by adding one to the last file number used. This option controls whether file numbering continues from the last number used when a new folder is created, the memory card is formatted, or a new memory card is inserted in the camera.

Option

Description

When a new folder is created, the memory card formatted, or a new memory card

inserted in the camera, file numbering continues from the last number used or from

On the largest file number in the current folder, whichever is higher. If a photograph is

taken when the current folder contains a photograph numbered 9999, a new folder

will be created automatically and file numbering will begin again from 0001.

File numbering is reset to 0001 when a new folder is created, the memory card is

Off

formatted, or a new memory card is inserted in the camera. Note that a new folder is created automatically if a photograph is taken when the current folder contains 999

photographs.

As for On, except that the next photograph taken is assigned a file number by adding

Reset one to the largest file number in the current folder. If the folder is empty, file

numbering is reset to 0001.

D File Number Sequence
If the current folder is numbered 999 and contains either 999 photographs or a photograph numbered 9999, the shutter-release button will be disabled and no further photographs can be taken. Choose Reset for Custom Setting d7 (File number sequence) and then either format the current memory card or insert a new memory card.

U

230

d8: Information Display

G button  A Custom Settings menu

If Auto (v) is selected, the color of the lettering in the information display (0 9) will automatically change from black to white or white to black to maintain contrast with the background. To always use the same color lettering, select Manual and choose Dark on light (w; black lettering) or Light on dark (x; white lettering). Monitor brightness will automatically be adjusted for maximum contrast with the selected text color.

Dark on light

Light on dark

d9: LCD Illumination

G button  A Custom Settings menu

If Off is selected, the control panel backlight (LCD illuminator) will only light while the power switch is rotated toward D. If On is selected, the control panel will be illuminated whenever the standby timer is active (0 39). Select Off for increased battery life.

d10: Exposure Delay Mode

G button  A Custom Settings menu

In situations where the slightest camera movement can blur pictures, select 1 s, 2 s, or 3 s to delay shutter release until one, two, or three seconds after the mirror is raised.

d11: Flash Warning

G button  A Custom Settings menu

If On is selected, the flash-ready indicator (c) will flash in the viewfinder if the flash is required to ensure optimal exposure.

U

231

d12: MB-D14 Battery Type

G button  A Custom Settings menu

To ensure that the camera functions as expected when the optional MB-D14 battery pack is used with AA batteries, match the option selected in this menu to the type of batteries inserted in the battery pack. There is no need to adjust this option when using EN-EL15 batteries.

Option 1 LR6 (AA alkaline) 2 HR6 (AA Ni-MH) 3 FR6 (AA lithium)

Description Select when using LR6 alkaline AA batteries. Select when using HR6 Ni-MH AA batteries. Select when using FR6 lithium AA batteries.

A Using AA Batteries
The capacity of AA batteries drops sharply at temperatures below 20 °C (68 °F) and varies with make and storage conditions; in some cases, batteries may cease to function before their expiry date. Some AA batteries can not be used; due to their performance characteristics and limited capacity, alkaline batteries have less capacity than some other types and should only be used if no alternative is available and then only at warmer temperatures. The camera shows the level of AA batteries as follows:

Control panel L H H
(flashes)

Viewfinder
-- d d (flashes)

Description Batteries fully charged. Low battery. Ready fresh batteries.
Shutter release disabled. Change batteries.

U
232

d13: Battery Order

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose whether the battery in the camera or the batteries in the battery pack are used first when an optional MB-D14 battery pack is attached. Note that if the MB-D14 is powered by an optional EH-5b AC adapter and EP-5B power connector, the AC adapter will be used regardless of the option selected.
A s icon is displayed in the camera control panel when the batteries in the MB-D14 are in use.

A The MB-D14 Battery Pack
The MB-D14 takes one EN-EL15 rechargeable Li-ion battery or six AA alkaline, Ni-MH, or lithium batteries (an EN-EL15 is supplied with the camera; AA batteries are available separately).

The information display shows the type of battery inserted in the MB-D14 as follows:

MB-D14 battery type display

Battery type

$

EN-EL15 rechargeable Li-ion battery

w

AA batteries

U
233

e: Bracketing/Flash

e1: Flash Sync Speed

G button  A Custom Settings menu

This option controls flash sync speed.

Option 1/250 s (Auto FP)
1/200 s (Auto FP) 1/200 s­1/60 s

Description
Auto FP high-speed sync is used when a compatible flash unit is attached (0 294). If the built-in flash or other flash units are used, shutter speed is set to 1/250 s. When the camera shows a shutter speed of 1/250 s in mode P or A, auto FP high-speed sync will be activated if the actual shutter speed is faster than 1/250 s.
Auto FP high-speed sync is used when a compatible flash unit is attached (0 294). If the built-in flash or other flash units are used, shutter speed is set to 1/200 s. When the camera shows a shutter speed of 1/200 s in mode P or A, auto FP high-speed sync will be activated if the actual shutter speed is faster than 1/200 s.
Flash sync speed set to selected value.

A Fixing Shutter Speed at the Flash Sync Speed Limit
To fix shutter speed at the sync speed limit in mode S or M, select the next shutter speed after the slowest possible shutter speed (30 s or bulb). An X (flash sync indicator) will be displayed in the viewfinder and control panel.
A Auto FP High-Speed Sync
Allows the flash to be used at the highest shutter speed supported by the camera, making it possible to choose the maximum aperture for reduced depth of field even when the subject is backlit in bright sunlight. The information display flash mode indicator shows "FP" when auto FP high-speed sync is active (0 295).

U
234

 Auto FP High-Speed Sync
When 1/250 s (Auto FP) or 1/200 s (Auto FP) is selected for Custom Setting e1 (Flash sync speed, 0 234), the built-in flash can be used at shutter speeds as fast as 1/250 s or 1/200 s, while compatible optional flash units (0 294) can be used at any shutter speed (Auto FP High-Speed Sync).

Flash sync speed 1/250 s (Auto FP)

1/200 s (Auto FP)

1/200 s

Shutter speed

Built-in flash

Optional flash unit

Built-in flash

Optional flash unit

Built-in flash

Optional flash unit

From 1/4,000 to but not including 1/250 s

--

Auto FP

--

Auto FP

--

--

From 1/250 to but not including 1/200 s

Flash sync *

--

Auto FP

--

--

1/200­30 s

Flash sync

* Flash range drops as shutter speed increases. Flash range will nevertheless be greater than

that obtained at the same speeds with Auto FP.

e2: Flash Shutter Speed

G button  A Custom Settings menu

This option determines the slowest shutter speed available when using front- or rear-curtain sync or red-eye reduction in mode P or A (regardless of the setting chosen, shutter speeds can be as slow as 30 s in S and M modes or at flash settings of slow sync, slow rear-curtain sync, or red-eye reduction with slow sync). Options range from 1/60 s (1/60 s) to 30 s (30 s).

U
235

e3: Flash Cntrl for Built-in Flash G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose the flash mode for the built-in flash.

Option

Description

1 TTL

Flash output is adjusted automatically in response to shooting conditions.

2 Manual

Choose the flash level (0 236). The camera does not emit monitor preflashes.

3 Repeating flash

The flash fires repeatedly while the shutter is open, producing a strobelight effect (0 236).

4

Commander mode

Use the built-in flash as a master flash controlling remote optional flash units in one or more groups (0 237).

 Manual
Choose a flash level between Full and 1/128 (1/128 of full power). At full power, the built-in flash has a Guide Number of 12/39 (m/ft, ISO 100, 20°C/68°F).

 Repeating Flash
The flash fires repeatedly while the shutter is open, producing a strobe-light effect. Press 4 or 2 to highlight the following options, 1 or 3 to change.

Option

Description

Output Choose flash output (expressed as a fraction of full power).

Choose the number of times the flash fires at the selected

Times

output. Note that depending on shutter speed and the option selected for Frequency, the actual number of flashes

may be less than selected.

Frequency Choose how often the flash fires per second.

A Flash Control Mode
The flash control mode for the built-in flash is shown in the information display (0 146).

A "Manual" and "Repeating Flash"
Y icons flash in the control panel and viewfinder when these options are selected.
U

236

A The SB-400
When an optional SB-400 flash unit is attached and turned on, Custom Setting e3 changes to Optional flash, allowing the flash control mode for the SB-400 to be selected from TTL and Manual (Repeating flash and Commander mode options are not available).
A "Times"
The options available for Repeating Flash > Times are determined by flash output.

Output 1/4 1/8 1/16

Options available for "Times" 2
2­5 2­10

Output 1/32 1/64 1/128

Options available for "Times" 2­10, 15
2­10, 15, 20, 25 2­10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 35

 Commander Mode
Use the built-in flash as a master flash controlling one or more remote optional flash units in up to two groups (A and B) using advanced wireless lighting (0 294).
Selecting this option displays the menu shown at right. Press 4 or 2 to highlight the following options, 1 or 3 to change.

Option

Description

Built-in flash

Choose a flash mode for the built-in flash (commander flash).

TTL

i-TTL mode. Choose flash compensation from values between +3.0 and ­3.0 EV in increments of 1/3 EV.

M Choose the flash level from values between 1/1 and 1/128 (1/128 of full power).

­­

The built-in flash does not fire, although remote flash units do. The built-in flash must be raised so that it can emit monitor pre-flashes.

Group A Choose a flash mode for all flash units in group A.

TTL

i-TTL mode. Choose flash compensation from values between +3.0 and ­3.0 EV in increments of 1/3 EV.

AA

Auto aperture (available only with compatible flash units; 0 294). Choose flash compensation from values between +3.0 and ­3.0 EV in increments of 1/3 EV.

M Choose the flash level from values between 1/1 and 1/128 (1/128 of full power).

­ ­ The flash units in this group do not fire.

Group B

Choose a flash mode for all flash units in group B. The options available are the same as those listed for Group A, above.

Channel

Choose from channels 1­4. All flash units in both groups must be set to the same channel.

U

237

Follow the steps below to take photographs in commander mode.
1 Adjust settings for the built-in flash.
Choose the flash control mode and output level for the built-in flash. Note that output level can not be adjusted in ­ ­ mode.
2 Adjust settings for group A.
Choose the flash control mode and output level for the flash units in group A.
3 Adjust settings for group B.
Choose the flash control mode and output level for the flash units in group B.
4 Select the channel.
5 Press J.
U
238

6 Compose the shot.
Compose the shot and arrange the flash units as shown below. Note that the maximum distance at which the remote flash units can be placed may vary with shooting conditions.

60 ° or less 10 m/33 ft or less 30 ° or less

5 m/15 ft or less

Wireless remote sensors on flash units should face camera.

30 ° or less 60 ° or less

Camera (built-in flash)
5 m/15 ft or less

7 Configure the remote flash units.
Turn all the remote flash units on, adjust group settings as desired, and set them to the channel selected in Step 4. See the flash unit instruction manuals for details.

8 Raise the built-in flash.
Press the M (Y) button to raise the built-in flash. Note that even if ­ ­ is selected for Built-in flash>Mode, the built-in flash must be raised so that monitor preflashes will be emitted.

9 Frame the photograph, focus, and shoot.
After confirming that the camera flash-ready light and the flash-ready lights for all other flash units are lit, frame the photograph, focus, and shoot. FV lock (0 149) can be used if desired.

U
239

A The Flash Sync Mode Display
M does not appear in the control panel flash sync mode display when ­ ­ is selected for Builtin flash > Mode.
A Flash Compensation
The flash compensation value selected with the M (Y) button and sub-command dial is added to the flash compensation values selected for the built-in flash, group A, and group B in the Commander mode menu. A Y icon is displayed in the control panel and viewfinder when a flash compensation value other than ±0 is selected for Built-in flash > TTL. The Y icon flashes when the built-in flash is in mode M.
D Commander Mode
Position the sensor windows on the remote flash units to pick up the light from the built-in flash (particular care is required if the camera is not mounted on a tripod). Be sure that direct light or strong reflections from the remote flash units do not enter the camera lens (in TTL mode) or the photocells on the remote flash units (AA mode), as this may interfere with exposure. To prevent timing flashes emitted by the built-in flash from appearing in photographs taken at short range, choose low ISO sensitivities or small apertures (high f-numbers) or use an optional SG-3IR infrared panel for the built-in flash. An SG-3IR is required for best results with rear-curtain sync, which produces brighter timing flashes. After positioning the remote flash units, take a test shot and view the results in the camera monitor.
Although there is no limit on the number of remote flash units that may be used, the practical maximum is three. With more than this number, the light emitted by the remote flash units will interfere with performance.

e4: Exposure Comp. for Flash

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose how the camera adjusts flash level when exposure compensation is used.

Option

Description

YE Entire frame

Both flash level and exposure compensation are adjusted to modify exposure over the entire frame.

E Background only Exposure compensation applies to background only.

U
240

e5: Modeling Flash

G button  A Custom Settings menu

If On is selected when the camera is being used with the built-in flash or an optional CLS-compatible flash unit (0 294), a modeling flash will be emitted when the camera depth-of-field preview button is pressed (0 77). No modeling flash is emitted if Off is selected.

e6: Auto Bracketing Set

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose the setting or settings bracketed when auto bracketing (0 153) is in effect. Choose AE & flash (j) to perform both exposure and flash-level bracketing, AE only (k) to bracket only exposure, Flash only (l) to perform only flash-level bracketing, WB bracketing (m) to perform white-balance bracketing (0 156), or ADL bracketing (y) to perform bracketing using Active D-Lighting (0 158). Note that white balance bracketing is not available at image quality settings of NEF (RAW) or
NEF (RAW) + JPEG.

e7: Bracketing Order

G button  A Custom Settings menu

At the default setting of MTR > under > over (H), exposure, flash, and white balance bracketing are performed in the order described on pages 153 and 156. If Under > MTR > over (I) is selected, shooting will proceed in order from the lowest to the highest value. This setting has no effect on ADL bracketing.

f: Controls

f1: OK Button (Shooting Mode) G button  A Custom Settings menu
Choose the role played by the J button during shooting: selecting the center focus point (J Select center focus point), highlighting the active focus point (K Highlight active focus point), or none (Not used).

U
241

f2: Assign Fn Button
Choose the role played by the Fn button.

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Option

Description

q Preview Press the Fn button to preview depth of field (0 77).

r FV lock

Press the Fn button to lock flash value (built-in flash and compatible optional flash units only, 0 149, 294). Press again to cancel FV lock.

B AE/AF lock Focus and exposure lock while the Fn button is pressed.

C AE lock only Exposure locks while the Fn button is pressed.

E

AE lock (Hold)

Exposure locks when the Fn button is pressed, and remains locked until the button is pressed a second time or the standby timer expires.

F AF lock only Focus locks while the Fn button is pressed.

A AF-ON

Pressing the Fn button initiates autofocus. The shutter-release button can not be used to focus.

s Flash off The flash will not fire in photos taken while the Fn button is pressed.

If the Fn button is pressed while exposure, flash, or ADL bracketing is active

in single frame or quiet shutter-release mode, all shots in the current

t

Bracketing burst

bracketing program will be taken each time the shutter-release button is pressed. If white balance bracketing is active or continuous release mode

(mode CH or CL) is selected, the camera will repeat the bracketing burst

while the shutter-release button is held down.

y

Active D-Lighting

Press the Fn button and rotate the main command dial to adjust Active D-Lighting (0 137).

If image quality is set to JPEG fine, JPEG normal, or JPEG basic, "RAW"

will be displayed in the control panel and an NEF (RAW) copy will be

e

+NEF (RAW)

recorded with the next picture taken after the Fn button is pressed (to record NEF/RAW copies with a series of photographs, keep the shutter-

release button pressed halfway between shots). To exit without recording

an NEF (RAW) copy, press the Fn button again.

L

Matrix metering

Matrix metering is activated while the Fn button is pressed.

Center-
M weighted Center-weighted metering is activated while the Fn button is pressed.

metering

U

N

Spot metering

Spot metering is activated while the Fn button is pressed.

242

Option

Description

9

Framing grid

Press the Fn button and rotate the main command dial to turn the framing grid display in the viewfinder on or off (0 8).

5

Choose image area

Press the Fn button and rotate a command dial to choose an image area (0 89).

Viewfinder
m virtual
horizon
n MY MENU

Press the Fn button to view a virtual horizon display in the viewfinder. Pressing the Fn button displays "MY MENU" (0 280).

Access top
6 item in MY
MENU

Press the Fn button to jump to the top item in "MY MENU." Select this option for quick access to a frequently-used menu item.

If the Fn button is pressed when the command dials are rotated, changes

v

1 step spd/ aperture

to shutter speed (modes S and M) and aperture (modes A and M) are made in increments of 1 EV, regardless of the option selected for Custom Setting

b2 (EV steps for exposure cntrl, 0 224).

w

Choose nonCPU lens number

Press the Fn button and rotate a command dial to choose a lens number specified using the Non-CPU lens data option (0 172).

K Playback

Fn button performs same function as K button. Select when using a telephoto lens or in other circumstances in which it is difficult to operate the K button with your left hand.

None

Pressing the button has no effect.

A Viewfinder Virtual Horizon
When Viewfinder virtual horizon is selected for Custom Setting f2 (Assign Fn button), pressing the Fn button converts the exposure display in the viewfinder to a roll indicator. Press the button again to restore the indicator to its normal function.

Camera tilted right

Camera level

Camera tilted left

Viewfinder Note that the display may not be accurate when the camera is tilted at a sharp angle forward or back. For a display that shows both pitch and roll, use the Virtual horizon option in the setup menu (0 258).
U
243

f3: Assign Preview Button

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose the role played by the depth-of-field preview button. The options available are the same as for Assign Fn button (0 242). The default setting is Preview.

f4: Assign AE-L/AF-L Button

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose the role played by the A AE-L/AF-L button.

Option

B

AE/AF lock

C

AE lock only

E

AE lock (Hold)

F

AF lock only

A AF-ON

r FV lock
None

Description Focus and exposure lock while the A AE-L/AF-L button is pressed.
Exposure locks while the A AE-L/AF-L button is pressed.
Exposure locks when the A AE-L/AF-L button is pressed, and remains locked until the button is pressed a second time or the standby timer expires.
Focus locks while the A AE-L/AF-L button is pressed.
The A AE-L/AF-L button initiates autofocus. The shutterrelease button can not be used to focus. Press the A AE-L/AF-L button to lock flash value (built-in flash and compatible optional flash units only, 0 149, 294). Press again to cancel FV lock. Pressing the button has no effect.

U
244

f5: Customize Command Dials

G button  A Custom Settings menu

This option controls the operation of the main and sub-command dials. · Reverse rotation: Reverse the direction of rotation of the
command dials when they are used to make adjustments to Exposure compensation and/or Shutter speed/aperture. Highlight options and press the multi selector right to select or deselect, then highlight Done and press J. This setting also applies to the command dials for the MB-D14. · Change main/sub: If Off is selected, the main command dial controls shutter speed and the sub-command dial controls aperture. Select On (Mode A) to use the main command dial to select aperture in shooting mode A, On to use the main command dial to select aperture in modes A and M and the sub-command dial to select shutter speed in modes S and M. This setting also applies to the command dials for the MB-D14. · Aperture setting: If Sub-command dial is selected, aperture can only be adjusted with the sub-command dial (or with the main command dial if On is selected for Change main/sub). If Aperture ring is selected, aperture can only be adjusted with the lens aperture ring and the camera aperture display will show aperture in increments of 1 EV (aperture for type G lenses is still set using the sub-command dial). Note that regardless of the setting chosen, the aperture ring must be used to adjust aperture when a non-CPU lens is attached. · Menus and playback: If Off is selected, the multi selector is used to choose the picture displayed during full-frame playback, highlight thumbnails, and navigate menus. If On or On (image review excluded) is selected, the main command dial can be used to choose the picture displayed during full-frame playback, move the cursor left or right during thumbnail playback, and move the menu highlight bar up or down. The sub-command dial is used to display additional photo information in full-frame playback and to move the cursor up or down during thumbnail playback. Select On (image review excluded) to prevent the command dials from being used for playback during image review. While menus are displayed, rotating the sub-command dial right displays the sub-menu for the selected option, while rotating it left displays the previous menu. To make a selection, press 2 or J.

U
245

f6: Release Button to Use Dial

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Selecting Yes allows adjustments that are normally made by holding the E, M (Y), W (S), X (T), L (U), AF-mode, Z (Q), or D button and rotating a command dial to be made by rotating the command dial after the button is released (this also applies to the Fn and depth-of-field preview buttons if they have been assigned Active D-Lighting using Custom Setting f2, Assign Fn button, or Custom Setting f3, Assign preview button). Setting ends when any of the affected buttons is pressed again or the shutter-release button is pressed halfway. Except when No limit is selected for Custom Setting c2 Standby timer, setting will also end when the standby timer expires.

f7: Slot Empty Release Lock

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Selecting Enable release allows the shutter to be released when no memory card is inserted, although no pictures will be recorded (they will however be displayed in the monitor in demo mode). If Release locked is selected, the shutter-release button is only enabled when a memory card is inserted in the camera.

f8: Reverse Indicators

G button  A Custom Settings menu

If

(W) is selected, the exposure indicators in the control panel,

viewfinder, and information display are displayed with negative values on the left

and positive values on the right. Select

(V) to display positive

values on the left and negative values on the right.

U
246

f9: Assign MB-D14 4 Button

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose the function assigned to the A AE-L/AF-L button on the optional MB-D14 battery pack.

Option B AE/AF lock C AE lock only
E AE lock (Hold)
F AF lock only A AF-ON

r FV lock

G

Same as Fn button

Description
Focus and exposure lock while the MB-D14 A AE-L/AF-L button is pressed. Exposure locks while the MB-D14 A AE-L/AF-L button is pressed. Exposure locks when the MB-D14 A AE-L/AF-L button is pressed, and remains locked until the button is pressed a second time or the standby timer expires. Focus locks while the MB-D14 A AE-L/AF-L button is pressed. Pressing the MB-D14 A AE-L/AF-L button initiates autofocus. The shutterrelease button can not be used to focus. Press the MB-D14 A AE-L/AF-L button to lock flash value (built-in flash and compatible optional flash units only, 0 149, 294). Press again to cancel FV lock. The MB-D14 A AE-L/AF-L button performs the function selected for Custom Setting f2 (0 242).

g: Movie

g1: Assign Fn Button

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose the role played by the Fn button during movie live view (the default option is None).

Option

Description

r

Index marking

Press the button during movie recording to add an index at the current position (0 60). Indices can be used when viewing and editing movies.

s

View photo shooting info

Press the button to display information on shutter speed, aperture, and other photo settings in place of movie recording information. Press again to return to the movie recording display (0 59).

B AE/AF lock Focus and exposure lock while the button is pressed.

C AE lock only Exposure locks while the button is pressed.

E AE lock (Hold)

Exposure locks when the button is pressed, and remains locked until the button is pressed a second time or the standby timer expires.

F AF lock only Focus locks while the button is pressed.

U

A AF-ON

Pressing the button initiates autofocus. The shutter-release button can not be used to focus.

None

Pressing the button has no effect.

247

g2: Assign Preview Button

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose the role played by the depth-of-field preview button during movie live view. The options available are the same as for Assign Fn button (0 247), except that the default setting is Index marking.

g3: Assign AE-L/AF-L Button

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose the role played by the A AE-L/AF-L button during movie live view. The options available are the same as for Assign Fn button (0 247), except that the default setting is AE/AF lock.

g4: Assign Shutter Button

G button  A Custom Settings menu

Choose the role played by pressing the shutter-release button when 1 is selected with the live view selector.

Option C Take photos
1 Record movies

Description
Press the shutter-release button all the way down to end movie recording and take a photograph with an aspect ratio of 16 : 9 (for information on image size, see page 63).
Press the shutter-release button halfway to start movie live view. You can then press the shutter-release button halfway to focus (autofocus mode only) and press it all the way down to start or end recording. To end movie live view, press the a button. The shutter-release button on an optional remote cord (0 298) can be used to start movie live view and to start and end movie recording; the optional ML-L3 remote control, however, can not be used to record movies. In remote control (4) mode, pressing the shutter-release button halfway does not start movie live view, while pressing the shutter-release button on the remote control releases the shutter to record a photograph and does not start or end movie recording.

A Record Movies
When this option is selected, interval timer (0 164) is not available and the shutter-release button can not be used during movie live view to record photographs, measure preset white
balance, or record image dust off reference data. Select Take photos to use these options.

U

248

B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup
To display the setup menu, press G and select the B (setup menu) tab.

G button

The setup menu contains the following options:

Option

0

Option

0

Format memory card

250 Image comment

253

Save user settings

81 Auto image rotation

254

Reset user settings

82 Battery info

255

Monitor brightness

250 Copyright information

256

Clean image sensor

301 Save/load settings

257

Lock mirror up for cleaning 1

303 GPS

175

Image Dust Off ref photo

251 Virtual horizon

258

HDMI

205 Non-CPU lens data

172

Flicker reduction

252 AF fine-tune

259

Time zone and date

253 Eye-Fi upload 2

260

Language

253 Firmware version

260

1 Not available when battery is low. 2 Only displayed when compatible Eye-Fi memory card is inserted (0 260).

A See Also
Menu defaults are listed on page 314.

U
249

Format Memory Card

G button  B setup menu

To begin formatting, choose a memory card slot and select Yes. Note that formatting permanently deletes all pictures and other data on the card in the selected slot. Before formatting, be sure to make backup copies as required.

D During Formatting
Do not turn the camera off or remove memory cards during formatting.
A Two-Button Format
Memory cards can also be formatted by pressing the O (Q) and Z (Q) buttons for more than two seconds (0 31).

Monitor Brightness

G button  B setup menu

Adjust the brightness of the monitor for playback, menus, and the information display.

Option

Description

When the monitor is on, monitor brightness is automatically adjusted according to

Auto ambient lighting conditions. Care should be taken not to cover the ambient brightness sensor (0 4).

Manual

Press 1 or 3 to choose monitor brightness. Choose higher values for increased brightness, lower values for reduced brightness.

A See Also
For information on adjusting monitor brightness in live view, see page 53.

U
250

Image Dust Off Ref Photo

G button  B setup menu

Acquire reference data for the Image Dust Off option in Capture NX 2 (available separately; for more information, see the Capture NX 2 manual).
Image Dust Off ref photo is available only when a CPU lens is mounted on the camera. A non-DX lens with a focal length of at least 50 mm is recommended. When using a zoom lens, zoom all the way in.

1 Choose a start option.
Highlight one of the following options and press J. To exit without acquiring image dust off data, press G.

· Start: The message shown at right will be displayed and "rEF" will appear in the viewfinder and control panel displays.
· Clean sensor and then start: Select this option to clean the image sensor before starting. The message shown at right will be displayed and "rEF" will appear in the viewfinder and control panel displays when cleaning is complete.

2 Frame a featureless white object in the viewfinder.
With the lens about ten centimeters (four inches) from a well-lit, featureless white object, frame the object so that it fills the viewfinder and then press the shutter-release button halfway.
In autofocus mode, focus will automatically be set to infinity; in manual focus mode, set focus to infinity manually.

U
251

3 Acquire dust off reference data.
Press the shutter-release button the rest of the way down to acquire Image Dust Off reference data. The monitor turns off when the shutter-release button is pressed. Note that noise reduction will be performed if the subject is poorly lit, increasing recording times.
If the reference object is too bright or too dark, the camera may be unable to acquire Image Dust Off reference data and the message shown at right will be displayed. Choose another reference object and repeat the process from step 1.
D Image Sensor Cleaning
Dust off reference data recorded before image sensor cleaning is performed can not be used with photographs taken after image sensor cleaning is performed. Select Clean sensor and then start only if the dust off reference data will not be used with existing photographs.
D Image Dust Off Reference Data
The same reference data can be used for photographs taken with different lenses or at different apertures. Reference images can not be viewed using computer imaging software. A grid pattern is displayed when reference images are viewed on the camera.

Flicker Reduction

G button  B setup menu

Reduce flicker and banding when shooting under fluorescent or mercury-vapor lighting during live view or movie recording. Choose Auto to allow the camera to automatically choose the correct frequency, or manually match the frequency to that of the local AC power supply.
A Flicker Reduction
If Auto fails to produce the desired results and you are unsure as to the frequency of the local power supply, test both the 50 and 60 Hz options and choose the one that produces the best results. Flicker reduction may not produce the desired results if the subject is very bright, in which case you should try choosing a smaller aperture (higher f-number).

U

252

Time Zone and Date

G button  B setup menu

Change time zones, set the camera clock, choose the date display order, and turn daylight saving time on or off (0 27).

Option

Description

Time zone

Choose a time zone. The camera clock is automatically set to the time in the new time zone.

Date and time

Set the camera clock. If the clock is not set, a flashing B icon will appear in the information display.

Date format Choose the order in which the day, month, and year are displayed.

Daylight saving time

Turn daylight saving time on or off. The camera clock will automatically be advanced or set back one hour. The default setting is Off.

Language
Choose a language for camera menus and messages.

G button  B setup menu

Image Comment

G button  B setup menu

Add a comment to new photographs as they are taken. Comments can be viewed as metadata in ViewNX 2 (supplied) or Capture NX 2 (available separately; 0 298). The comment is also visible on the shooting data page in the photo information display (0 182). · Done: Save changes and return to the setup menu. · Input comment: Input a comment as described on page 135. Comments can be
up to 36 characters long. · Attach comment: Select this option to attach the comment
to all subsequent photographs. Attach comment can be turned on and off by highlighting it and pressing 2.

U
253

Auto Image Rotation

G button  B setup menu

Photographs taken while On is selected contain information on camera orientation, allowing them to be rotated automatically during playback (0 177) or when viewed in ViewNX 2 (supplied) or in Capture NX 2 (available separately; 0 298). The following orientations are recorded:

Landscape (wide) orientation

Camera rotated 90° clockwise

Camera rotated 90° counter-clockwise

Camera orientation is not recorded when Off is selected. Choose this option when panning or taking photographs with the lens pointing up or down.

A Rotate Tall
To automatically rotate "tall" (portrait-orientation) photographs for display during playback, select On for the Rotate tall option in the playback menu (0 212).

U
254

Battery Info

G button  B setup menu

View information on the battery currently inserted in the camera.

Item Charge No. of shots
Battery age

Description
The current battery level expressed as a percentage.
The number of times the shutter has been released with the current battery since the battery was last charged. Note that the camera may sometimes release the shutter without recording a photograph, for example when measuring preset white balance. A five-level display showing battery age. 0 (k) indicates that battery performance is unimpaired, 4 (l) that the battery has reached the end of its charging life and should be replaced. Note that batteries charged at temperatures under about 5 °C (41 °F) may show a temporary drop in charging life; the battery age display will however return to normal once the battery has been recharged at a temperature of about 20 °C (68 °F) or higher.

A The MB-D14 Battery Pack
The display for the MB-D14 battery pack is shown at right. If AA batteries are used, the battery level will be shown by a battery level icon; other items will not be displayed.

U
255

Copyright Information

G button  B setup menu

Add copyright information to new photographs as they are taken. Copyright information is included in the shooting data shown in the photo information display (0 182) and can be viewed as metadata in ViewNX 2 (supplied) or in Capture NX 2 (available separately; 0 298). · Done: Save changes and return to the setup menu. · Artist: Enter a photographer name as described on page 135. Photographer
names can be up to 36 characters long. · Copyright: Enter the name of the copyright holder as described on page 135.
Copyright holder names can be up to 54 characters long. · Attach copyright information: Select this option to attach
copyright information to all subsequent photographs. Attach copyright information can be turned on and off by highlighting it and pressing 2.

D Copyright Information
To prevent unauthorized use of the artist or copyright holder names, make sure that Attach copyright information is not selected and that the Artist and Copyright fields are blank before lending or transferring the camera to another person. Nikon does not accept liability for any damages or disputes arising from the use of the Copyright information option.

U
256

Save/Load Settings

G button  B setup menu

Select Save settings to save the following settings to the memory card in Slot 1 (0 96; if the card is full, an error will be displayed). Use this option to share settings among D600 cameras.

Menu

Option

Playback display options

Playback

Image review After delete

Rotate tall

File naming

Role played by card in Slot 2

Image quality

Image size

Image area

JPEG compression

NEF (RAW) recording

White balance (with fine-tuning

and presets d-1­d-4)

Shooting Set Picture Control

Auto distortion control

Color space

Active D-Lighting

Vignette control

Long exposure NR

High ISO NR

ISO sensitivity settings

Remote control mode

Movie settings

Menu

Option

Custom All Custom Settings except Reset

settings custom settings

Clean image sensor

HDMI

Flicker reduction

Time zone and date (excepting

date and time)

Language Setup Image comment

Auto image rotation

Copyright information

GPS

Non-CPU lens data

Eye-Fi upload

My Menu/ All My Menu items

Recent All recent settings

Settings Choose tab

Settings saved using this model of camera can be restored by selecting Load settings. Note that Save/load settings is only available when a memory card is inserted in the camera, and that the Load settings option is only available if the card contains saved settings.

A Saved Settings
Settings are saved in a file named NCSETUPA. The camera will not be able to load settings if the file name is changed.

U

257

Virtual Horizon

G button  B setup menu

Display roll and pitch information based on information from the camera tilt sensor. If the camera is tilted neither left nor right, the roll reference line will turn green, while if the camera is tilted neither forward nor back, the pitch reference line will turn green and a dot will appear in the center of the display. Each division is equivalent to 5°.

Camera level

Camera tilted left or right

Camera tilted forward or back

D Tilting the Camera
The virtual horizon display is not accurate when the camera is tilted at a sharp angle forward or back. If the camera is unable to measure tilt, the amount of tilt will not be displayed.
A See Also
For information on viewing a roll indicator in the viewfinder, see Custom Setting f2 (Assign Fn button; 0 242, 243). For information on displaying a virtual horizon in live view, see pages 55 and 62.

U
258

AF Fine-tune

G button  B setup menu

Fine-tune focus for up to 12 lens types. AF tuning is not recommended in most situations and may interfere with normal focus; use only when required.

Option AF fine-tune · On: Turn AF tuning on.
(On/Off) · Off: Turn AF tuning off.

Description

Saved value

Tune AF for the current lens (CPU lenses only). Press 1 or 3 to choose a value between +20 and ­20. Values for up to 12 lens types can be stored. Only one value can be stored for each type of lens.

Move focal point away from camera.

Current value

Default
List saved values

Choose the AF tuning value used when no previously saved value exists for the current lens (CPU lenses only).

Move focal Previous point toward value camera.

List previously saved AF tuning values. To delete a lens from the list, highlight the desired lens and press O (Q). To change a lens identifier (for example, to choose an identifier that is the same as the last two digits of the lens serial number to distinguish it from other lenses of the same type in light of the fact that Saved value can be used with only one lens of each type), highlight the desired lens and press 2.

The menu shown at right will be displayed; press 1 or 3 to choose an identifier and press J to save changes and exit.

D AF Tuning
The camera may be unable to focus at minimum range or at infinity when AF tuning is applied.
D Live View
Tuning is not applied to autofocus during in live view (0 53).
A Saved Value
Only one value can be stored for each type of lens. If a teleconverter is used, separate values can be stored for each combination of lens and teleconverter.
U

259

Eye-Fi Upload

G button  B setup menu

This option is displayed only when an Eye-Fi memory card (available separately from third-party suppliers) is inserted in the camera. Choose Enable to upload photographs to a preselected destination. Note that pictures will not be uploaded if signal strength is insufficient.
Observe all local laws concerning wireless devices and choose Disable where wireless devices are prohibited.
When an Eye-Fi card is inserted, its status is indicated by an icon in the information display: · d: Eye-Fi upload disabled. · e: Eye-Fi upload enabled but no pictures available for upload. · f (static): Eye-Fi upload enabled; waiting to begin upload. · f (animated): Eye-Fi upload enabled; uploading data. · g: Error -- camera can not control Eye-Fi card. If a flashing W appears in the
control panel or viewfinder, refer to page 324; if this indicator is not flashing, pictures can be taken normally but you may be unable to change Eye-Fi settings.

D Eye-Fi Cards
Eye-Fi cards may emit wireless signals when Disable is selected. If a warning is displayed in the monitor (0 324), turn the camera off and remove the card.
See the manual provided with the Eye-Fi card, and direct any inquiries to the manufacturer. The camera can be used to turn Eye-Fi cards on and off, but may not support other Eye-Fi functions.
A Supported Eye-Fi Cards
As of December 2011, the camera supports 8 GB SDHC Pro X2 Eye-Fi cards. Some cards may not be available in some countries or regions; consult the manufacturer for more information. Eye-Fi cards are for use only in the country of purchase. Be sure the Eye-Fi card firmware has been updated to the latest version.
A Using Eye-Fi Cards in Ad Hoc Mode
Additional time may be required when connecting using Eye-Fi cards that support ad hoc mode. Set Custom Setting c2 (Standby timer, 0 227) to 30 s or longer.

Firmware Version
View the current camera firmware version.

G button  B setup menu

U

260

N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies
To display the retouch menu, press G and select the N (retouch menu) tab.

G button

The options in the retouch menu are used to create trimmed or retouched copies of existing pictures. The retouch menu is only displayed when a memory card containing photographs is inserted in the camera (note that if the memory card is being used to store both RAW/NEF and JPEG copies of the same photographs as described on page 93, retouch other than Image overlay and NEF (RAW) processing apply only to the JPEG copies).

Option

0

Option

0

i D-Lighting

264

e Straighten

274

j Red-eye correction

264

( Distortion control

274

k Trim

265

) Fisheye

274

l Monochrome

266

f Color outline

275

m Filter effects

267

g Color sketch

275

n Color balance o Image overlay 1

268

h Perspective control

275

269

i Miniature effect

276

7 NEF (RAW) processing

271

u Selective color

277

8 Resize

272

9 Edit movie

69

& Quick retouch

273 p Side-by-side comparison 2

279

1 Can only be selected by pressing G and selecting N tab. 2 Only available if J or c (b) is pressed in full-frame playback when a retouched image or
original is displayed.

D Retouching Copies
Most options can be applied to copies created using other retouch options, although with the exceptions of Image overlay and Edit movie > Choose start/end point each option can be applied only once (note that multiple edits may result in loss of detail). Options that can not be applied to the current image are grayed out and unavailable.
A Image Quality
U Except in the case of copies created with Trim, Image overlay, NEF (RAW) processing, and
Resize, copies created from JPEG images are the same size and quality as the original, while copies created from NEF (RAW) photos are saved as large fine-quality JPEG images. Sizepriority compression is used when copies are saved in JPEG format.

261

Creating Retouched Copies
To create a retouched copy:
1 Select an item in the retouch menu.
Press 1 or 3 to highlight an item, 2 to select.
2 Select a picture.
Highlight a picture and press J (to view the highlighted picture full screen, press and hold the X (T) button; to view images in other locations as described on page 178, hold D and press 1).
A Retouch
The camera may not be able to display or retouch images created with other devices.
3 Select retouch options.
For more information, see the section for the selected item. To exit without creating a retouched copy, press G.
A Monitor off Delay
The monitor will turn off and the operation will be cancelled if no actions are performed for a brief period. Any unsaved changes will be lost. To increase the time the monitor remains on, choose a longer menu display time for Custom Setting c4 (Monitor off delay; 0 228).
4 Create a retouched copy.
Press J to create a retouched copy. Retouched copies are indicated by a o icon.
U
262

A Creating Retouched Copies During Playback
Retouched copies can also be created during playback.

2

2

Display picture full frame and press J or c (b).

Highlight an option and press J.

Create retouched copy.

U
263

D-Lighting

G button  N retouch menu

D-lighting brightens shadows, making it ideal for dark or backlit photographs.

Before

After

Press 1 or 3 to choose the amount of correction performed. The effect can be previewed in the edit display. Press J to copy the photograph.

Red-Eye Correction

G button  N retouch menu

This option is used to correct "red-eye" caused by the flash, and is available only with photographs taken using the flash. The photograph selected for red-eye correction can be previewed in the edit display. Confirm the effects of red-eye correction and create a copy as described in the following table. Note that red-eye correction may not always produce the expected results and may in very rare circumstances be applied to portions of the image that are not affected by red-eye; check the preview thoroughly before proceeding.

To

Use

Description

Zoom in X (T) Press X (T) to zoom in, W (S) to zoom out. While photo is zoomed in, use multi

Zoom out W (S) selector to view areas of image not visible in

View other areas of image

monitor. Keep multi selector pressed to scroll rapidly to other areas of frame. Navigation window is displayed when zoom buttons or

multi selector is pressed; area currently

Cancel zoom J visible in monitor is indicated by yellow border. Press J to cancel

zoom.

If the camera detects red-eye in the selected photograph, a copy will

Create copy

J be created that has been processed to reduce its effects. No copy

will be created if the camera is unable to detect red-eye.

U

264

Trim

G button  N retouch menu

Create a cropped copy of the selected photograph. The selected photograph is displayed with the selected crop shown in yellow; create a cropped copy as described in the following table.

To Reduce size of crop Increase size of crop

Use

Description

W (S) Press W (S) to reduce the size of the crop.

X (T) Press X (T) to increase the size of the crop.

Change crop aspect ratio

Rotate the main command dial to switch between aspect ratios of 3 : 2, 4 : 3, 5 : 4, 1 : 1, and 16 : 9.

Position crop Create copy

Use multi selector to position the crop. Press and hold to move the crop rapidly to the desired position.
J Save the current crop as a separate file.

A Trim: Image Quality and Size
Copies created from NEF (RAW) or NEF (RAW) + JPEG photos have an image quality (0 93) of JPEG fine; cropped copies created from JPEG photos have the same image quality as the original. The size of the copy varies with crop size and aspect ratio and appears at upper left in the crop display.
A Viewing Cropped Copies
Playback zoom may not be available when cropped copies are displayed.

U
265

Monochrome
Copy photographs in Black-and-white, Sepia, or Cyanotype (blue and white monochrome).

G button  N retouch menu

Selecting Sepia or Cyanotype displays a preview of the selected image; press 1 to increase color saturation, 3 to decrease. Press J to create a monochrome copy.

Increase saturation

Decrease saturation

U
266

Filter Effects

G button  N retouch menu

Choose from the following filter effects. After adjusting filter effects as described below, press J to copy the photograph.

Option Skylight
Warm filter

Description Creates the effect of a skylight filter, making the picture less blue. The effect can be previewed in the monitor as shown at right. Creates a copy with warm tone filter effects, giving the copy a "warm" red cast. The effect can be previewed in the monitor.

Red intensifier Intensify reds (Red intensifier), greens (Green
Green intensifier intensifier), or blues (Blue intensifier). Press 1 to increase the effect, 3 to decrease.
Blue intensifier

Cross screen

Add starburst effects to light sources. · Number of points: Choose from four, six, or eight. · Filter amount: Choose the brightness of the light
sources affected. · Filter angle: Choose the angle of the points. · Length of points: Choose the length of points. · Confirm: Preview the effects of the filter as shown at
right. Press X (T) to preview the copy full frame. · Save: Create a retouched copy.

Soft

Add a soft filter effect. Press 1 or 3 to choose the filter strength.

U
267

Color Balance

G button  N retouch menu

Use the multi selector to create a copy with modified color balance as shown below. The effect is displayed in the monitor together with red, green, and blue histograms (0 181) giving the distribution of tones in the copy.

Increase amount of green Create retouched copy

Increase amount of blue

Increase amount of amber

Increase amount of magenta
A Zoom
To zoom in on the image displayed in the monitor, press X (T). The histogram will be updated to show data only for the portion of the image displayed in the monitor. While the image is zoomed in, press L (U) to toggle back and forth between color balance and zoom. When zoom is selected, you can zoom in and out with the X (T) and W (S) and scroll the image with the multi selector.

U
268

Image Overlay

G button  N retouch menu

Image overlay combines two existing NEF (RAW) photographs to create a single picture that is saved separately from the originals; the results, which make use of RAW data from the camera image sensor, are noticeably better than overlays created in an imaging application. The new picture is saved at current image quality and size settings; before creating an overlay, set image quality and size (0 93, 95; all options are available). To create a NEF (RAW) copy, choose an image quality of NEF (RAW).

+

1 Select Image overlay.
Highlight Image overlay in the retouch menu and press 2.

The dialog shown at right will be displayed, with Image 1 highlighted; press J to display a list of the NEF pictures created with this camera.

2 Select the first image.
Use the multi selector to highlight the first photograph in the overlay. To view the highlighted photograph full frame, press and hold the X (T) button (to view images in other locations as described on page 178, hold D and press 1). Press J to select the highlighted photograph and return to the preview display.
3 Select the second image.
The selected image will appear as Image 1. Highlight Image 2 and press J, then select the second photo as described in Step 2.
U

269

4 Adjust gain.
Highlight Image 1 or Image 2 and optimize exposure for the overlay by pressing 1 or 3 to select gain from values between 0.1 and 2.0. Repeat for the second image. The default value is 1.0; select 0.5 to halve gain or 2.0 to double it. The effects are visible in the Preview column.
5 Preview the overlay.
Press 4 or 2 to place the cursor in the Preview column and press 1 or 3 to highlight Overlay. Press J to preview the overlay as shown at right (to save the overlay without displaying a preview, select Save). To return to Step 4 and select new photos or adjust gain, press W (S).
6 Save the overlay.
Press J while the preview is displayed to save the overlay. After an overlay is created, the resulting image will be displayed full-frame in the monitor.
D Image Overlay
Only NEF (RAW) photographs with the same image area and bit depth can be combined. The overlay has the same photo info (including date of recording, metering, shutter speed, aperture, shooting mode, exposure compensation, focal length, and image orientation), and values for white balance and Picture Control as the photograph selected for Image 1. The current image comment is appended to the overlay when it is saved; copyright information, however, is not copied. Overlays saved in NEF (RAW) format use the compression selected for Type in the NEF (RAW) recording menu and have the same bit depth as the original images; JPEG overlays are saved using size-priority compression.
U
270

NEF (RAW) Processing
Create JPEG copies of NEF (RAW) photographs.

G button  N retouch menu

1 Select NEF (RAW) processing.
Highlight NEF (RAW) processing in the retouch menu and press 2 to display a picture selection dialog listing only NEF (RAW) images created with this camera.

2 Select a photograph.
Highlight a photograph (to view the highlighted photograph full frame, press and hold the X (T) button; to view images in other locations as described on page 178, hold D and press 1). Press J to select the highlighted photograph and proceed to the next step.

3 Choose settings for the JPEG copy.
Adjust the settings listed below. Note that white balance and vignette control are not available with multiple exposures or pictures created with image overlay and that exposure compensation can only be set to values between ­2 and +2 EV. The Picture Control grid is not displayed when Picture Controls are adjusted.

Image quality (0 93) Image size (0 95) White balance (0 115) Exposure compensation (0 112) Set Picture Control (0 129) High ISO NR (0 218)
Color space (0 217) Vignette control (0 218) D-Lighting (0 264)
U

271

4 Copy the photograph.
Highlight EXE and press J to create a JPEG copy of the selected photograph (to exit without copying the photograph, press the G button).

Resize

G button  N retouch menu

Create small copies of selected photographs.

1 Select Resize.
To resize selected images, press G to display the menus and select Resize in the retouch menu.

2 Choose a destination.
If two memory cards are inserted, you can choose a destination for the resized copies by highlighting Choose destination and pressing 2 (if only one card is inserted, proceed to Step 3).
The menu shown at right will be displayed; highlight a card slot and press J.

3 Choose a size.
Highlight Choose size and press 2.
The options shown at right will be displayed; highlight an option and press J.
U

272

4 Choose pictures.
Highlight Select image and press 2.

The dialog shown at right will be displayed; highlight pictures using the multi selector and press the W (S) button to select or deselect (to view the highlighted picture full screen, press and hold the X (T) button; to view images in other locations as described on page 178, hold D and press 1). Selected pictures are marked by a 8 icon. Press J when the selection is complete.
5 Save the resized copies.
A confirmation dialog will be displayed. Highlight Yes and press J to save the resized copies.

A Viewing Resized Copies
Playback zoom may not be available when resized copies are displayed.
A Image Quality
Copies created from NEF (RAW) or NEF (RAW) + JPEG photos have an image quality (0 93) of JPEG fine; copies created from JPEG photos have the same image quality as the original.

Quick Retouch

G button  N retouch menu

Create copies with enhanced saturation and contrast. D-Lighting is applied as required to brighten dark or backlit subjects.
Press 1 or 3 to choose the amount of enhancement. The effect can be previewed in the edit display. Press J to copy the photograph.

U

273

Straighten

G button  N retouch menu

Create a straightened copy of the selected image. Press 2 to rotate the image clockwise by up to five degrees in increments of approximately 0.25 degrees, 4 to rotate it counterclockwise (the effect can be previewed in the edit display; note that edges of the image will be trimmed to create a square copy). Press J to copy the photograph, or press K to exit to playback without creating a copy.

Distortion Control

G button  N retouch menu

Create copies with reduced peripheral distortion. Select Auto to let the camera correct distortion automatically and then make fine adjustments using the multi selector, or select Manual to reduce distortion manually (note that Auto is not available with photos taken using auto distortion control; see page 217). Press 2 to reduce barrel distortion, 4 to reduce pincushion distortion (the effect can be previewed in the edit display; note that greater amounts of distortion control result in more of the edges being cropped out). Press J to copy the photograph, or press K to exit to playback without creating a copy. Note that distortion control may heavily crop or distort the edges of copies created from photographs taken with DX lenses at an image area setting of FX (36×24) 1.0×.
A Auto
Auto is for use only with pictures taken with type G and D lenses (PC, fisheye, and certain other lenses excluded). Results are not guaranteed with other lenses.

Fisheye

G button  N retouch menu

Create copies that appear to have been taken with a fisheye lens. Press 2 to increase the effect (this also increases the amount of that will be cropped out at the edges of the image), 4 to reduce it. The effect can be previewed in the edit display. Press J to copy the photograph, or press K to exit to playback without creating a copy.

U

274

Color Outline

G button  N retouch menu

Create an outline copy of a photograph to use as a base for painting. The effect can be previewed in the edit display. Press J to copy the photograph.

Before

After

Color Sketch

G button  N retouch menu

Create a copy of a photograph that resembles a sketch made with colored pencils. Press 1 or 3 to highlight Vividness or Outlines and press 4 or 2 to change. Vividness can be increased to make colors more saturated, or decreased for a washed-out, monochromatic effect, while outlines can be made thicker or thinner. Thicker outlines makes colors more saturated. The results can be previewed in the edit display. Press J to copy the photograph, or press K to exit to playback without creating a copy.

Perspective Control

G button  N retouch menu

Create copies that reduce the effects of perspective taken from the base of a tall object. Use the multi selector to adjust perspective (note that greater amounts of perspective control result in more of the edges being cropped out). The results can be previewed in the edit display. Press J to copy the photograph, or press K to exit to playback without creating a copy.

Before

After

U
275

Miniature Effect

G button  N retouch menu

Create a copy that appears to be a photo of a diorama. Works best with photos taken from a high vantage point. The area that will be in focus in the copy is indicated by a yellow frame.

To

Press

Description

Choose orientation

W (S) Press W (S) to choose orientation of area that is in focus.

Choose position

If area of effect is in wide orientation, press 1 or 3 to position frame showing area of copy that will be in focus.
If area of effect is in tall orientation, press 4 or 2 to position frame showing area of copy that will be in focus.

Area in focus

Choose size

If area of effect is in wide orientation, press 4 or 2 to choose height.
If area of effect is in tall orientation, press 1 or 3 to choose width.

Preview copy X (T) Preview copy.

Cancel

K Exit to full-frame playback without creating copy.

Create copy J Create copy.

U
276

Selective Color

G button  N retouch menu

Create a copy in which only selected hues appear in color.

1 Select Selective color.
Highlight Selective color in the retouch menu and press 2 to display a picture selection dialog.

2 Select a photograph.
Highlight a photograph (to view the highlighted photograph full frame, press and hold the X (T) button; to view images in other locations as described on page 178, hold D and press 1). Press J to select the highlighted photograph and proceed to the next step.

3 Select a color.

Selected color

Use the multi selector to position the cursor

over an object and press the A AE-L/AF-L

button to select the color of the object as

one that will remain in the final copy (the

camera may have difficulty detecting

unsaturated colors; choose a saturated color). To zoom in on the picture for precise A AE-L/AF-L button

color selection, press X (T). Press W (S) to zoom out.

4 Highlight the color range.
Rotate the main command dial to highlight the color range for the selected color.

Color range

U
277

5 Choose the color range.
Press 1 or 3 to increase or decrease the range of similar hues that will be included in the final photograph or movie. Choose from values between 1 and 7; note that higher values may include hues from other colors. The effect can be previewed in the edit display.
6 Select additional colors.
To select additional colors, rotate the main command dial to highlight another of the three color boxes at the top of the display and repeat Steps 3­5 to select another color. Repeat for a third color if desired. To deselect the highlighted color, press O (Q), or press and hold O (Q) to remove all colors.
7 Save the edited copy.
Press J to copy the photograph.
U
278

Side-by-side Comparison
Compare retouched copies to the original photographs. This option is only available if J or c (b) button is pressed to display the retouch menu when a copy or original is played back full frame.
1 Select a picture.
In full-frame playback, select a retouched copy (shown by a o icon) or a photograph that has been retouched and press J or c (b).
2 Select Side-by-side comparison.
Highlight Side-by-side comparison and press J.

3 Compare the copy with the original.

Options used to create

The source image is displayed on the left, the

copy

retouched copy on the right, with the options

used to create the copy listed at the top of the

display. Press 4 or 2 to switch between the

source image and the retouched copy. To view

the highlighted picture full frame, press and hold

the X (T) button. If the copy was created from two source images using Image overlay, or

Source Retouched image copy

if the source has been copied multiple times,

press 1 or 3 to view the other source images or copies. To exit to playback

mode, press the K button, or press J to exit to playback with the highlighted

image selected.

D Side-by-side Comparisons
The source image will not be displayed if the copy was created from a photograph that was protected (0 188), is on a locked memory card, has since been deleted or hidden (0 208), or is on a card in a different slot from that used when the image was created.

U

279

O My Menu/m Recent Settings
To display My Menu, press G and select the O (My Menu) tab.

G button
The My Menu option can be used to create and edit a customized list of options from the playback, shooting, Custom Settings, setup, and retouch menus for quick access (up to 20 items). If desired, recent settings can be displayed in place of My Menu (0 283).
Options can be added, deleted, and reordered as described below.
 Adding Options to My Menu
1 Select Add items.
In My Menu (O), highlight Add items and press 2.

2 Select a menu.
Highlight the name of the menu containing the option you wish to add and press 2.

3 Select an item.
Highlight the desired menu item and press J.

4 Position the new item.

Press 1 or 3 to move the new item up or

U

down in My Menu. Press J to add the new

item.

280

5 Add more items.
The items currently displayed in My Menu are indicated by a check mark. Items indicated by a V icon can not be selected. Repeat steps 1­4 to select additional items.
 Deleting Options from My Menu
1 Select Remove items.
In My Menu (O), highlight Remove items and press 2.
2 Select items.
Highlight items and press 2 to select or deselect. Selected items are indicated by a check mark.
3 Select Done.
Highlight Done and press J. A confirmation dialog will be displayed.
4 Delete the selected items.
Press J to delete the selected items.

A Deleting Items in My Menu

U

To delete the item currently highlighted in My Menu, press the O (Q) button. A

confirmation dialog will be displayed; press O (Q) again to remove the selected item from

My Menu.

281

 Reordering Options in My Menu
1 Select Rank items.
In My Menu (O), highlight Rank items and press 2.
2 Select an item.
Highlight the item you wish to move and press J.
3 Position the item.
Press 1 or 3 to move the item up or down in My Menu and press J. Repeat Steps 2­3 to reposition additional items.
4 Exit to My Menu.
Press the G button to return to My Menu.
G button
U
282

Recent Settings
To display the twenty most recently used settings, select m Recent settings for O My Menu > Choose tab.
1 Select Choose tab.
In My Menu (O), highlight Choose tab and press 2.
2 Select m Recent settings.
Highlight m Recent settings and press J. The name of the menu will change from "MY MENU" to "RECENT SETTINGS." Menu items will be added to the top of the recent settings menu as they are used. To view My Menu again, select O My Menu for m Recent settings > Choose tab.
U
A Removing Items from the Recent Settings Menu
To remove an item from the recent settings menu, highlight it and press the O (Q) button. A confirmation dialog will be displayed; press O (Q) again to delete the selected item.
283

U
284

nTechnical Notes
Read this chapter for information on compatible accessories, cleaning and storing the camera, and what to do if an error message is displayed or you encounter problems using the camera.

Compatible Lenses

Camera setting

Focus mode

Lens/accessory

AF

M (with electronic rangefinder)

M

Type G or D AF NIKKOR 2 AF-S, AF-I NIKKOR







CPU lenses 1

PC-E NIKKOR series

--

5



PC Micro 85mm f/2.8D 4

--

5



AF-S / AF-I Teleconverter 7







Other AF NIKKOR (except lenses for F3AF)  8

8



AI-P NIKKOR

--

9



AI-, AI-modified, NIKKOR or Nikon Series E lenses 11

--

9



Non-CPU lenses 10

Medical-NIKKOR 120mm f/4

--





Reflex-NIKKOR

--

--



PC-NIKKOR

--

5



AI-type Teleconverter 17

--

 18



PB-6 Bellows Focusing Attachment 19

--

 18



Auto extension rings (PK-series 11A, 12, or 13; PN-11)

--

 18



Shooting mode
PA SM

Metering system

L

M

3D Color N

   -- 3

 5  5  5 --  3,5 --  6  --  3,5    -- 3   --  3   --  3

--  12 --  13  14

--  15 -- -- -- --  12 -- --  14 --  16 -- --  --  12 --  13  14 --  20 -- -- 

--  12 -- -- 

1 IX-NIKKOR lenses can not be used.

2 Vibration Reduction (VR) supported with VR lenses.

3 Spot metering meters selected focus point (0 109).

4 The camera's exposure metering and flash control systems do not work properly when shifting and/or

tilting the lens, or when an aperture other than the maximum aperture is used.

5 Can not be used with shifting or tilting.

6 Manual shooting mode only.

7 Can be used with AF-S and AF-I lenses only (0 287). For information on the focus points available for

autofocus and electronic rangefinding, see page 287.

8 When focusing at minimum focus distance with AF 80­200mm f/2.8, AF 35­70mm f/2.8, AF 28­85mm

f/3.5­4.5 <New>, or AF 28­85mm f/3.5­4.5 lens at maximum zoom, in-focus indicator may be

displayed when image on matte screen in viewfinder is not in focus. Adjust focus manually until image

in viewfinder is in focus.

9 With maximum aperture of f/5.6 or faster.

10 Some lenses can not be used (see page 288).

n

285

11 Range of rotation for AI 80­200mm f/2.8 ED tripod mount is limited by camera body. Filters can not be exchanged while AI 200­400mm f/4 ED is mounted on camera.
12 If maximum aperture is specified using Non-CPU lens data (0 172), aperture value will be displayed in viewfinder and control panel.
13 Can be used only if lens focal length and maximum aperture are specified using Non-CPU lens data (0 172). Use spot or center-weighted metering if desired results are not achieved.
14 For improved precision, specify lens focal length and maximum aperture using Non-CPU lens data (0 172).
15 Can be used in manual mode M at shutter speeds slower than flash sync speed by one step or more. 16 Exposure determined by presetting lens aperture. In mode A, preset aperture using lens aperture ring
before performing AE lock and shifting lens. In mode M, preset aperture using lens aperture ring and determine exposure before shifting lens. 17 Exposure compensation required when used with AI 28­85mm f/3.5­4.5, AI 35­105mm f/3.5­4.5, AI 35­135mm f/3.5­4.5, or AF-S 80­200mm f/2.8D. See teleconverter manual for details. 18 With maximum effective aperture of f/5.6 or faster. 19 Requires PK-12 or PK-13 auto extension ring. PB-6D may be required depending on camera orientation. 20 Use preset aperture. In mode A, set aperture using focusing attachment before determining exposure and taking photograph. · PF-4 Reprocopy Outfit requires PA-4 Camera Holder. · Noise in the form of horizontal lines may appear in movies taken with the following lenses at ISO sensitivities of 6400 or higher; use manual focus or focus lock. - AF-S Zoom Nikkor 24­85mm f/3.5­4.5G (IF) - AF-S DX Zoom-Nikkor 18­70mm f/3.5­4.5G IF-ED
n
286

A Recognizing CPU and Type G and D Lenses
CPU lenses (particularly types G and D) are recommended, but note that IX-NIKKOR lenses can not be used. CPU lenses can be identified by the presence of CPU contacts, type G and D lenses by a letter on the lens barrel. Type G lenses are not equipped with a lens aperture ring.

CPU contacts

Aperture ring

CPU lens

Type G lens

Type D lens

A The AF-S/AF-I Teleconverter
The AF-S/AF-I teleconverter can be used with the following AF-S and AF-I lenses:

· AF-S NIKKOR 70­200mm f/2.8G ED VR II · AF-S 300mm f/4D ED

· AF-S VR 70­200mm f/2.8G ED

· AF-S NIKKOR 400mm f/2.8G ED VR

· AF-S 80­200mm f/2.8D ED

· AF-S 400mm f/2.8D ED II

· AF-S VR Micro-Nikkor 105mm f/2.8G IF-ED * · AF-S 400mm f/2.8D ED

· AF-S NIKKOR 200mm f/2G ED VR II

· AF-I 400mm f/2.8D ED

· AF-S VR 200mm f/2G ED

· AF-S NIKKOR 500mm f/4G ED VR

· AF-S NIKKOR 200­400mm f/4G ED VR II · AF-S 500mm f/4D ED II

· AF-S VR 200­400mm f/4G ED

· AF-S 500mm f/4D ED

· AF-S NIKKOR 300mm f/2.8G ED VR II

· AF-I 500mm f/4D ED

· AF-S VR 300mm f/2.8G ED

· AF-S NIKKOR 600mm f/4G ED VR

· AF-S 300mm f/2.8D ED II

· AF-S 600mm f/4D ED II

· AF-S 300mm f/2.8D ED

· AF-S 600mm f/4D ED

· AF-I 300mm f/2.8D ED

· AF-I 600mm f/4D ED

* Autofocus not supported.

A f/8 Autofocus Support

If the lens can be used with the AF-S/AF-I

TC-20E/

teleconverter and has a maximum aperture of f/4, TC-17E II

TC-20E II/

the apparent aperture will drop by two stops to f/8

TC-20E III

when the lens is used with a TC-20E/TC-20E II/

TC-20E III teleconverter, or by one-and-a-half stops to f/6.8 when the lens is used with a

TC-17E II. The focus points shown in the illustrations can be used for autofocus and

electronic rangefinding when an AF-S teleconverter is attached. When used with TC-20E/

TC-20E II/TC-20E III, focus data for focus points other than the center focus point are obtained

from line sensors. Single point AF is used when 3D-tracking or auto-area AF is selected for

AF-area mode (0 99); at maximum or combined apertures slower than f/5.6, the camera

may not be able to focus on dark or low-contrast subjects.

n
287

A Lens f-number
The f-number given in lens names is the maximum aperture of the lens.
A Compatible Non-CPU Lenses
When using non-CPU lenses and accessories, rotate the camera mode dial to A or M and set aperture using the lens aperture ring. In other modes, the shutter-release is disabled. NonCPU lens data (0 172) can be used to enable many of the features available with CPU lenses, including color matrix metering; if no data are provided, center-weighted metering will be used in place of color matrix metering, while if the maximum aperture is not provided, the camera aperture display will show the number of stops from maximum aperture and the actual aperture value must be read off the lens aperture ring.

D Incompatible Accessories and Non-CPU Lenses
The following can NOT be used with the D600:

· TC-16AS AF teleconverter

· AF lenses for the F3AF (AF 80mm f/2.8, AF

· Non-AI lenses

200mm f/3.5 ED, AF Teleconverter TC-16)

· Lenses that require the AU-1 focusing unit · PC 28mm f/4 (serial number 180900 or

(400mm f/4.5, 600mm f/5.6, 800mm f/8,

earlier)

1200mm f/11)

· PC 35mm f/2.8 (serial numbers 851001­

· Fisheye (6mm f/5.6, 7.5mm f/5.6, 8mm f/8, 906200)

OP 10mm f/5.6)

· PC 35mm f/3.5 (old type)

· 2.1cm f/4

· Reflex 1000mm f/6.3 (old type)

· Extension Ring K2

· Reflex 1000mm f/11 (serial numbers

· 180­600mm f/8 ED (serial numbers

142361­143000)

174041­174180)

· Reflex 2000mm f/11 (serial numbers

· 360­1200mm f/11 ED (serial numbers

200111­200310)

174031­174127)

· 200­600mm f/9.5 (serial numbers 280001­

300490)

A The Built-in Flash
The built-in flash can be used with CPU lenses with focal lengths of 24 mm (16 mm in DX format) to 300 mm, although in some cases the flash may be unable to entirely light the subject at some ranges or focal lengths due to shadows cast by the lens, while lenses that block the subject's view of the red-eye reduction lamp may interfere with red-eye reduction. Remove lens hoods to prevent shadows. The flash has a minimum range of 0.6 m (2 ft) and can not be used in the macro range of macro zoom lenses. The flash may be unable to light the entire subject with the following lenses at ranges less than those given below:

Lens AF-S DX NIKKOR 10­24mm f/3.5­4.5G ED
AF-S DX Zoom-Nikkor 12­24mm f/4G IF-ED

Zoom position 18­24 mm
18 mm 20­24 mm

Minimum distance without vignetting No vignetting 1.0 m/3 ft 3 in. No vignetting

DX

n
288

FX

DX

Lens AF-S DX Zoom-Nikkor 17­55mm f/2.8G IF-ED AF-S DX NIKKOR 18­200mm f/3.5­5.6G ED VR II AF-S DX VR Zoom-Nikkor 18­200mm f/3.5­5.6G IF-ED AF-S DX NIKKOR 18­300mm f/3.5­5.6G ED VR AF-S NIKKOR 16­35mm f/4G ED VR AF-S Zoom-Nikkor 17­35mm f/2.8D IF-ED
AF Zoom-Nikkor 18­35mm f/3.5­4.5D IF-ED
AF Zoom-Nikkor 20­35mm f/2.8D IF
AF-S NIKKOR 24mm f/1.4G ED AF-S NIKKOR 24­70mm f/2.8G ED AF-S VR Zoom-Nikkor 24­120mm f/3.5­5.6G IF-ED
AF-S NIKKOR 24­120mm f/4G ED VR
AF-S Zoom-Nikkor 28­70mm f/2.8D IF-ED
AF-S NIKKOR 28­300mm f/3.5­5.6G ED VR
PC-E NIKKOR 24mm f/3.5D ED * * When not shifted or tilted.

Zoom position 20 mm
24­55 mm
18 mm
24­200 mm
28 mm 50­300 mm
35 mm 28 mm 35 mm 24 mm 28­35 mm 24 mm 28 mm 35 mm 24 mm 35 mm 50­70 mm 24 mm 35­120 mm 24 mm 28 mm 50­120 mm 28 mm 50­70 mm 28 mm 35 mm 50­300 mm 24 mm

Minimum distance without vignetting 2.0 m/6 ft 7 in. 1.0 m/3 ft 3 in.
1.0 m/3 ft 3 in.
No vignetting
1.0 m/3 ft 3 in. No vignetting 1.5 m/4 ft 11 in. 1.5 m/4 ft 11 in. No vignetting 1.0 m/3 ft 3 in. No vignetting 1.5 m/4 ft 11 in. 1.0 m/3 ft 3 in. No vignetting 1.0 m/3 ft 3 in. 1.5 m/4 ft 11 in. No vignetting 1.0 m/3 ft 3 in. No vignetting 2.0 m/6 ft 7 in. 1.0 m/3 ft 3 in. No vignetting 1.0 m/3 ft 3 in. No vignetting 1.5 m/4 ft 11 in. 1.0 m/3 ft 3 in. No vignetting 1.5 m/4 ft 11 in.

When used with the AF-S NIKKOR 14­24mm f/2.8G ED, the flash will be unable to light the entire subject at all ranges.
The built-in flash can also be used with AI-S, AI-, AI-modified NIKKOR, Nikon Series E and nonCPU lenses with a focal length of 24­300mm. AI 50­300mm f/4.5, modified AI 50­300mm f/4.5, AI-S 50­300mm f/4.5 ED, and AI 50­300mm f/4.5 ED lenses must be used at a zoom position of 70 mm or above. With AI-S and AI 25­50mm f/4 ED lenses, the ranges above which vignetting will not occur are: 2.0 m (6 ft 7 in.) at a zoom position of 25 mm and 1.0 m (3 ft 3 in.) at a zoom position of 28 mm; vignetting will not occur at zoom positions of 35 mm or above.

n
289

D AF-Assist Illumination

AF-assist illumination is available with lenses with focal lengths of 24­200 mm. It can not

however be used to assist the focus operation with the following lenses:

· AF-S NIKKOR 200mm f/2G ED VR II

· AF-S NIKKOR 200­400mm f/4G ED VR II

· AF-S VR Zoom-Nikkor 200­400mm f/4G · AF-S NIKKOR 300mm f/2.8G ED VR II

IF-ED

At ranges under 0.7 m (2 ft 4 in.), the following lenses may block the AF-assist illuminator and

interfere with autofocus when lighting is poor:

· AF-S NIKKOR 16­35mm f/4G ED VR

· AF Zoom Nikkor 24­120mm f/3.5­5.6D (IF)

· AF-S Zoom-Nikkor 17­35mm f/2.8D IF-ED · AF-S NIKKOR 24­120mm f/4G ED VR

· AF-S DX Zoom-Nikkor 17­55mm f/2.8G IF-ED · AF-S NIKKOR 28­300mm f/3.5­5.6G ED VR

· AF-S DX VR Zoom-Nikkor 18­200mm

· AF-S NIKKOR 35mm f/1.4G

f/3.5­5.6G IF-ED

· AF Zoom Micro Nikkor ED 70­180mm

· AF Zoom-Nikkor 20­35mm f/2.8D IF

f/4.5­5.6D

· AF Zoom-Nikkor 24­85mm f/2.8­4D IF · AF-S VR Micro-Nikkor 105mm f/2.8G IF-ED

· AF-S NIKKOR 24­85mm f/3.5­4.5G ED VR

At ranges under 1.0 m (3 ft 3 in.), the following lenses may block the AF-assist illuminator and

interfere with autofocus when lighting is poor:

· AF-S DX NIKKOR 18­200mm f/3.5­5.6G ED · AF-S Zoom-Nikkor 28­70mm f/2.8D IF-ED

VR II

· AF Micro-Nikkor 200mm f/4D IF-ED

· AF-S NIKKOR 24­70mm f/2.8G ED

· AF-S VR Zoom-Nikkor 24­120mm f/3.5­5.6G

IF-ED

At ranges under 1.5 m (4 ft 11 in.), the following lenses may block the AF-assist illuminator

and interfere with autofocus when lighting is poor:

· AF-S NIKKOR 14­24mm f/2.8G ED

· AF-S NIKKOR 70­200mm f/2.8G ED VR II

· AF-S DX NIKKOR 18­300mm f/3.5­5.6G ED VR · AF Zoom-Nikkor 80­200mm f/2.8D ED

· AF-S DX NIKKOR 55­300mm f/4.5­5.6G ED VR · AF-S Zoom-Nikkor 80­200mm f/2.8D IF-ED

· AF-S VR Zoom-Nikkor 70­200mm f/2.8G

IF-ED

n
290

A Calculating Angle of View
The D600 can be used with Nikon lenses for 35mm (135) format cameras. If Auto DX crop is on (0 90) and a 35mm format lens is attached, the angle of view will be the same as a frame of 35mm film (35.9 × 24.0 mm); if a DX lens is attached, the angle of view will automatically be adjusted to 23.5 × 15.7 mm (DX format).
If a 35 mm format lens is attached, the angle of view can be reduced by 1.5 × by turning Auto DX crop off and selecting DX (24×16).
FX (36×24) picture size (35.9 × 24.0 mm, equivalent to 35mm format camera)

Lens

Picture diagonal

DX (24×16) picture size (23.5 × 15.7 mm, equivalent to DX format camera)

Angle of view (FX (36×24); 35mm format) Angle of view (DX (24×16); DX format)

The DX (24×16) angle of view is about 1.5 times smaller than the 35mm format angle of view. To calculate the focal length of lenses in 35mm format when DX (24×16) is selected, multiply the focal length of the lens by about 1.5 (for example, the effective focal length of a 50mm lens in 35mm format would be 75 mm when DX (24×16) is selected).

n
291

Optional Flash Units (Speedlights)
The camera supports the Nikon Creative Lighting System (CLS) and can be used with CLS-compatible flash units. Optional flash units can be attached directly to the camera accessory shoe as described below. The accessory shoe is equipped with a safety lock for flash units with a locking pin.
1 Remove the accessory shoe cover.
2 Mount the flash unit on the accessory shoe.
See the manual provided with the flash unit for details. The built-in flash will not fire when an optional flash unit is attached.
A The AS-15 Sync Terminal Adapter
When the AS-15 sync terminal adapter (available separately) is mounted on the camera accessory shoe, flash accessories can be connected via a sync terminal.
D Use Only Nikon Flash Accessories
Use only Nikon flash units. Negative voltages or voltages over 250 V applied to the accessory
n shoe could not only prevent normal operation, but damage the sync circuitry of the camera or flash. Before using a Nikon flash unit not listed in this section, contact a Nikon-authorized service representative for more information.
292

The Nikon Creative Lighting System (CLS)

Nikon's advanced Creative Lighting System (CLS) offers improved communication between the camera and compatible flash units for improved flash photography.

 CLS-Compatible Flash Units

The camera can be used with the following CLS-compatible flash units:

· The SB-910, SB-900, SB-800, SB-700, SB-600, SB-400, and SB-R200:

Feature

Flash unit SB-910 1

SB-900 1

SB-800

SB-700 1

SB-600

SB-400 2 SB-R200 3

Guide No. 4 ISO 100 ISO 200

34/111 34/111 38/125 28/92 30/98 48/157 48/157 53/174 39/128 42/138

21/69 30/98

10/33 14/46

1 If a color filter is attached to the SB-910, SB-900, or SB-700 when v or N (flash) is selected for white

balance, the camera will automatically detect the filter and adjust white balance appropriately.

2 Wireless flash control is not available with the SB-400.

3 Controlled remotely with built-in flash in commander mode or using optional SB-910, SB-900,

SB-800, or SB-700 flash unit or SU-800 wireless Speedlight commander.

4 m/ft, 20 °C (68 °F), SB-910, SB-900, SB-800, SB-700, and SB-600 at 35 mm zoom head position; SB-910,

SB-900, and SB-700 with standard illumination.

· SU-800 Wireless Speedlight Commander: When mounted on a CLS-compatible camera, the SU-800 can be used as a commander for remote SB-910, SB-900, SB-800, SB-700, SB-600, or SB-R200 flash units in up to three groups. The SU-800 itself is not equipped with a flash.

A Guide Number
To calculate the range of the flash at full power, divide the Guide Number by the aperture. For example, at ISO 100 the SB-800 has a Guide Number of 38 m or 125 ft (35 mm zoom head
n position); its range at an aperture of f/5.6 is 38÷5.6 or about 6.8 meters (or in feet,
125÷5.6=approximately 23 ft 7 in.). For each twofold increase in ISO sensitivity, multiply the Guide Number by the square root of two (approximately 1.4).
293

The following features are available with CLS-compatible flash units:

Flash unit

Advanced Wireless Lighting

Master/commander

Remote

SB-910

SB-910

SB-910

Flash mode/feature

SB-900

SB-900

SB-900 SB-700

SB-800 SB-700 SB-600 SB-400 SB-800 SB-700 SU-800 1 SB-800 SB-600 SB-R200

i-TTL i-TTL balanced fill-flash for digital SLR  2  3  2  3      

AA Auto aperture

4 -- -- -- 5 -- 5 5 -- --

A Non-TTL auto

4 -- -- -- 5 -- -- 5 -- --

GN Distance-priority manual

 -------- -- ---- --

M Manual

   6      

RPT Repeating flash

------  --    --

Auto FP High-Speed Sync 7

--    

FV lock

   

AF-assist for multi-area AF 8

  --    ---- --

Flash Color Information Communication

      -- ---- --

REAR Rear-curtain sync

   

Y Red-eye reduction

      -- ---- --

Power zoom

  --   -- ---- --

1 Only available when SU-800 is used to control other flash units. The SU-800 itself is not equipped with a

flash.

2 Standard i-TTL flash for digital SLR is used with spot metering or when selected with flash unit.

3 Standard i-TTL flash for digital SLR is used with spot metering.

4 Selected with flash unit.

5 Auto aperture (AA) is used regardless of mode selected with flash unit.

6 Can be selected with camera.

7 Select 1/250 s (Auto FP) or 1/200 s (Auto FP) for Custom Setting e1 (Flash sync speed, 0 234).

8 CPU lens required.

A Auto Aperture/Non-TTL Auto
n Unless the focal length and maximum aperture are specified using the Non-CPU lens data option in the setup menu, choosing auto aperture (AA) when a non-CPU lens is attached automatically selects non-TTL auto (A).
294

 Other Flash Units
The following flash units can be used in non-TTL auto and manual modes.

Flash unit SB-80DX, SB-28DX, SB-28,

SB-30, SB-27 2, SB-22S, SB-23, SB-29 3,

Flash mode

SB-26, SB-25, SB-24

SB-50DX 1 SB-22, SB-20, SB-16B, SB-15 SB-21B 3, SB-29S 3

A Non-TTL auto



--



--

M Manual









G Repeating flash



--

--

--

REAR Rear-curtain sync 4









1 Select mode P, S, A, or M, lower built-in flash, and use optional flash unit only.

2 Flash mode is automatically set to TTL and shutter-release is disabled. Set flash unit to A (non-TTL auto

flash).

3 Autofocus is available with AF-S VR Micro-Nikkor 105mm f/2.8G IF-ED and AF-S Micro NIKKOR 60mm

f/2.8G ED lenses only.

4 Available when camera is used to select flash mode.

A Flash Control Mode
The information display shows the flash control mode for optional flash units attached to the camera accessory shoe as follows:

Flash sync

Auto FP (0 234)

i-TTL

Auto aperture (AA)

Non-TTL auto flash (A)

Distance-priority manual (GN)

Manual

Repeating flash Advanced wireless lighting

--
n

295

D Notes on Optional Flash Units
Refer to the Speedlight manual for detailed instructions. If the flash unit supports CLS, refer to the section on CLS-compatible digital SLR cameras. The D600 is not included in the "digital SLR" category in the SB-80DX, SB-28DX, and SB-50DX manuals.

If an optional flash unit is attached in shooting modes other than j, the flash will fire with every shot, even in modes in which the built-in flash can not be used. Note that optional flash units can not be used in movie live view (0 57) or while HDR is in effect (0 139).

i-TTL flash control can be used at ISO sensitivities between 100 and 6400. At values over 6400, the desired results may not be achieved at some ranges or aperture settings. If the flash-ready indicator flashes for about three seconds after a photograph is taken, the flash has fired at full power and the photograph may be underexposed.

When an SC-series 17, 28, or 29 sync cable is used for off-camera flash photography, correct exposure may not be achieved in i-TTL mode. We recommend that you select standard i-TTL flash control. Take a test shot and view the results in the monitor.

In i-TTL, use the flash panel or bounce adapter provided with the flash unit. Do not use other panels such as diffusion panels, as this may produce incorrect exposure.

The SB-910, SB-900, SB-800, SB-700, SB-600, and SB-400 provide red-eye reduction, while the

SB-910, SB-900, SB-800, SB-700, SB-600, and SU-800 provide AF-assist illumination with the

following restrictions:

· SB-910 and SB-900: AF-assist illumination is available

with 17­135 mm AF lenses, however, autofocus is

available only with the focus points shown at

17­19 mm 20­105 mm 106­135 mm

right.

· SB-800, SB-600, and SU-800: AF-assist illumination is

available with 24­105 mm AF lenses, however, autofocus is available only with the focus points 24­34 mm 35­49 mm 50­105 mm

shown at right.

· SB-700: AF-assist illumination is available with 24­

135 mm AF lenses, however, autofocus is available only with the focus points shown at

24­135 mm

right.

In mode P, the maximum aperture (minimum f-number) is limited according to ISO sensitivity, as shown below:

Maximum aperture at ISO equivalent of:

100

200

400

800

1600

3200

6400

4

5

5.6

7.1

8

10

11

If the maximum aperture of the lens is smaller than given above, the maximum value for

aperture will be the maximum aperture of the lens.

n
296

Other Accessories

At the time of writing, the following accessories were available for the D600.

· Rechargeable Li-ion Battery EN-EL15 (0 21, 23): Additional EN-EL15 batteries are

available from local retailers and Nikon-authorized service representatives.

· Battery Charger MH-25 (0 21): Recharge EN-EL15 batteries.

· Multi-Power Battery Pack MB-D14: The MB-D14 is equipped with a shutter-release

button, A AE/AF lock button, multi selector, and main- and sub-command

dials for improved operation when taking photographs in portrait (tall)

Power

orientation. When attaching the MB-D14, remove the camera MB-D14 contact

sources

cover.

· Power Connector EP-5B, AC Adapter EH-5b: These accessories can be used to power

the camera for extended periods (EH-5a and EH-5 AC adapters can also be

used). The EP-5B is required to connect the camera to the EH-5b; see page 299

for details. Note that when the camera is used with an MB-D14, the EP-5B must

be inserted into the MB-D14, not the camera. Do not attempt to use the

camera with power connectors inserted into both the camera and MB-D14.

· Filters intended for special-effects photography may interfere with autofocus

or the electronic rangefinder.

· The D600 can not be used with linear polarizing filters. Use C-PL or C-PL II

circular polarizing filters instead.

Filters

· Use NC filters to protect the lens. · To prevent ghosting, use of a filter is not recommended when the subject is

framed against a bright light, or when a bright light source is in the frame.

· Center-weighted metering is recommended with filters with exposure factors

(filter factors) over 1 × (Y44, Y48, Y52, O56, R60, X0, X1, C-PL, ND2S, ND4, ND4S,

ND8, ND8S, ND400, A2, A12, B2, B8, B12). See the filter manual for details.

· DK-20C Eyepiece Correction Lenses: Lenses are available with diopters of ­5, ­4, ­3,

­2, 0, +0.5, +1, +2, and +3 m­1 when the camera diopter adjustment control is

in the neutral position (­1 m­1). Use eyepiece correction lenses only if the

desired focus can not be achieved with the built in diopter adjustment control

(­3 to +1 m­1). Test eyepiece correction lenses before purchase to ensure that

the desired focus can be achieved. The rubber eyecup can not be used with

eyepiece correction lenses.

Viewfinder eyepiece accessories

· Magnifying Eyepiece DK-21M: The DK-21M magnifies the view through the viewfinder by approximately 1.17 × (50 mm f/1.4 lens at infinity; ­1.0 m­1) for greater precision when framing.
· Magnifier DG-2: The DG-2 magnifies the scene displayed in the center of the

viewfinder for greater precision during focusing. Eyepiece adapter required

(available separately).

· Eyepiece Adapter DK-22: The DK-22 is used when attaching the DG-2 magnifier.

· Right-Angle Viewing Attachment DR-6: The DR-6 attaches at a right angle to the

viewfinder eyepiece, allowing the image in the viewfinder to be viewed at

right angles to the lens (for example, from directly above when the camera is

horizontal).
n

297

Software Body cap

· Capture NX 2: A complete photo editing package with such advanced editing features as selection control points and an auto retouch brush.
· Camera Control Pro 2: Control the camera remotely from a computer to record movies and photographs and save photographs directly to the computer hard disk.
Note: Use the latest versions of Nikon software; see the websites listed on page xxiii for the latest information on supported operating systems. At default settings, Nikon Message Center 2 will periodically check for updates to Nikon software and firmware while you are logged in to an account on the computer and the computer is connected to the Internet. A message is automatically displayed when an update is found. Body Cap BF-1B/Body Cap BF-1A: The body cap keeps the mirror, viewfinder screen, and low-pass filter free of dust when a lens is not in place. Wireless Remote Control ML-L3: The ML-L3 uses a 3 V CR2025 battery.

Remote controls

Pressing the battery-chamber latch to the right (q), insert a fingernail into the gap and open the battery chamber (w). Ensure that the battery is inserted in the correct orientation (r).

Accessory terminal accessories

The D600 is equipped with an accessory terminal for MC-DC2 remote cords (0 79) and GP-1 GPS units (0 175), which connect with the 4 mark on the connector aligned with the 2 next to the accessory terminal (close the camera connector cover when the terminal is not in
use).

Microphones Stereo Microphone ME-1 (0 61)

Wireless mobile adapters

Wireless Mobile Adapter WU-1b: Supports two-way communication between the camera and smart devices running the Wireless Mobile Adapter Utility.

n
298

Attaching a Power Connector and AC Adapter
Turn the camera off before attaching an optional power connector and AC adapter.
1 Ready the camera.
Open the battery-chamber (q) and power connector (w) covers.
2 Insert the EP-5B power connector.
Be sure to insert the connector in the orientation shown, using the connector to keep the orange battery latch pressed to one side. The latch locks the connector in place when the connector is fully inserted.
3 Close the battery-chamber cover.
Position the power connector cable so that it passes through the power connector slot and close the battery-chamber cover.
4 Connect the AC adapter.
Connect the AC adapter power cable to the AC socket on AC adapter (e) and the EP-5B power cable to the DC socket (r). A V icon is displayed in the monitor when the camera is powered by the AC adapter and power connector.
n
299

Caring for the Camera

Storage
When the camera will not be used for an extended period, replace the monitor cover, remove the battery, and store the battery in a cool, dry area with the terminal cover in place. To prevent mold or mildew, store the camera in a dry, well-ventilated area. Do not store your camera with naphtha or camphor moth balls or in locations that: · are poorly ventilated or subject to humidities of over 60% · are next to equipment that produces strong electromagnetic fields, such as
televisions or radios · are exposed to temperatures above 50 °C (122 °F) or below ­10 °C (14 °F)

Cleaning

Use a blower to remove dust and lint, then wipe gently with a soft, dry cloth. After

Camera using the camera at the beach or seaside, wipe off sand or salt with a cloth lightly

body

dampened in distilled water and dry thoroughly. Important: Dust or other foreign

matter inside the camera may cause damage not covered under warranty.

Lens, mirror, and viewfinder

These glass elements are easily damaged. Remove dust and lint with a blower. If using an aerosol blower, keep the can vertical to prevent the discharge of liquid. To remove fingerprints and other stains, apply a small amount of lens cleaner to a soft cloth and clean with care.

Remove dust and lint with a blower. When removing fingerprints and other stains,

Monitor wipe the surface lightly with a soft cloth or chamois leather. Do not apply pressure,

as this could result in damage or malfunction.

Do not use alcohol, thinner, or other volatile chemicals.

D Servicing the Camera and Accessories
The camera is a precision device and requires regular servicing. Nikon recommends that the camera be inspected by the original retailer or Nikon-authorized service representative once every one to two years, and that it be serviced once every three to five years (note that fees apply to these services). Frequent inspection and servicing are particularly recommended if
n the camera is used professionally. Any accessories regularly used with the camera, such as lenses or optional Speedlights, should be included when the camera is inspected or serviced.
300

The Low-Pass Filter
The image sensor that acts as the camera's picture element is fitted with a low-pass filter to prevent moiré. If you suspect that dirt or dust on the filter is appearing in photographs, you can clean the filter using the Clean image sensor option in the setup menu. The filter can be cleaned at any time using the Clean now option, or cleaning can be performed automatically when the camera is turned on or off.
 "Clean Now"
1 Select Clean image sensor in the setup
menu.
Press the G button to display the menus. Highlight Clean image sensor in the setup menu and press 2.
G button
2 Select Clean now.
The camera will check the image sensor and then begin cleaning. This process takes about 10 seconds; during this time, P flashes in the control panel and other operations can not be performed. Do not remove or disconnect the power source until cleaning is complete and P is no longer displayed.

A Place the Camera Base Down
Image sensor cleaning is most effective when the camera is placed base down as shown at right.

n
301

 "Clean at Startup/Shutdown"
Choose from the following options:

Option

Description

5 Clean at startup

The image sensor is automatically cleaned each time the camera is turned on.

6

Clean at shutdown

The image sensor is automatically cleaned during shutdown each time the camera is turned off.

7

Clean at startup & shutdown

The image sensor is cleaned automatically at startup and at shutdown.

Cleaning off Automatic image sensor cleaning off.

1 Select Clean at startup/shutdown.
Display the Clean image sensor menu as described in Step 2 on the previous page. Highlight Clean at startup/shutdown and press 2.

2 Select an option.
Highlight an option and press J.

D Image Sensor Cleaning
Using camera controls during startup interrupts image sensor cleaning. Image sensor cleaning may not be performed at startup if the flash is charging.
Cleaning is performed by vibrating the low-pass filter. If dust can not be fully removed using the options in the Clean image sensor menu, clean the image sensor manually (0 303) or consult a Nikon-authorized service representative.
n If image sensor cleaning is performed several times in succession, image sensor cleaning may be temporarily disabled to protect the camera's internal circuitry. Cleaning can be performed again after a short wait.
302

 Manual Cleaning
If foreign matter can not be removed from the low-pass filter using the Clean image sensor option in the setup menu (0 301), the filter can be cleaned manually as described below. Note, however, that the filter is extremely delicate and easily damaged. Nikon recommends that the filter be cleaned only by Nikon-authorized service personnel.
1 Charge the battery or connect an AC adapter.
A reliable power source is required when inspecting or cleaning the low-pass filter. Turn the camera off and insert a fully-charged EN-EL15 battery or connect an optional EP-5B power connector and EH-5b AC adapter. The Lock mirror up for cleaning option is only available in the setup menu at battery levels over J.
2 Remove the lens.
Turn the camera off and remove the lens.
3 Select Lock mirror up for cleaning.
Turn the camera on and press the G button to display the menus. Highlight Lock mirror up for cleaning in the setup menu and press 2.
G button
4 Press J.
The message shown at right will be displayed in the monitor and a row of dashes will appear in the control panel and viewfinder. To restore normal operation without inspecting the low-pass filter, turn the camera off.
n
303

5 Raise the mirror.
Press the shutter-release button all the way down. The mirror will be raised and the shutter curtain will open, revealing the lowpass filter. The display in the viewfinder will turn off and the row of dashes in the control panel will flash.
6 Examine the low-pass filter.
Holding the camera so that light falls on the low-pass filter, examine the filter for dust or lint. If no foreign objects are present, proceed to Step 8.
7 Clean the filter.
Remove any dust and lint from the filter with a blower. Do not use a blower-brush, as the bristles could damage the filter. Dirt that can not be removed with a blower can only be removed by Nikon-authorized service personnel. Under no circumstances should you touch or wipe the filter.
8 Turn the camera off.
The mirror will return to the down position and the shutter curtain will close. Replace the lens or body cap.
n
304

A Use a Reliable Power Source
The shutter curtain is delicate and easily damaged. If the camera powers off while the mirror is raised, the curtain will close automatically. To prevent damage to the curtain, observe the following precautions: · Do not turn the camera off or remove or disconnect the power source while the mirror is
raised. · If the battery runs low while the mirror is raised, a beep will sound and the self-timer lamp
will flash to warn that the shutter curtain will close and the mirror will be lowered after about two minutes. End cleaning or inspection immediately.
D Foreign Matter on the Low-Pass Filter
Nikon takes every possible precaution to prevent foreign matter from coming into contact with the low-pass filter during production and shipping. The D600, however, is designed to be used with interchangeable lenses, and foreign matter may enter the camera when lenses are removed or exchanged. Once inside the camera, this foreign matter may adhere to the low-pass filter, where it may appear in photographs taken under certain conditions. To protect the camera when no lens is in place, be sure to replace the body cap provided with the camera, being careful to first remove all dust and other foreign matter that may be adhering to the body cap. Avoid exchanging lenses in dusty environments. Should foreign matter find its way onto the low-pass filter, clean the filter as described above, or have the filter cleaned by authorized Nikon service personnel. Photographs affected by the presence of foreign matter on the filter can be retouched using Capture NX 2 (available separately; 0 298) or the clean image options available in some third-party imaging applications.
n
305

Caring for the Camera and Battery: Cautions
Do not drop: The product may malfunction if subjected to strong shocks or vibration.
Keep dry: This product is not waterproof, and may malfunction if immersed in water or exposed to high levels of humidity. Rusting of the internal mechanism can cause irreparable damage.
Avoid sudden changes in temperature: Sudden changes in temperature, such as those that occur when entering or leaving a heated building on a cold day, can cause condensation inside the device. To prevent condensation, place the device in a carrying case or plastic bag before exposing it to sudden changes in temperature.
Keep away from strong magnetic fields: Do not use or store this device in the vicinity of equipment that generates strong electromagnetic radiation or magnetic fields. Strong static charges or the magnetic fields produced by equipment such as radio transmitters could interfere with the monitor, damage data stored on the memory card, or affect the product's internal circuitry.
Do not leave the lens pointed at the sun: Do not leave the lens pointed at the sun or other strong light source for an extended period. Intense light may cause the image sensor to deteriorate or produce a white blur effect in photographs.
Turn the product off before removing or disconnecting the power source: Do not unplug the product or remove the battery while the product is on or while images are being recorded or deleted. Forcibly cutting power in these circumstances could result in loss of data or in damage to product memory or internal circuitry. To prevent an accidental interruption of power, avoid carrying the product from one location to another while the AC adapter is connected.
Cleaning: When cleaning the camera body, use a blower to gently remove dust and lint, then wipe gently with a soft, dry cloth. After using the camera at the beach or seaside, wipe off any sand or salt using a cloth lightly dampened in pure water and then dry the camera thoroughly. In rare instances, static electricity may cause LCDs to light up or go dark. This does not indicate a malfunction, and the display will soon return to normal.
The lens and mirror are easily damaged. Dust and lint should be gently removed with a blower. When using an aerosol blower, keep the can vertical to prevent discharge of liquid. To remove fingerprints and other stains from the lens, apply a small amount of lens cleaner to a soft cloth and wipe the lens carefully.
See "The Low-Pass Filter" (0 301, 303) for information on cleaning the low-pass filter.
Lens contacts: Keep the lens contacts clean.
Do not touch the shutter curtain: The shutter curtain is extremely thin and easily damaged. Under no circumstances should you exert pressure on the curtain, poke it with cleaning tools, or subject it to powerful air currents from a blower. These actions could scratch, deform, or tear the curtain.
n
306

Storage: To prevent mold or mildew, store the camera in a dry, well-ventilated area. If you are using an AC adapter, unplug the adapter to prevent fire. If the product will not be used for an extended period, remove the battery to prevent leakage and store the camera in a plastic bag containing a desiccant. Do not, however, store the camera case in a plastic bag, as this may cause the material to deteriorate. Note that desiccant gradually loses its capacity to absorb moisture and should be replaced at regular intervals.
To prevent mold or mildew, take the camera out of storage at least once a month. Turn the camera on and release the shutter a few times before putting it away.
Store the battery in a cool, dry place. Replace the terminal cover before putting the battery away.
Notes on the monitor: The monitor is constructed with extremely high precision; at least 99.99% of pixels are effective, with no more than 0.01% being missing or defective. Hence while these displays may contain pixels that are always lit (white, red, blue, or green) or always off (black), this is not a malfunction and has no effect on images recorded with the device.
Images in the monitor may be difficult to see in a bright light.
Do not apply pressure to the monitor, as this could cause damage or malfunction. Dust or lint on the monitor can be removed with a blower. Stains can be removed by wiping lightly with a soft cloth or chamois leather. Should the monitor break, care should be taken to avoid injury from broken glass and to prevent liquid crystal from the monitor touching the skin or entering the eyes and mouth.
Replace the monitor cover when transporting the camera or leaving it unattended.
Batteries: Batteries may leak or explode if improperly handled. Observe the following precautions when handling batteries: · Use only batteries approved for use in this equipment. · Do not expose the battery to flame or excessive heat. · Keep the battery terminals clean. · Turn the product off before replacing the battery. · Remove the battery from the camera or charger when not in use and replace the terminal
cover. These devices draw minute amounts of charge even when off and could draw the battery down to the point that it will no longer function. If the battery will not be used for some time, insert it in the camera and run it flat before removing it and storing it in a location with an ambient temperature of 15 to 25 °C (59 to 77 °F; avoid hot or extremely cold locations). Repeat this process at least once every six months. · Turning the camera on or off repeatedly when the battery is fully discharged will shorten battery life. Batteries that have been fully discharged must be charged before use. · The internal temperature of the battery may rise while the battery is in use. Attempting to charge the battery while the internal temperature is elevated will impair battery performance, and the battery may not charge or charge only partially. Wait for the battery to cool before charging.
n
307

· Continuing to charge the battery after it is fully charged can impair battery performance. · A marked drop in the time a fully charged battery retains its charge when used at room
temperature indicates that it requires replacement. Purchase a new EN-EL15 battery. · Charge the battery before use. When taking photographs on important occasions, ready a
spare EN-EL15 battery and keep it fully charged. Depending on your location, it may be difficult to purchase replacement batteries on short notice. Note that on cold days, the capacity of batteries tends to decrease. Be sure the battery is fully charged before taking photographs outside in cold weather. Keep a spare battery in a warm place and exchange the two as necessary. Once warmed, a cold battery may recover some of its charge. · Used batteries are a valuable resource; recycle in accord with local regulations.
n
308

Available Settings

The following table lists the settings that can be adjusted in each mode.

Shooting menu

k, p, l, m,

n, o, r, t,

x, y, 1, 2,

i j P S, A, M s, 0 u, v w z 3

Storage folder

      

File naming 1

      

Role played by card in Slot 2 1

      

Image quality 1, 2

      

Image size 1, 2

      

Image area 1

      

JPEG compression 1

      

NEF (RAW) recording 1

      

White balance 1, 2

----  -- -- -- -- --

Set Picture Control 1

----  -- -- -- -- --

Auto distortion control 1

      

Color space 1

      

Active D-Lighting 1

-- 3 -- 3 2  2 -- 3 -- 3 -- 3 -- 3 --

HDR (high dynamic range) 1, 2

----  -- -- -- -- --

Vignette control 1

      

Long exposure NR 1

      

High ISO NR 1

      

ISO sensitivity settings 1, 2

4 4   4 4 4 4 4

Remote control mode 1

      

Multiple exposure 1, 2

----  -- -- -- -- --

Interval timer shooting 1

      

Time-lapse photography 1

      

Movie settings 1

      

Autofocus mode (viewfinder)  5  5    5  5  5  5  5

AF-area mode (viewfinder)

5 5   5 5 5 5 5

AF mode (Live view/movie)

5 5   5 5 5 5 5

AF-area mode (Live view/movie)  5  5    5  5  5  5  5

AE lock hold

      

Flexible program

---- -- -- -- -- -- --

Metering

----  -- -- -- -- --

Exposure compensation

----  -- -- -- -- --

Bracketing

----  -- -- -- -- --

Flash mode

5 --   5 -- 5 -- --

Flash compensation

----  -- -- -- -- --

FV lock

--   --  -- --

Other settings 2

n
309

Custom Settings 6

k, p, l, m,

n, o, r, t,

x, y, 1, 2,

i j P S, A, M s, 0 u, v w z 3

a1: AF-C priority selection

      

a2: AF-S priority selection

      

a3: Focus tracking with lock-on         

a4: AF point illumination

      

a5: Focus point wrap-around

      

a6: Number of focus points

      

a7: Built-in AF-assist illuminator      -- --  

b1: ISO sensitivity step value

      

b2: EV steps for exposure cntrl         

b3: Easy exposure compensation -- --   -- -- -- -- --

b4: Center-weighted area

----  -- -- -- -- --

b5: Fine-tune optimal exposure         

c1: Shutter-release button AE-L         

c2: Standby timer

      

c3: Self-timer

      

c4: Monitor off delay

      

c5: Remote on duration

      

d1: Beep

      

d2: Viewfinder grid display

      

d3: ISO display and adjustment         

d4: Screen tips

      

d5: CL mode shooting speed

      

d6: Max. continuous release

      

d7: File number sequence

      

d8: Information display

      

d9: LCD illumination

      

d10: Exposure delay mode 2

      

d11: Flash warning

----  -- -- -- -- --

d12: MB-D14 battery type

      

d13: Battery order

      

n
310

e1: Flash sync speed

ij 

e2: Flash shutter speed

----

e3: Flash cntrl for built-in flash/ Optional flash

----

e4: Exposure comp. for flash

----

e5: Modeling flash

----

e6: Auto bracketing set

----

e7: Bracketing order

----

Custom Settings 6

f1: OK button (shooting mode)  

f2: Assign Fn button



f3: Assign preview button



f4: Assign AE-L/AF-L button



f5: Customize command dials  

f6: Release button to use dial



f7: Slot empty release lock



f8: Reverse indicators



f9: Assign MB-D14 4 button



g1: Assign Fn button



g2: Assign preview button



g3: Assign AE-L/AF-L button



g4: Assign shutter button



1 Reset with Reset shooting menu (0 214). 2 Reset with two-button reset (0 151).

3 Fixed at Auto.

4 Auto ISO sensitivity control is not available.

5 Reset when mode dial is rotated to new setting. 6 Reset with Reset custom settings (0 221).

k, p, l, m,

n, o, r, t,

x, y, 1, 2,

P S, A, M s, 0 u, v w z 3

   

 -- ------ --

 -- ------ --

 -- ------ --  -- ------ --  -- ------ --  -- ------ --                                                    

n
311

Defaults

The default settings for the options in the camera menus are listed below. For information on two-button resets, see page 151.

 Playback Menu Defaults

Option Playback folder Image review After delete Rotate tall

Default ND600
Off Show next
On

0

Option

207 Slide show

212 Image type 212

212 Frame interval

Default 0
Still images and movies 213 2s

 Shooting Menu Defaults 1

Option File naming Role played by card in Slot 2 Image quality Image size Image area
Auto DX crop Choose image area JPEG compression NEF (RAW) recording
Type
NEF (RAW) bit depth White balance
Fine-tuning Choose color temp. Preset manual Set Picture Control Auto distortion control Color space Active D-Lighting P, S, A, M, 1, 2, 3 Other modes HDR (high dynamic range) HDR mode Exposure differential Smoothing

Default 0

Option

DSC 216 Vignette control

Overflow 96 Long exposure NR

JPEG normal 93 High ISO NR

Large 95 ISO sensitivity settings

ISO sensitivity

On

89 P, S, A, M

FX (36×24) 90 Other modes

Size priority 94 Auto ISO sensitivity control

Remote control mode

Lossless

Multiple exposure 2

compressed 94 Multiple exposure mode

14-bit

Number of shots

Auto > Normal 115 Auto gain

A-B: 0, G-M: 0 117 Interval timer shooting

5000 K 120 Time-lapse photography

d-1

121 Movie settings

Standard 129 Frame size/frame rate

Off

217 Movie quality

sRGB 217 Microphone

Destination

Off 137
Auto

Off

140

Auto 140

Normal 141

Default 0

Normal 218

Off

218

Normal 218

100 Auto

105

Off

107

Delayed remote 85

Off

160

2

161

On

162

Reset 3 164

Reset 4 168

1920×1080; 30p

High quality Auto sensitivity

65

Slot 1

1 Default settings restored with Reset shooting menu (0 214). 2 Reset shooting menu can not be selected while shooting is in progress. 3 Start time reset to Now, interval reset to 1 minute, number of intervals and number of shots reset to 1,
n and Start set to Off. Shooting ends when reset is performed. 4 Interval reset to 5 s, recording time to 25 minutes.

312

 Custom Settings Menu Defaults *

Option

Default 0

a1 AF-C priority selection

Release 221

a2 AF-S priority selection

Focus 221

a3 Focus tracking with lock-on 3 (Normal) 222

a4 AF point illumination

Auto

222

a5 Focus point wrap-around

No wrap 222

a6 Number of focus points

39 points 223

a7 Built-in AF-assist illuminator

On

223

b1 ISO sensitivity step value

1/3 step 224

b2 EV steps for exposure cntrl

1/3 step 224

b3 Easy exposure compensation

Off

225

b4 Center-weighted area

ø 12 mm 226

b5 Fine-tune optimal exposure

Matrix metering

0

Center-weighted metering

0

226

Spot metering

0

c1 Shutter-release button AE-L

Off

226

c2 Standby timer

6s

227

c3 Self-timer

Self-timer delay

10 s

Number of shots

1

227

Interval between shots

0.5 s

c4 Monitor off delay

Playback

10 s

Menus

1 min

Information display

10 s

228

Image review

4s

Live view

10 min

c5 Remote on duration

1 min 228

d1 Beep

Volume Pitch

Off High

228

d2 Viewfinder grid display

Off

229

d3 ISO display and adjustment Show frame count 229

d4 Screen tips

On

229

d5 CL mode shooting speed

3 fps

229

d6 Max. continuous release

100

230

d7 File number sequence

On

230

Option

Default 0

d8 Information display

Auto

231

d9 LCD illumination

Off

231

d10 Exposure delay mode

Off

231

d11 Flash warning

On

231

d12 MB-D14 battery type

LR6 (AA alkaline) 232

d13 Battery order

Use MB-D14 batteries first

233

e1 Flash sync speed

1/200 s 234

e2 Flash shutter speed

1/60 s 235

e3 Flash cntrl for built-in flash/ Optional flash

TTL

236

e4 Exposure comp. for flash

Entire frame 240

e5 Modeling flash

On

241

e6 Auto bracketing set

AE & flash 241

e7 Bracketing order

MTR > under > over

241

f1 OK button (shooting mode)

Select center focus point

241

f2 Assign Fn button

Choose image area 242

f3 Assign preview button

Preview 244

f4 Assign AE-L/AF-L button

AE/AF lock 244

f5 Customize command dials

Exposure

Reverse rotation

compensation: U Shutter speed/

aperture: U 245

Change main/sub

Off

Aperture setting

Sub-command dial

Menus and playback

Off

f6 Release button to use dial

No

246

f7 Slot empty release lock

Enable release 246

f8 Reverse indicators

246

f9 Assign MB-D14 4 button

AE/AF lock 247

g1 Assign Fn button

None

247

g2 Assign preview button

Index marking 248

g3 Assign AE-L/AF-L button

AE/AF lock 248

g4 Assign shutter button

Take photos 248

* Default settings restored with Reset custom settings (0 221).

n

313

 Setup Menu Defaults

Option

Default

0

Option

Default

0

Save user settings

Flicker reduction

Auto

252

Save to U1 Save to U2

Shooting mode defaults to P

81

Time zone and date Daylight saving time

Off

253

Monitor brightness Manual

Manual 0

250

Auto image rotation GPS

On

254

Clean image sensor Clean at startup/shutdown

Clean at startup & shutdown

Standby timer 301 Use GPS to set camera clock
Eye-Fi upload

Enable Yes
Enable

175 260

HDMI

Output resolution Device control

Auto On

205

n
314

Exposure Program (Mode P)

The exposure program for mode P is shown in the following graph:

Aperture f/1.4 - f/16

ISO 100; lens with maximum aperture of f/1.4 and minimum

aperture of f/16 (e.g., AF-S NIKKOR 50mm f/1.4G)

[ EV] -5 -4 -3 -2 -1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13

f/1

14

f/1.4

15

f/2

16161 /3

f/2.8

17

f/4

18

f/5.6

19

f/8

20

f/11

21

f/16

22

f/22

23

f/32 30" 15" 8" 4" 2" 1" 2 4 8 15 30 60 125 250 500 1000 2000 4000 8000

Shutter speed (seconds)

The maximum and minimum values for EV vary with ISO sensitivity; the above graph assumes an ISO sensitivity of ISO 100 equivalent. When matrix metering is used, values over 161/3 EV are reduced to 161/3 EV.

n
315

Troubleshooting
If the camera fails to function as expected, check the list of common problems below before consulting your retailer or Nikon-authorized service representative.
Display
Viewfinder is out of focus: Adjust viewfinder focus or use optional eyepiece correction lenses (0 33, 297). Viewfinder is dark: Insert a fully-charged battery (0 21, 35). Displays turn off without warning: Choose longer delays for Custom Setting c2 (Standby timer) or c4 (Monitor off delay) (0 227, 228). Control panel and viewfinder displays are unresponsive and dim: The response times and brightness of these displays vary with temperature. Fine lines are visible around active focus point or display turns red when focus point is highlighted: These phenomena are normal for this type of viewfinder and do not indicate a malfunction.
A If the Camera Stops Responding
In extremely rare instances, the displays may not respond as expected and the camera may stop functioning. In most cases, this phenomenon is caused by a strong external static charge. Turn the camera off, remove and replace the battery, taking care to avoid burns, and
n turn the camera on again, or, if you are using an AC adapter (available separately), disconnect and reconnect the adapter and turn the camera on again. If the problem persists, contact your retailer or Nikon-authorized service representative.
316

Shooting (All Modes)
Camera takes time to turn on: Delete files or folders. Shutter-release disabled: · Memory card is locked, full, or not inserted (0 29, 31). · Built-in flash is charging (0 39). · Camera is not in focus (0 38). · CPU lens with aperture ring attached but aperture not locked at highest f-number. If B is
displayed in control panel, select Aperture ring for Custom Setting f5 (Customize command dials) > Aperture setting to use lens aperture ring to adjust aperture (0 245). · Non-CPU lens is attached but camera is not in mode A or M (0 288). Camera is slow to respond to shutter-release button: Select Off for Custom Setting d10 (Exposure delay mode; 0 231). No photo taken when remote control shutter-release button is pressed: · Replace battery in remote control (0 298). · Choose remote control release mode (0 85). · Flash is charging (0 87). · Time selected for Custom Setting c5 (Remote on duration, 0 228) has elapsed: press camera shutter-release button halfway. · Bright light is interfering with remote. Photos are out of focus: · Rotate focus-mode selector to AF (0 97). · Camera unable to focus using autofocus: use manual focus or focus lock (0 102, 103). Focus does not lock when shutter-release button is pressed halfway: Use A AE-L/AF-L button to lock focus when AF-C is selected for focus mode or when photographing moving subjects in AF-A mode. Can not select focus point: · Unlock focus selector lock (0 101). · Auto-area AF or face-priority AF selected for AF-area mode: choose another mode. · Camera is in playback mode (0 177) or menus are in use (0 207). · Press shutter-release button halfway to turn monitor off or start standby timer (0 39). Can not select AF-area mode: Manual focus selected (0 55, 103). Only one shot taken each time shutter-release button is pressed in continuous release mode: Continuous shooting is not available if built-in flash fires (0 145). Image size can not be changed: Image quality set to NEF (RAW) (0 93). Camera is slow to record photos: Turn long exposure noise reduction off (0 218).
n
317

Noise (bright spots, randomly-spaced bright pixels, fog, or lines) appear in photos: · Choose lower ISO sensitivity or use high ISO noise reduction (0 105, 218). · Shutter speed is slower than 1 s: use long exposure noise reduction (0 218). · Turn Active D-Lighting off to avoid heightening the effects of noise (0 137). AF-assist illuminator does not light: · AF-assist lamp does not light if AF-C is selected for autofocus mode (0 97) or if continuous-
servo autofocus is selected when the camera is in AF-A mode. Choose AF-S. If an option other than auto-area AF is selected for AF-area mode, select center focus point (0 99, 101). · The camera is currently in live view or a movie is being recorded. · Off selected for Custom Setting a7 (Built-in AF-assist illuminator) (0 223). · Illuminator has turned off automatically. Illuminator may become hot with continued use; wait for lamp to cool down. Smudges appear in photographs: Clean front and rear lens elements. If problem persists, perform image sensor cleaning (0 301). Sound is not recorded with movies: Microphone off is selected for Movie settings > Microphone. The brightness of the image in the monitor differs from the exposure of photographs taken in live view: · Center-weighted or spot metering is selected (0 109). · The camera is in mode M. · The subject is too bright or too dark. · Active D-Lighting is in effect (0 137). · The photograph is a long time-exposure (0 79). · The flash is used (0 143). Flicker or banding appears during live view or movie recording: Choose an option for Flicker reduction that matches the frequency of the local AC power supply (0 252). Bright bands appear during live view or movie recording: A flashing sign, flash, or other light source with brief duration was used during live view or movie recording. Menu item can not be selected: Some options are not available in all modes.
n
318

Shooting (P, S, A, M)
Shutter-release disabled: · Non-CPU lens is attached: rotate camera mode dial to A or M (0 288). · Mode dial rotated to S after shutter speed of A selected in mode M: choose new shutter
speed (0 76). Full range of shutter speeds not available: Flash in use. Flash sync speed can be selected using Custom Setting e1 (Flash sync speed); when using compatible flash units, choose 1/250 s (Auto FP) or 1/200 s (Auto FP) for full range of shutter speeds (0 234). Colors are unnatural: · Adjust white balance to match light source (0 115). · Adjust Set Picture Control settings (0 129). Can not measure white balance: Subject is too dark or too bright (0 123). Image can not be selected as source for preset white balance: Image was not created with D600 (0 124). White balance bracketing unavailable: · NEF (RAW) or NEF+JPEG image quality option selected for image quality (0 93). · Multiple exposure mode is in effect (0 163). Effects of Picture Control differ from image to image: A (auto) is selected for sharpening, contrast, or saturation. For consistent results over a series of photos, choose another setting (0 132). Metering can not be changed: Autoexposure lock or movie live view is in effect (0 57, 110). Exposure compensation can not be used: Choose mode P, S, or A (0 75, 76, 77). Noise (reddish areas or other artifacts) appears in long time-exposures: Enable long exposure noise reduction (0 218).
n
319

Playback
NEF (RAW) image is not played back: Photo was taken at image quality of NEF + JPEG (0 93).
Can not view pictures recorded with other cameras: Pictures recorded with other makes of camera may not be displayed correctly.
Message is displayed stating that no images are available for playback: Select All for Playback folder (0 207).
"Tall" (portrait) orientation photos are displayed in "wide" (landscape) orientation: · Select On for Rotate tall (0 212). · Photo was taken with Off selected for Auto image rotation (0 254). · Camera was pointed up or down when photo was taken (0 254). · Photo is displayed in image review (0 212).
Can not delete picture: · Picture is protected: remove protection (0 188). · Memory card is locked (0 32). Can not retouch picture: Photo can not be further edited with this camera (0 262).
Can not change print order: · Memory card is full: delete pictures (0 36, 189). · Memory card is locked (0 32).
Can not select photo for printing: Photo is in NEF (RAW) format. Create JPEG copy using NEF (RAW) processing or transfer to computer and print using ViewNX 2 (supplied) or Capture NX 2 (available separately).
Picture is not displayed on TV: · Choose correct video mode (0 65) or output resolution (0 205). · HDMI (0 204) cable is not correctly connected.
Camera does not respond to remote control for HDMI-CEC television: · Select On for HDMI > Device control in the setup menu (0 205). · Adjust HDMI-CEC settings for the television as described in documentation provided with
the device.
Can not transfer photos to computer: OS not compatible with camera or transfer software. Use card reader to copy photos to computer (0 193). Photos are not displayed in Capture NX 2: Update to latest version (0 298).
Image Dust Off option in Capture NX 2 does not have desired effect: Image sensor cleaning changes the position of dust on the low-pass filter. Dust off reference data recorded before image sensor cleaning is performed can not be used with photographs taken after image sensor cleaning is performed. Dust off reference data recorded after image sensor cleaning is performed can not be used with photographs taken before image sensor cleaning is performed (0 252).
Computer displays NEF (RAW) images differently from camera: Third-party software does not display effects of Picture Controls, Active D-Lighting, or vignette control. Use ViewNX 2 (supplied) or optional Nikon software such as Capture NX 2 (available separately).
n
320

Miscellaneous
Date of recording is not correct: Set camera clock (0 27, 253). Menu item can not be selected: Some options are not available at certain combinations of settings or when no memory card is inserted. Note that Battery info option is not available when camera is powered by an optional EP-5B power connector and EH-5b AC adapter (0 255).
n
321

Error Messages

This section lists the indicators and error messages that appear in the viewfinder, control panel, and monitor.

Indicator

Control Viewpanel finder

Problem

Solution

0

B (flashes)

Lens aperture ring is not set to Set ring to minimum aperture

minimum aperture.

(highest f-number).

26

H

d Low battery.

Ready a fully-charged spare battery.

21

· Battery exhausted.

· Recharge or replace battery.

· Battery can not be used. · Contact Nikon-authorized

service representative.

H

d · An extremely exhausted · Replace the battery, or

xxiii, 21,

(flashes) (flashes) rechargeable Li-ion battery recharge the battery if the

23

or a third-party battery is

rechargeable Li-ion battery

inserted either in the camera is exhausted.

or in the optional MB-D14

battery pack.

No lens attached, or non-CPU

lens attached without

Aperture value will be

F

specifying maximum aperture. displayed if maximum aperture 172

Aperture shown in stops from is specified.

maximum aperture.

--

2 4 Camera unable to focus using Change composition or focus

(flashes) autofocus.

manually.

98, 103

· No lens attached.

· Attach non-IX Nikkor lens. 25, 285

i (flashes)

If a CPU lens is attached, remove and reattach the lens.

· Non-CPU lens attached. · Select mode A or M.

288

n
322

Indicator

Control View-

panel finder

Problem

Solution

· Use a lower ISO sensitivity

· In shooting mode:

Subject too bright; photo will P Use optional ND filter

be overexposed. (Exposure indicators and shutter speed or aperture display

S Increase shutter speed A Choose a smaller aperture
(higher f-number) · Use a higher ISO sensitivity

flash)

· In shooting mode:

Subject too dark; photo will be P Use flash

underexposed.

S Lower shutter speed

A Choose a larger aperture

(lower f-number)

A (flashes)

A selected in mode S.

Change shutter speed or select mode M.

% (flashes)

% selected in mode S.

Change shutter speed or select mode M.

P (flashes)

k (flashes)

Images are being processed.

Wait until processing is complete.

--

c (flashes)

If indicator flashes for 3s after flash fires, photo may be underexposed.

Check photo in monitor; if underexposed, adjust settings and try again.

Memory insufficient to record · Reduce quality or size.

n j further photos at current

· Delete photographs.

(flashes) (flashes) settings, or camera has run out · Insert new memory card.

of file or folder numbers.

O (flashes)

Camera malfunction.

Release shutter. If error persists or appears frequently, consult Nikon-authorized service

representative.

0 105
297 76 77 105
143 76 77
76, 78
76, 78
--
177
93, 95 189 29
--

n
323

Indicator

Control

Monitor

panel

Problem

Solution

0

No memory card.

S

Camera cannot detect memory card.

Turn camera off and confirm that card is correctly inserted.

29

· Error accessing

· Use Nikon-approved card. 334

memory card.

· Check that contacts are

--

This memory card

cannot be used. W,

Card may be

O

damaged.

(flashes)

Insert another card.

· Unable to create new

folder.

clean. If card is damaged, contact retailer or Nikonauthorized service representative. · Delete files or insert new memory card after copying

29, 189

important images to

computer or other device.

· Check that Eye-Fi card

260

g

W, O (flashes)

Camera can Eye-Fi card.

not

control

firmware is up to date. · Copy files on Eye-Fi card to
a computer or other device and format card, or insert

29, 31, 193

new card.

Memory card is locked. Slide lock to "write" position.

W, X (flashes)

Memory card is locked (write protected).

Not available if Eye-Fi card is locked.

W, O (flashes)

Eye-Fi card is locked (write protected).

Slide card write-protect switch to "write" position.

32

This card is not formatted. Format the card.

[C] (flashes)

Memory card has not been formatted for use in camera.

Format memory card or insert new memory card.

29, 31

Clock has been reset -- Camera clock is not set. Set camera clock.

27, 253

Failed to update

flash unit firmware.

Flash cannot be used. Contact a Nikon-

--

Firmware for flash unit mounted on camera was not updated correctly.

Contact a Nikon-authorized service representative.

--

authorized service

representative.

Unable to start live view. Please wait.

--

The internal temperature of the camera is high.

Wait for the internal circuits to cool before resuming live view or movie recording.

64

n

324

Indicator

Control

Monitor

panel

Problem

Solution

Folder contains no images.

--

No images on memory card or in folder(s) selected for playback.

Select folder containing images from Playback folder menu or insert memory card containing images.

No images can be played

All images are hidden.

--

All photos in current folder are hidden.

back until another folder has been selected or Hide image used to allow at least one

image to be displayed.

File has been created or

Cannot display this file.

--

modified using a computer or different make of camera, or file is

File can not be played back on camera.

corrupt.

Cannot select this file.

--

Selected image can not be retouched.

Images created with other devices can not be retouched.

· Movies created with other

This movie cannot be edited.

--

The selected movie can devices can not be edited.

not be edited.

· Movies must be at least

two seconds long.

Check printer.

-- Printer error.

Check printer. To resume, select Continue (if available).

Check paper.

--

Paper in printer is not of Insert paper of correct size

selected size.

and select Continue.

Paper jam.

--

Paper is jammed in printer.

Clear jam and select Continue.

Out of paper.

--

Printer is out of paper.

Insert paper of selected size and select Continue.

Check ink supply.

-- Ink error.

Check ink. To resume, select Continue.

Out of ink.

-- Printer is out of ink.

Replace ink and select Continue.

* See printer manual for more information.

0 29, 207
208
--
262 -- 71 196 * 196 * 196 * 196 * 196 * 196 *

n
325

Specifications

 Nikon D600 Digital Camera

Type Type Lens mount

Single-lens reflex digital camera Nikon F mount (with AF coupling and AF contacts)

Effective pixels Effective pixels

24.3 million

Image sensor

Image sensor

35.9 × 24.0 mm CMOS sensor (Nikon FX format)

Total pixels

24.7 million

Dust-reduction System Image sensor cleaning, Image Dust Off reference data (optional

Capture NX 2 software required)

Storage

Image size (pixels) · FX (36×24) image area

6,016 × 4,016 (#) 4,512 × 3,008 ($) 3,008 × 2,008 (%)

· DX (24×16) image area

3,936 × 2,624 (#) 2,944 × 1,968 ($) 1,968 × 1,312 (%)

· FX-format photographs taken in movie live view

6,016 × 3,376 (#) 4,512 × 2,528 ($) 3,008 × 1,688 (%)

· DX-format photographs in movie live view

3,936 × 2,224 (#) 2,944 × 1,664 ($) 1,968 × 1,112 (%)

File format

· NEF (RAW): 12 or 14 bit, lossless compressed or compressed

· JPEG: JPEG-Baseline compliant with fine (approx. 1 : 4), normal (approx.

1 : 8), or basic (approx. 1 : 16) compression (Size priority); Optimal

quality compression available

· NEF (RAW)+JPEG: Single photograph recorded in both NEF (RAW) and

JPEG formats

Picture Control System Standard, Neutral, Vivid, Monochrome, Portrait, Landscape; selected

Picture Control can be modified; storage for custom Picture Controls

Media

SD (Secure Digital) and UHS-I compliant SDHC and SDXC memory cards

Double slot

Slot 2 can be used for overflow or backup storage or for separate storage

of copies created using NEF+JPEG; pictures can be copied between

cards.

File system

DCF (Design Rule for Camera File System) 2.0, DPOF (Digital Print Order

Format), Exif (Exchangeable Image File Format for Digital Still Cameras)

2.3, PictBridge

Viewfinder Viewfinder Frame coverage
Magnification Eyepoint

Eye-level pentaprism single-lens reflex viewfinder · FX (36×24): Approx. 100% horizontal and 100% vertical · DX (24×16): Approx. 97% horizontal and 97% vertical Approx. 0.7 × (50 mm f/1.4 lens at infinity, ­1.0 m­1) 21 mm (­1.0 m­1; from center surface of viewfinder eyepiece lens)

n

326

Viewfinder Diopter adjustment ­3­+1 m­1

Focusing screen

Type B BriteView Clear Matte Mark VIII screen with AF area brackets

(framing grid can be displayed)

Reflex mirror

Quick return

Depth-of-field preview Pressing depth-of-field preview button stops lens aperture down to

value selected by user (A and M modes) or by camera (other modes)

Lens aperture

Instant return, electronically controlled

Lens Compatible lenses

Compatible with AF NIKKOR lenses, including type G and D lenses (some restrictions apply to PC lenses) and DX lenses (using DX 24 × 16 1.5× image area), AI-P NIKKOR lenses, and non-CPU AI lenses (A and M modes only). IX NIKKOR lenses, lenses for the F3AF, and non-AI lenses can not be used.

The electronic rangefinder can be used with lenses that have a maximum aperture of f/5.6 or faster (the electronic rangefinder supports the center 7 focus points with lenses that have a maximum aperture of f/8 or faster and the center 33 focus points with lenses that have a maximum aperture of f/6.8 or faster)

Shutter Type Speed
Flash sync speed

Electronically-controlled vertical-travel focal-plane shutter 1/4000 ­ 30 s in steps of 1/3 or 1/2 EV, bulb, time (requires optional ML-L3 remote control), X200 X=1/200 s; synchronizes with shutter at 1/250 s or slower (flash range drops at speeds between 1/200 and 1/250 s)

Release

Release mode

S (single frame), CL (continuous low speed), CH (continuous high speed),

J (quiet shutter-release), E (self-timer), 4 (remote control), MUP (mirror

up)

Frame advance rate 1­5 fps (CL) or 5.5 fps (CH)

Self-timer

2 s, 5 s, 10 s, 20 s; 1­9 exposures at intervals of 0.5, 1, 2, or 3 s

Remote release modes Delayed remote, quick-response remote, remote mirror-up

Exposure

Metering

TTL exposure metering using 2,016-pixel RGB sensor

Metering method · Matrix: 3D color matrix metering II (type G and D lenses); color matrix

metering II (other CPU lenses); color matrix metering available with

non-CPU lenses if user provides lens data

· Center-weighted: Weight of 75% given to 12 mm circle in center of frame.

Diameter of circle can be changed to 8, 15, or 20 mm, or weighting can

be based on average of entire frame (non-CPU lenses use 12-mm circle

or average of entire frame)

· Spot: Meters 4 mm circle (about 1.5% of frame) centered on selected

focus point (on center focus point when non-CPU lens is used)

Range (ISO 100, f/1.4 · Matrix or center-weighted metering: 0­20 EV

lens, 20 °C/68 °F)

· Spot metering: 2­20 EV

n

327

Exposure

Exposure meter coupling

Combined CPU and AI

Mode

Auto (i auto; j auto (flash off)); scene (k portrait; l landscape; p child; m sports;

n close up; o night portrait; r night landscape; s party/indoor; t beach/snow; u sunset;

v dusk/dawn; w pet portrait; x candlelight; y blossom; z autumn colors; 0 food;

1 silhouette; 2 high key; 3 low key); programmed auto with flexible program

(P); shutter-priority auto (S); aperture-priority auto (A); manual (M); U1 (user

settings 1); U2 (user settings 2)

Exposure compensation ­5 ­ +5 EV in increments of 1/3 or 1/2 EV

Exposure bracketing 2­3 frames in steps of 1/3, 1/2, 2/3, 1, 2, or 3 EV

Flash bracketing

2­3 frames in steps of 1/3, 1/2, 2/3, 1, 2, or 3 EV

White balance bracketing

2­3 frames in steps of 1, 2, or 3

ADL bracketing

2 frames using selected value for one frame or 3 frames using preset

values for all frames

Exposure lock

Luminosity locked at detected value with A AE-L/AF-L button

ISO sensitivity

ISO 100 ­ 6400 in steps of 1/3 or 1/2 EV. Can also be set to approx. 0.3, 0.5,

(Recommended

0.7, or 1 EV (ISO 50 equivalent) below ISO 100 or to approx. 0.3, 0.5, 0.7, 1,

Exposure Index)

or 2 EV (ISO 25600 equivalent) above ISO 6400; auto ISO sensitivity

control available

Active D-Lighting Auto, Extra high, High, Normal, Low, Off

Focus Autofocus
Detection range Lens servo
Focus point AF-area mode Focus lock

Nikon Multi-CAM 4800 autofocus sensor module with TTL phase detection, fine-tuning, 39 focus points (including 9 cross-type sensors; the center 33 points are available at apertures slower than f/5.6 and faster than f/8, while the center 7 focus points are available at f/8), and AF-assist illuminator (range approx. 0.5­3 m/1 ft 8 in.­9 ft 10 in.) ­1 ­ +19 EV (ISO 100, 20 °C/68 °F) · Autofocus (AF): Single-servo AF (AF-S); continuous-servo AF (AF-C); auto
AF-S/AF-C selection (AF-A); predictive focus tracking activated automatically according to subject status · Manual focus (M): Electronic rangefinder can be used Can be selected from 39 or 11 focus points Single-point AF; 9-, 21-, or 39-point dynamic-area AF, 3D-tracking, auto-area AF Focus can be locked by pressing shutter-release button halfway (singleservo AF) or by pressing A AE-L/AF-L button

Flash Built-in flash
Guide Number Flash control
n

i, k, p, n, o, s, w: Auto flash with auto pop-up P, S, A, M, 0: Manual pop-up with button release Approx. 12/39, 12/39 with manual flash (m/ft, ISO 100, 20 °C/68 °F) TTL: i-TTL flash control using 2,016-pixel RGB sensor is available with built-in flash and SB-910, SB-900, SB-800, SB-700, SB-600, or SB-400; i-TTL balanced fill-flash for digital SLR is used with matrix and center-weighted metering, standard i-TTL flash for digital SLR with spot metering

328

Flash

Flash mode

Auto, auto with red-eye reduction, auto slow sync, auto slow sync with

red-eye reduction, fill-flash, red-eye reduction, slow sync, slow sync with

red-eye reduction, rear-curtain with slow sync, rear-curtain sync, off;

Auto FP High-Speed Sync supported

Flash compensation ­3 ­ +1 EV in increments of 1/3 or 1/2 EV

Flash-ready indicator Lights when built-in flash or optional flash unit is fully charged; flashes

after flash is fired at full output

Accessory shoe

ISO 518 hot-shoe with sync and data contacts and safety lock

Nikon Creative Lighting Advanced Wireless Lighting supported with built-in flash, SB-910,

System (CLS)

SB-900, SB-800, or SB-700 as a master flash and SB-600 or SB-R200 as

remotes, or SU-800 as commander; built-in flash can serve as master

flash in commander mode; Auto FP High-Speed Sync and modeling

illumination supported with all CLS-compatible flash units except

SB-400; Flash Color Information Communication and FV lock supported

with all CLS-compatible flash units

Sync terminal

AS-15 sync terminal adapter (available separately)

White balance White balance

Auto (2 types), incandescent, fluorescent (7 types), direct sunlight, flash, cloudy, shade, preset manual (up to 4 values can be stored), choose color temperature (2500 K­10000 K), all with fine-tuning

Live view Modes Lens servo
AF-area mode Autofocus

Live view photography (still images), movie live view (movies) · Autofocus (AF): Single-servo AF (AF-S); full-time servo AF (AF-F) · Manual focus (M) Face-priority AF, wide-area AF, normal-area AF, subject-tracking AF Contrast-detect AF anywhere in frame (camera selects focus point automatically when face-priority AF or subject-tracking AF is selected)

Movie

Metering

TTL exposure metering using main image sensor

Metering method Matrix

Frame size (pixels) and · 1,920 × 1,080; 30 p (progressive), 25 p, 24 p

frame rate

· 1,280 × 720; 60 p, 50 p, 30 p, 25 p

Actual frame rates for 60 p, 50 p, 30 p, 25 p, and 24 p are 59.94, 50, 29.97,

25, and 23.976 fps respectively; options support both high and normal

image quality

File format

MOV

Video compression H.264/MPEG-4 Advanced Video Coding

Audio recording format Linear PCM

Audio recording device Built-in monaural or external stereo microphone; sensitivity adjustable

Other options

Index marking, time-lapse photography

n

329

Monitor Monitor

8-cm/3.2-in., approx. 921k-dot (VGA), low-temperature polysilicon TFT LCD with approx. 170 ° viewing angle, approx. 100% frame coverage, and automatic monitor brightness control using ambient brightness sensor

Playback Playback

Full-frame and thumbnail (4, 9, or 72 images or calendar) playback with playback zoom, movie playback, photo and/or movie slide shows, histogram display, highlights, photo information, GPS data display, and auto image rotation

Interface USB HDMI output Accessory terminal
Audio input Audio output

Hi-Speed USB Type C mini-pin HDMI connector Remote cord: MC-DC2 (available separately) GPS unit: GP-1 (available separately) Stereo mini-pin jack (3.5mm diameter; plug-in power supported) Stereo mini-pin jack (3.5 mm diameter)

Supported languages Supported languages

Arabic, Chinese (Simplified and Traditional), Czech, Danish, Dutch, English, Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hindi, Hungarian, Indonesian, Italian, Japanese, Korean, Norwegian, Polish, Portuguese (Portugal and Brazil), Romanian, Russian, Spanish, Swedish, Thai, Turkish, Ukrainian

Power source Battery Battery pack
AC adapter

One rechargeable Li-ion EN-EL15 battery Optional MB-D14 multi-power battery pack with one rechargeable Nikon EN-EL15 Li-ion battery or six AA alkaline, Ni-MH, or lithium batteries EH-5b AC adapter; requires EP-5B power connector (available separately)

Tripod socket Tripod socket

1/4 in. (ISO 1222)

Dimensions/weight

Dimensions (W × H × D) Approx. 141 × 113 × 82 mm (5.6 × 4.4 × 3.2 in.)

Weight

Approx. 850 g (1 lb 14.0 oz) with battery and memory card but without

body cap; approx. 760 g (1 lb 10.8 oz; camera body only)

Operating environment

Temperature

0­40 °C (+32­104 °F)

Humidity

85% or less (no condensation)

· Unless otherwise stated, all figures are for a camera with a fully-charged battery operating at an ambient

temperature of 20 °C (68 °F).

· Nikon reserves the right to change the specifications of the hardware and software described in this

manual at any time and without prior notice. Nikon will not be held liable for damages that may result

from any mistakes that this manual may contain.

n

330

MH-25 battery charger

Rated input (in North America)

AC 120 V, 60 Hz, 0.2 A

Rated input (in other regions) Rated output

AC 100­240 V, 50/60 Hz, 0.23­0.12 A DC 8.4 V/1.2 A

Supported batteries Nikon EN-EL15 rechargeable Li-ion batteries

Charging time

Approx. 2 hours and 35 minutes at an ambient temperature of

25 °C (77 °F) when no charge remains Operating temperature 0­40 °C (+32­104 °F)

Dimensions (W × H × D) Approx. 91.5 × 33.5 × 71 mm (3.6 × 1.3 × 2.8 in.), excluding projections Length of power cable Approx. 1.8 m/6 ft (U.S.A. and Canada) or 1.5 m/4.9 ft (other countries)

Weight

Approx. 110 g (3.9 oz), excluding power cable and AC wall adapter

EN-EL15 rechargeable Li-ion battery

Type

Rechargeable lithium-ion battery

Rated capacity

7.0 V/1,900 mAh

Operating temperature 0­40 °C (+32­104 °F)

Dimensions (W × H × D) Approx. 40 × 56 × 20.5 mm (1.6 × 2.2 × 0.8 in.)

Weight

Approx. 88 g (3.1 oz), excluding terminal cover

Nikon reserves the right to change the specifications of the hardware and software described in this manual at any time and without prior notice. Nikon will not be held liable for damages that may result from any mistakes that this manual may contain.

n
331

ViewNX 2 CPU
OS
RAM Hard-disk space Monitor
n

Windows

Mac OS

· Photographs/JPEG movies: Intel

· Photographs/JPEGmovies: PowerPC

Celeron, Pentium 4, or Core series, G4 (1 GHz or better), G5, Intel

1.6 GHz or better

Core series, or Xeon series

· H.264 movies (playback): 3.0 GHz or · H.264 movies (playback): PowerPC

better Pentium D; Intel Core i5 or G5 Dual or Core Duo, 2 GHz or

better recommended when

better; Intel Core i5 or better

viewing movies with a frame size recommended when viewing

of 1,280 × 720 or more at a frame movies with a frame size of

rate of 30 fps or above or movies 1,280 × 720 or more at a frame

with a frame size of 1,920 × 1,080 rate of 30 fps or above or

or more

movies with a frame size of

· H.264 movies (editing): 2.6 GHz or

1,920 × 1,080 or more

better Core 2 Duo

· H.264 movies (editing): 2.6 GHz or

better Core 2 Duo

· GPU that supports QuickTime

H.264 hardware acceleration

recommended

Pre-installed versions of Windows 7

Home Basic/Home Premium/

Professional/Enterprise/Ultimate

(Service Pack 1), Windows Vista

Home Basic/Home Premium/

Business/Enterprise/Ultimate

(Service Pack 2), or 32-bit editions of Windows XP Home Edition/ Professional (Service Pack 3). All

Mac OS X version 10.5.8, 10.6.8, or 10.7.2

installed programs may run as 32-bit

applications in 64-bit editions of

Windows 7 and Windows Vista. This

application is not compatible with

computers running 64-bit

Windows XP.

· Windows 7/Windows Vista: 1 GB or

more (2 GB or more

recommended) · Windows XP: 512 MB or more (2 GB

512 MB or more (2 GB or more recommended)

or more recommended)

A minimum of 500 MB available on the startup disk (1 GB or more

recommended)

Resolution: 1024×768 pixels (XGA) or Resolution: 1024×768 pixels (XGA) or

more (1280 × 1024 pixels (SXGA) or more recommended)

more (1280 × 1024 pixels (SXGA) or more recommended) Color: 24-bit color (millions of colors)

Color: 24-bit color (True Color) or more or more

332

 Supported Standards
· DCF Version 2.0: The Design Rule for Camera File Systems (DCF) is a standard widely used in the digital camera industry to ensure compatibility among different makes of camera.
· DPOF: Digital Print Order Format (DPOF) is an industry-wide standard that allows pictures to be printed from print orders stored on the memory card.
· Exif version 2.3: The camera supports Exif (Exchangeable Image File Format for Digital Still Cameras) version 2.3, a standard in which information stored with photographs is used for optimal color reproduction when the images are output on Exif-compliant printers.
· PictBridge: A standard developed through cooperation with the digital camera and printer industries, allowing photographs to be output directly to a printer without first transferring them to a computer.
· HDMI: High-Definition Multimedia Interface is a standard for multimedia interfaces used in consumer electronics and AV devices capable of transmitting audiovisual data and control signals to HDMI-compliant devices via a single cable connection.

Trademark Information

Macintosh, Mac OS, and QuickTime are registered trademarks of Apple Inc. in the United States

and/or other countries. Microsoft, Windows, and Windows Vista are either registered

trademarks, or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other

countries. PictBridge is a trademark. The SD, SDHC, and SDXC logos are trademarks of the

SD-3C, LLC. HDMI, the

logo and High-Definition Multimedia Interface are

trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC. All other trade names mentioned

in this manual or the other documentation provided with your Nikon product are trademarks

or registered trademarks of their respective holders.

n
333

Approved Memory Cards

The following SD memory cards have been tested and approved for use in the camera. Cards with class 6 or faster write speeds are recommended for movie recording. Recording may end unexpectedly when cards with slower write speeds are used.

SD cards

SDHC cards 2

SDXC cards 3

SanDisk Toshiba

4 GB, 8 GB, 16 GB, 32 GB

64 GB

Panasonic Lexar Media

2 GB 1

4 GB, 6 GB, 8 GB, 12 GB, 16 GB, 24 GB, 32 GB 4 GB, 8 GB, 16 GB

48 GB, 64 GB

Platinum II

4 GB, 8 GB, 16 GB, 32 GB

--

Professional

Full-HD Video

--

4 GB, 8 GB, 16 GB

1 Check that any card readers or other devices with which the card will be used support 2 GB cards.

2 Check that any card readers or other devices with which the card will be used are SDHC-compliant. The

camera supports UHS-1.

3 Check that any card readers or other devices with which the card will be used are

SDXC-compliant. The camera supports UHS-1.

Other cards have not been tested. For more details on the above cards, please contact the manufacturer.

n
334

Memory Card Capacity

The following table shows the approximate number of pictures that can be stored on an 8 GB SanDisk Extreme Pro SDHC UHS-I card at different image quality (0 93), image size (0 95), and image area settings (0 89).

 FX (36×24) Image Area*

Image quality

Image size

File size 1

No. of images 1

NEF (RAW), Lossless compressed, 12-bit

--

23.4 MB

190

NEF (RAW), Lossless compressed, 14-bit

--

29.2 MB

147

NEF (RAW), Compressed, 12-bit

--

20.7 MB

258

NEF (RAW), Compressed, 14-bit

--

25.4 MB

215

Large

12.4 MB

506

JPEG fine 3

Medium

7.4 MB

853

Small

3.8 MB

1600

Large

6.2 MB

1000

JPEG normal 3

Medium

3.7 MB

1600

Small

1.9 MB

3200

Large

3.2 MB

1900

JPEG basic 3

Medium

1.9 MB

3200

Small

1.0 MB

6300

* Includes images taken with non-DX lenses when On is selected for Auto DX crop.

Buffer capacity 2
22
16
27 16 57 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100

n
335

 DX (24×16) Image Area *

Image quality

Image size

File size 1

No. of images 1

NEF (RAW), Lossless compressed, 12-bit

--

10.9 MB

426

NEF (RAW), Lossless compressed, 14-bit

--

13.4 MB

332

NEF (RAW), Compressed, 12-bit

--

9.7 MB

571

NEF (RAW), Compressed, 14-bit

--

11.7 MB

480

Large

5.9 MB

1000

JPEG fine 3

Medium

3.7 MB

1700

Small

2.2 MB

2900

Large

3.0 MB

2100

JPEG normal 3

Medium

1.9 MB

3300

Small

1.1 MB

5700

Large

1.5 MB

4100

JPEG basic 3

Medium

1.0 MB

6300

Small

0.6 MB

10000

* Includes images taken with DX lenses when On is selected for Auto DX crop.

Buffer capacity 2
62
38
86 61 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100

1 All figures are approximate. File size varies with scene recorded. 2 Maximum number of exposures that can be stored in memory buffer at ISO 100. Drops if Optimal
quality is selected for JPEG compression (0 94), ISO sensitivity is set to Hi 0.3 or higher, or long exposure noise reduction or auto distortion control is on. 3 Figures assume JPEG compression is set to Size priority. Selecting Optimal quality increases the file size of JPEG images; number of images and buffer capacity drop accordingly.

n A d6--Max. Continuous Release (0 230) The maximum number of photographs that can be taken in a single burst can be set to any amount between 1 and 100.
336

Battery Life
The number of shots that can be taken with fully-charged batteries varies with the condition of the battery, temperature, and how the camera is used. In the case of AA batteries, capacity also varies with make and storage conditions; some batteries can not be used. Sample figures for the camera and optional MB-D14 multi-power battery pack are given below. · CIPA standard 1
One EN-EL15 battery (camera): Approximately 900 shots One EN-EL15 battery (MB-D14): Approximately 900 shots Six AA alkaline batteries (MB-D14): Approximately 450 shots · Nikon standard 2 One EN-EL15 battery (camera): Approximately 3900 shots One EN-EL15 battery (MB-D14): Approximately 3900 shots Six AA alkaline batteries (MB-D14): Approximately 1300 shots 1 Measured at 23 °C/73.4 °F (±2 °C/3.6 °F) with an AF-S NIKKOR 24­85mm f/3.5­4.5G ED VR
lens under the following test conditions: lens cycled from infinity to minimum range and one photograph taken at default settings once every 30 s; flash fired once every other shot. Live view not used. 2 Measured at 20 °C/68 °F with an AF-S NIKKOR 24­85mm f/3.5­4.5G ED VR lens under the following test conditions: image quality set to JPEG basic, image size set to M (medium), shutter speed 1/250 s, shutter-release button pressed halfway for three seconds and focus cycled from infinity to minimum range three times; six shots are then taken in succession and monitor turned on for five seconds and then turned off; cycle repeated once standby timer expires.
The following can reduce battery life: · Using the monitor · Keeping the shutter-release button pressed halfway · Repeated autofocus operations · Taking NEF (RAW) photographs · Slow shutter speeds · Using a GP-1 GPS unit · Using an Eye-Fi card · Using a WU-1b wireless mobile adapter · Using VR (vibration reduction) mode with VR lenses
To ensure that you get the most from rechargeable Nikon EN-EL15 batteries: · Keep the battery contacts clean. Soiled contacts can reduce battery performance. · Use batteries immediately after charging. Batteries will lose their charge if left
unused.
n
337

Index

Symbols
i (Auto mode)......................... 35, 36 j (Auto (flash off) mode) .... 35, 36 h (Scene)................................... 40 k (Portrait) ....................................... 41 l (Landscape)................................. 41 p (Child)............................................ 41 m (Sports).......................................... 41 n (Close up) ..................................... 42 o (Night portrait)........................... 42 r (Night landscape)...................... 42 s (Party/indoor)............................. 42 t (Beach/snow).............................. 43 u (Sunset)......................................... 43 v (Dusk/dawn) ............................... 43 w (Pet portrait) ............................... 43 x (Candlelight)................................. 44 y (Blossom)...................................... 44 z (Autumn colors) ......................... 44 0 (Food)............................................. 44 1 (Silhouette).................................. 45 2 (High key)..................................... 45 3 (Low key) ...................................... 45 P (Programmed auto).................... 75 S (Shutter-priority auto) ............... 76 A (Aperture-priority auto)............ 77 M (Manual) ........................................ 78 U1/U2.................................................... 81 S (Single frame) ...........................6, 83 CL (Continuous low speed) .....6, 83, 229 CH (Continuous high speed)....6, 83 J (Quiet shutter-release).........6, 83 E (Self-timer)........................6, 83, 85 4 (Remote control)............6, 83, 85 MUP (Mirror up)......................6, 83, 88 ! (Face-priority AF) ...................... 52 $ (Wide-area AF) ........................... 52 % (Normal-area AF)....................... 52 & (Subject-tracking AF) ............ 52 a (Matrix).......................................109 Z (Center-weighted) ....... 109, 226 b (Spot) ..........................................109 AUTO (Auto flash).................. 144, 145 Y (Red-eye reduction).... 144, 145 SLOW (Slow sync) ................. 144, 145 REAR (Rear-curtain sync)... 144, 145 E (Exposure compensation) ....112 Y (Flash compensation) ..........148 U (Flexible program) .................... 75
n a (Live view) button ............. 49, 57 R (Info) button...........................9, 11 D switch...............................................2

m (White balance) .......................115 L (Preset manual) .......... 115, 121 D (Bracketing) ................. 153, 178 d (Help)............................................. 18 I (Focus indicator)..... 38, 102, 103 t (Memory buffer) .................. 38, 84 N (Flash-ready indicator) ............. 39
Numerics
12-bit .................................................. 94 14-bit .................................................. 94 2,016-pixel RGB sensor..... 146, 327 3D-tracking .............................99, 100
A
AC adapter............................ 297, 299 Accessories .....................................297 Accessory shoe..............................292 Accessory terminal ......................298 Active D-Lighting ............... 137, 158 Add items (My Menu) .................280 ADL bracketing ................... 158, 241 Adobe RGB .....................................217 AE & flash (Auto bracketing set) .... 153, 241 AE lock..............................................110 AE only (Auto bracketing set) .153, 241 AE-L/AF-L button. 102, 110, 244, 248 AF................................. 51­52, 97­102 AF area brackets .........................8, 33 AF fine-tune ...................................259 AF point illumination..................222 AF-A..................................................... 97 AF-area mode........................... 52, 99 AF-assist........................223, 290, 296 AF-C............................................97, 221 AF-F ..................................................... 51 AF-mode button......51, 52, 98, 100 AF-S .....................................51, 97, 221 After delete.....................................212 A-M mode switch............................. 26 Ambient brightness sensor ...4, 53, 250 Angle of view.................................291 Aperture .............................. 74, 77­78 Aperture-priority auto.................. 77 Aspect ratio ....................................265 Assign AE-L/AF-L button . 244, 248 Assign Fn button ................ 242, 247 Assign MB-D14 4 button..........247 Assign preview button..... 244, 248 Assign shutter button.................248 Attaching the lens.......................... 25

Auto (White balance)..................115 Auto bracketing.................. 153, 241 Auto bracketing set.....................241 Auto distortion control ..............217 Auto DX crop ............................ 89, 91 Auto flash........................................145 Auto FP high-speed sync. 234, 235 Auto image rotation....................254 Auto ISO sensitivity control......107 Auto-area AF...........................99, 100 Autoexposure lock.......................110 Autofocus.................. 51­52, 97­102 Autofocus mode...................... 51, 97 Auto-servo AF.................................. 97 Available settings.........................309
B
Backlight..................................... 2, 231 Backup (Role played by card in Slot 2)................................................ 96 Battery............... 21, 23, 35, 255, 331 Battery info.....................................255 Battery life.......................................337 Battery order..................................233 Battery pack ..... 232, 233, 247, 255, 297 Beep ..................................................228 Bit rate ................................................ 65 Black-and-white (Monochrome).... 266 Blue intensifier (Filter effects) ..267 Body cap.............................. 3, 25, 298 Border (PictBridge) ......................198 Bracketing............................. 153, 241 Bracketing order...........................241 Built-in AF-assist illuminator ....223 Built-in flash .................. 39, 143, 288 Bulb .............................................. 78, 79 Burst...............................162, 230, 242
C
Calendar playback .......................186 Camera Control Pro 2..................298 Camera controls.............................. 92 Capture NX 2........94, 251, 253, 298 CEC ....................................................205 Center-weighted ................ 109, 226 Charging the battery .............21­22 Choose color temp. (White balance) ............................... 115, 120 Choose image area................. 90, 91 Choose start/end point................ 69 CL mode shooting speed ..........229 Clean image sensor .....................301

338

Clock .......................................... 27, 253 Clock battery ....................................28 Cloudy (White balance) ............. 115 CLS..................................................... 293 Color balance................................. 268 Color outline .................................. 275 Color sketch ................................... 275 Color space..................................... 217 Color temperature .... 115, 116, 120 Commander mode ...................... 237 Compatible lenses ....................... 285 Compressed (Type) ........................94 Computer........................................ 193 Connector for external microphone....................................... 2 Continuous high speed ........... 6, 83 Continuous low speed ....6, 83, 229 Continuous release mode....... 6, 83 Continuous-servo AF........... 97, 221 Control panel......................................7 Copy image(s) ............................... 209 Copyright ...............................182, 256 CPU contacts ................................. 287 CPU lens ................................... 26, 285 Creative Lighting System .......... 293 Cross screen (Filter effects).......267 Custom Settings ........................... 219 Customize command dials .......245 Cyanotype (Monochrome) .......266
D
Date and time......................... 27, 253 Date format ............................. 27, 253 Daylight saving time............ 27, 253 DCF...........................................217, 333 Default settings 151, 214, 221, 312 Delayed remote (Remote control mode) ................................................85 Delete........................................ 47, 189 Delete all images.......................... 190 Delete current image........... 47, 189 Delete selected images ............. 190 Depth-of-field ..................................77 Depth-of-field preview button .60, 77, 241, 244, 248 Destination (Movie settings).......65 Device control (HDMI)................ 205 Digital Print Order Format ....... 199, 202, 333 Diopter adjustment control .......33, 297 Direct sunlight (White balance)..... 115 Distortion control ........................ 274 D-Lighting ...................................... 264 DPOF.............................. 199, 202, 333

DPOF print order.......................... 202 DX (24 × 16) 1.5 ×.....................63, 90 DX format....................................89, 90 DX-based movie format............... 63 Dynamic-area AF................... 99, 100
E
Easy exposure compensation.. 225 Edit movie......................................... 69 Electronic rangefinder................ 103 EV steps for exposure cntrl ....... 224 Exif............................................217, 333 Exposure......................... 74, 109­113 Exposure bracketing..........153, 241 Exposure comp. for flash........... 240 Exposure compensation............ 112 Exposure delay mode................. 231 Exposure differential................... 140 Exposure indicator......................... 78 Exposure lock ................................110 Exposure meters.................... 39, 227 Exposure program ....................... 315 External microphone..............61, 65 Eye-Fi upload................................. 260
F
Face-priority AF .............................. 52 File naming..................................... 216 File number sequence................ 230 Filter effects................. 132, 133, 267 Fine-tune optimal exposure .... 226 Fine-tuning white balance ....... 117 Firmware version.......................... 260 Fisheye ............................................. 274 Flash..... 39, 143, 144, 148, 149, 292 Flash (White balance) ................. 115 Flash bracketing ..................153, 241 Flash cntrl for built-in flash....... 236 Flash compensation.................... 148 Flash mode............................144, 145 Flash only (Auto bracketing set).... 153, 241 Flash range ..................................... 147 Flash ready indicator ..39, 149, 296 Flash shutter speed ............146, 235 Flash sync speed ....... 234, 235, 327 Flash warning ................................231 Flexible program ............................ 75 Flicker reduction .......................... 252 Fluorescent (White balance).... 115 Fn button ......92, 149, 174, 242, 247 f-number ........................... 73, 77, 288 Focal length ..........................173, 291 Focal length scale .......................... 25 Focal length scale index .............. 25 Focal plane mark .......................... 103

Focus indicator..............38, 102, 103 Focus lock ....................................... 102 Focus mode............................... 51, 97 Focus mode switch........ 25, 26, 103 Focus point......38, 52, 99, 101, 103, 222, 223 Focus point wrap-around ......... 222 Focus tracking ........................ 97, 222 Focus tracking with lock-on..... 222 Focusing screen............................ 327 Focus-mode selector ............. 51, 97 Format memory card........... 31, 250 Frame interval (Slide show)...... 213 Frame size/frame rate................... 65 Framing guides........................ 55, 62 Front-curtain sync........................145 Full-frame playback..................... 177 Full-time servo AF .......................... 51 FV lock.............................................. 149 FX (36 × 24) 1.0 ×............................ 90 FX format ................................... 89, 90 FX-based movie format ............... 63
G
GP-1..........................................175, 298 GPS ...........................................175, 183 GPS data .......................................... 183 Green intensifier (Filter effects)...... 267
H
H.264................................................. 329 HDMI..........................56, 64, 204, 333 HDMI mini-pin connector ..............2 HDMI-CEC ....................................... 205 Headphones ............................. 61, 62 Help..................................................... 18 Hi (Sensitivity) ............................... 106 Hide image..................................... 208 High definition.....................204, 333 High Dynamic Range (HDR)..... 139 High ISO NR.................................... 218 Highlights ..............................180, 209 Histogram .................... 180, 181, 209
I
Image area.............26, 63, 89, 91, 95 Image comment........................... 253 Image Dust Off ref photo .......... 251 Image overlay................................ 269 Image quality................................... 93 Image review .............. 171, 177, 212 Image size......................................... 95
n Image type (Slide show)............ 213
Incandescent (White balance) 115 Index marking ................. 60, 68, 247

339

Index print ......................................199 In-focus indicator ........ 38, 102, 103 Information ............................... 9, 179 Information display ................ 9, 231 Interval timer shooting ..............164 ISO display and adjustment .....229 ISO sensitivity ...................... 105, 107 ISO sensitivity settings ...............107 ISO sensitivity step value...........224 i-TTL................................143, 146, 237
J
JPEG .................................................... 93 JPEG basic ......................................... 93 JPEG compression.......................... 94 JPEG fine............................................ 93 JPEG normal..................................... 93
L
L (large) ....................................... 63, 95 Landscape (Set Picture Control) .... 129 Language .................................27, 253 LCD illumination...................... 2, 231 Lens ..................25­26, 172, 259, 285 Lens cap............................................. 25 Lens focus ring ................25, 55, 103 Lens mount ........................ 3, 26, 103 Live view.......................49­56, 57­64 Live view photography ................ 49 Live view selector.................... 49, 57 Lo (Sensitivity)...............................106 Lock mirror up for cleaning ......303 Long exposure NR........................218 Lossless compressed (Type) ....... 94
M
M (medium) ............................... 63, 95 Main command dial ...................... 12 Manage Picture Control.............134 Manual ......................................78, 103 Manual (Flash cntrl for built-in flash)................................................ 236 Manual focus ..........................55, 103 Matrix ...............................................109 Max. continuous release............230 Maximum aperture ..103, 147, 296 Maximum sensitivity...................107 MB-D14 ...... 232, 233, 247, 255, 297 MB-D14 battery type ..................232 Memory buffer ......................... 38, 84 Memory card 29, 31, 250, 334, 335 Memory card capacity................335
n Metering..........................................109 Microphone....................3, 61, 62, 65 Miniature effect ............................276

Minimum aperture ................. 26, 73 Minimum shutter speed............107 Mired ................................................119 Mirror..................................85, 88, 303 Mirror up ................................6, 83, 88 Mode dial .............................................5 Mode dial lock release.....................5 Modeling flash ..............................241 Monitor .................... 46, 49, 177, 250 Monitor brightness......................250 Monitor cover .................................. 17 Monitor off delay..........................228 Monitor pre-flash ............... 146, 149 Monochrome....................... 129, 266 Movie live view ............ 57, 247­248 Movie quality (Movie settings).. 65 Movie settings................................. 65 Movie-record button .................... 58 Movies............................. 57, 247­248 Multiple exposure........................160 My Menu .........................................280
N
NEF (RAW)............... 93, 94, 216, 271 NEF (RAW) bit depth ..................... 94 NEF (RAW) processing ................271 NEF (RAW) recording .................... 94 Neutral (Set Picture Control) ....129 Nikon Transfer 2.................. 193, 194 Non-CPU lens .............172, 285, 288 Non-CPU lens data.......................172 Normal-area AF............................... 52 Number of focus points .............223 Number of shots...........................337
O
OK button (shooting mode).....241 Optimal quality (JPEG compression) ................................. 94 Optional flash ...................... 237, 292 Output resolution (HDMI) .........205 Overflow (Role played by card in Slot 2)................................................ 96 Overview data ...............................184
P
Page size (PictBridge) .................198 Perspective control......................275 Photo information ............. 179, 209 PictBridge.............................. 196, 333 Picture Controls .................. 129, 131 Picture size......................................291 Pitching ............................................ 258 Playback ...................................46, 177 Playback display options...........209 Playback folder..............................207

Playback information........ 179, 209 Playback menu..............................207 Playback slot and folder.............178 Playback zoom ..............................187 Portrait (Set Picture Control)....129 Power connector ................ 297, 299 Power switch.......................................1 Predictive focus tracking ............. 97 Preset manual (White balance)...... 115, 121 Press the shutter-release button all the way down ................... 38, 39 Press the shutter-release button halfway...................................... 38, 39 Preview button ............ 77, 244, 248 Print (DPOF)....................................199 Print select ......................................199 Printing ............................................196 Programmed auto.......................... 75 Protecting photographs ............188
Q
Quick retouch ................................273 Quick-response remote (Remote control mode)................................ 85 Quiet shutter-release ................6, 83
R
Rank items (My Menu)................282 RAW Slot 1 - JPEG Slot 2 (Role played by card in Slot 2)............. 96 Rear-curtain sync .........................145 Recent settings .............................283 Red intensifier (Filter effects) ...267 Red-eye correction ......................264 Red-eye reduction ............. 144, 145 Release button to use dial ........246 Release mode ..............................6, 83 Release mode dial......................6, 83 Release mode dial lock release ...6, 83 Remote control .......... 6, 83, 85, 298 Remote control mode .................. 85 Remote cord ....................79, 88, 298 Remote mirror-up (Remote control mode)................................ 85 Remote on duration....................228 Remove items (My Menu) .........281 Removing the lens from the camera.............................................. 26 Repeating flash .............................236 Reset ..............................151, 214, 221 Reset custom settings ................221 Reset shooting menu .................214 Reset user settings......................... 82 Resize ................................................ 272

340

Restoring default settings........ 151, 214, 221, 312 Retouch menu .............................. 261 Reverse indicators........................ 246 RGB...........................................180, 217 Role played by card in Slot 2.......96 Rotate tall........................................212
S
S (small)........................................63, 95 Save selected frame ................69, 72 Save user settings ...........................81 Save/load settings ....................... 257 Saving camera settings.............. 257 Scene mode ......................................40 Screen tips ...................................... 229 SD memory card..... 29, 31, 96, 334, 335 Select date................... 191, 199, 208 Selective color............................... 277 Self-timer ......................6, 83, 85, 227 Sensitivity ..............................105, 107 Sepia (Monochrome).................. 266 Set Picture Control....................... 129 Setup menu ................................... 249 Shade (White balance)............... 115 Shooting data................................ 182 Shooting menu............................. 214 Shutter speed............................76, 78 Shutter-priority auto......................76 Shutter-release button 38, 39, 102, 110, 226, 248 Shutter-release button AE-L .... 226 Side-by-side comparison .......... 279 Single frame................................. 6, 83 Single-point AF...................... 99, 100 Single-servo AF............... 51, 97, 221 Size ................................................63, 95 Size priority (JPEG compression)... 94 Skylight (Filter effects)................ 267 Slide show ...................................... 213 Slot ...................................... 30, 96, 178 Slot empty release lock.............. 246 Slow sync ...............................144, 145 Smoothing...................................... 141 Soft (Filter effects)........................ 267 Speaker............................................ 3, 4 Speedlight ...................................... 292 Spot................................................... 109 sRGB.................................................. 217 Standard (Set Picture Control) 129 Standard i-TTL flash for digital SLR 146 Standby timer................39, 175, 227 Start printing (PictBridge)198, 201

Storage folder................................215 Straighten ....................................... 274 Sub-command dial........................ 12 Subject-tracking AF....................... 52
T
Television ........................................ 204 Thumbnail playback ................... 185 Time .................................................. 253 Time stamp (PictBridge) ............ 198 Time zone ................................ 27, 253 Time zone and date.............. 27, 253 Time-lapse photography .......... 168 Timer.......................................... 85, 164 Toning .....................................132, 133 Trim ................................................... 265 Trimming movies ........................... 69 Tripod ....................................................3 Two-button reset ......................... 151 Type D lens ............................285, 287 Type G lens ............................285, 287
U
USB...........................................194, 196 USB cable ...............................194, 196 Use GPS to set camera clock .... 175 User settings .................................... 81 UTC....................................27, 175, 183
V
Vibration reduction mode switch . 25 Viewfinder ................. 8, 33, 297, 326 Viewfinder eyepiece ..................... 86 Viewfinder eyepiece cap ............. 86 Viewfinder focus.................... 33, 297 Viewfinder grid display .............. 229 ViewNX 2................................193, 217 Vignette control............................ 218 Virtual horizon .......55, 62, 243, 258 Vivid (Set Picture Control)......... 129 Volume............................................... 67
W
Warm filter (Filter effects).......... 267 WB ............................................115, 156 WB bracketing (Auto bracketing set)..........................................156, 241 White balance ......................115, 156 Wide-area AF ................................... 52 Wireless mobile adapter............ 298

a

n
341

No reproduction in any form of this manual, in whole or in part (except for brief quotation in critical articles or reviews), may be made without written authorization from NIKON CORPORATION.
AMA14687 Printed in Europe SB2G01(11)
6MB15311-01


Acrobat Distiller 7.0 (Windows) Corporation